Vous êtes sur la page 1sur 173

UNIT 7 GRAMMAR: INFINITIVE

Infinitive as Subject
a) We can use the to-infinitive as a subject (eg To know how to drive is useful) but this is unusual.
When we use the to-infinitive as a subject, it is more usual to begin the sentence with it (as a
"preparatory subject").
It is useful to know how to drive.
It isn't expensive to play tennis in England.
b) The infinitive is the complement of subject + BE
Your mistake was to send him that letter.

Verb + infinitive
Salesman: As you see, when we try to clean even the dirtiest part of your carpet there is no problem
for this vacuum-cleaner.
Customer: But how easily can I learn to operate this machine? It seems to be extremely complicated
to me.
Salesman: If you want to know how to get the best out of your new Dirt-Up vacuum cleaner you
should read this brochure. It tells you everything you need to know.
If these verbs are followed by another verb, the structure is usually verb + to-infinitive:
1. afford
I can't afford to buy it.
2. agree
They agreed to help us.
3. appear She appears to be tired.
4. arrange I'll arrange to meet you at the airport.
5. decide I have decided to leave on Monday.
6. expect I expect to be back on Sunday.
7. fail
She failed to return the book to the library on
time.
8. forget
I forgot to mail the letter.
9. happen I happened to be passing his house at that time.
10. hope
Jack hopes to arrive next week.
11. intend
He intended to meet me at the station.
12. learn
He learned to play the piano.
13. manage She managed to finish her work early.
14. mean
I didn't mean to hurt your feelings.
15. need
I need to have your opinion.
16. offer
They offered to help us.
17. plan
I am planning to have a party.
18. prepare We prepared to welcome them.
19. pretend He pretends not to understand.
20. promise I promise not to be late.
21. prove
He proved to be a good doctor.
22. refuse
I refuse to believe his story.
23. seem
The dog seems to be friendly.
24. threaten They threatened to tell my parents.
25. want
I want to tell you something.
26. wish
She wishes to come with us.
There is a continuous infinitive (to be doing) and a perfect infinitive (to have done). We use these
especially after seem, appear, happen and pretend:
I pretended to be reading. (= I pretended that I was reading.) You seem to have lost weight. (= It
seems that you have lost weight.)
She appeared to have been cleaning the house since the morning. (= It appeared that she had been
cleaning the house since the morning.)
After the following verbs you can use a question word (what/ where/how etc.) + to-infinitive:
ask decide know remember forget explain understand
I don't know what to say.
We asked how to get to the station.

Have you decided where to go for your holidays?


I'll explain what to do later on.
I don't know whether to go to the party or not.
We often use this structure with an object + question word + to-infinitive.
I'll show you how to play chess. Somebody told me where to buy a ticket.
Alec: I don't know where to go and what to do.
George: Why don't you go to the cinema? There are a couple
of good films on at the moment. Alec: That's another problem. I don't know which to see.
I don't know whether to choose "Star Wars" or "Love
Story".

Verb + object + infinitive


I. These verbs normally take the structure verb + object + to-infinitive:
1. advise
She advised me to wait until tomorrow.
2. allow
She allowed me to use her car.
3. ask
I asked John to help us.
4. beg
They begged us to come.
5. convince
I couldn't convince him to accept our
offer.
6. expect
I expect you to be on time.
7. forbid
I forbid you to tell him.
8. force
They forced him to tell the truth.
9. get (= persuade) She got her son to do his homework.
10. hire
She hired a boy to mow the lawn.
11. instruct
He instructed them to be careful.
12. invite
Harry invited the Johnsons to come to
his party.
13. order
The judge ordered me to pay a fine.
14. permit
He permitted the children to stay up
late.
15. persuade
I persuaded him to come for a visit.
16. remind
She reminded me to lock the door.
17. teach
My brother taught me to swim.
18. tell
The doctor told me to take these pills.
19. urge
I urged her to apply for the j ob.
20. want
I want you to be happy.
21. warn
I warned you not to drive so fast.
Note: After help you can use the infinitive with to or without to: Can somebody help me (to) move
this table?
2. Make (= force), have (= ask) and let (= allow) These verbs
have the structure verb + infinitive without to:
I only did it because they made me do it.(= forced me to do it)
Hot weather makes me feel uncomfortable. (= causes me
to feel)
Jane had the waiter bring her some tea. (= asked)
I had the plumber repair the leak. (= asked)
They let their children stay up late at weekends. (= allow)
Will you let me use your camera? (= allow)
Compare the use of causative verbs make, have, get:
a) I made my brother carry my suitcase. (= forced)
b) I had my brother carry my suitcase. (= asked)
c) I got my brother to carry my suitcase. (= persuaded)
Note: After the passive verb the infinitive is always with to: Everyone was made to take the exam.
We do not use the verb letin the passive. We use allow instead. Mr Jones was allowed to leave early.
/ want (you) to speak to him

There are two possible structures after these words: want, expect, hate, like, dislike, love, cannot
bear, prefer, wish, would like, would prefer.
verb + to-infinitive I want to help her. We expected to be late. He would like to come. I'd prefer to
stay at home. I hate to be punished.
verb + object + to-infinitive I want him to help her. We expected her to be late. He would like me to
come. I'd prefer you to stay at home. I hate him to be punished.
I cannot bear to read in bed.
I cannot bear him to read in bed.

/ know him to be an honest man


We can use that or to-infinitive after these verbs to refer to people or things: believe, consider, find,
imagine, know, suppose, think.
Instead of: People know (that) he is an honest man. We can say: People know him to be an honest
man. Instead of: I thought that the lecture was useful. We can say: I thought the lecture to be useful.
It is said that he.../He is said to... etc.
1. When we talk about what other people say, believe, etc. we can use two possible passive forms.
Compare:
Active:
People say that Mr Ross is a millionaire.
Passive (I):
It + passive + that-clause
It is said that Mr Ross is a millionaire. Passive (2): Subject + passive + to-infinitive
Mr Ross is said to be a millionaire.
We often use these passive forms in a formal style and with verbs such as: say, think, believe,
consider, know, report, expect
It is believed that they own a lot of land in the north. They are believed to own a lot of land in the
north.
It is reported that the president is seriously ill. The president is reported to be seriously ill.
It is expected that a new law will be introduced next year.
A new law is expected to be introduced next year.
When the belief, etc refers to an earlier action, we use the perfect infinitive. Compare:
It is believed that the fire started late last night. The fire is believed to have started late last night.
It was thought that two prisoners had escaped. Two prisoners were thought to have escaped.
2. Be supposed to
We can use supposed to to mean "said to ".
I'd like to read that book. It's supposed to be very good. (= It is said to be very good.)
He's supposed to have been married before. (= He is said to have been married before.)
Supposed to sometimes suggests some doubt about whether something is true or not.
Note that we also use supposed to to say what people are expected to do because of an arrangement,
a rule, or a duty eg I'm supposed to see Maria this afternoon.

Infinitive of purpose
Jill: Hi, Sally. I've come to show you my new records. I went to buy a sweater, but then I heard this
record playing...
Sally: I suppose when you go to buy records you usually come out of the shop with clothes!
a) The infinitive with to frequently expresses purpose, indicating that one action will follow another:
I have come to apologise.
I sent Mrs Bacon a bunch of flowers to thank her for the party.
We shouted to warn everyone of the danger.
You can also use in order or so as + to-mfinitive:
We shouted in order to warn everyone of the danger.
(so as)
Some speakers hesitate so as to choose the right word.
(in order)
In order and so as + to-infinitive are more formal than the infinitive of purpose with to.
I am going to England to improve my English.
I am going to England in order (so as) to improve my
English.

Note: You can never express purpose with/or plus an infinitive. You cannot say: I am going to
England for to learn English, b) So (that)
So (that) is used to express purpose in the following situations: (i) with can or could
I'd like to work in the afternoons so (that) I can study in the mornings.
We moved to London so (that) we could visit our friends more often.
(ii) when the purpose is negative:
You'd better take a map so (that) you won't get lost. I hurried so that I wouldn't be late. (= because I
didn't want' to be late)
(iii) when the subject of the main clause is different from the subject of the purpose clause:
I gave him my address so that he could contact me. He wore glasses and a false beard so that nobody
would recognize him.

The infinitive after nouns and pronouns


Son:
I'm really bored. I've got nothing to do.
Mother: You're lucky! I've got the kitchen to clean, the dinner
to cook and the shopping to do! Why don't you help
me? You could make a cake. Son:
That's all right. I've just found a comic to read!
We have a problem to discuss. (= We have a problem which we should discuss.)
I've got a comic to read. (= I've got a comic which I can read.)
I have an exercise to do. (= I have an exercise which I must do.)
The book tells you about walks to take. (= which you can take)
There are a lot of museums to visit. (= which you can visit)

The infinitive after adjectives


Chris: You were very kind to lend me your bike. I was just too lazy to walk all the way to the bank.
Ian: That's all right. Now you can be good enough to pay me the money that you owe me.
a) The to-infinitive often follows an adjective:
I'm ready to go to school.
We were sorry to hear the bad news.
I was surprised to see Tim at the meeting.
b)You can use a phrase with of after adjectives:
It's good of you to come.
It was silly of Peter not to tell anyone.
c) Note.I'm eager to please. = I am very keen to please someone
else.
I'm easy to please. = It is easy for someone else to please me.
He is easy to teach. = He is an easy pupil to teach, or It is easy to teach him.
George is quick to take offence. = He takes offence quickly.
This car is easy to drive. = It is easy to drive this car.
She is hard to deal with. = It is hard to deal with her.
This construction is often used after the comparative and superlative of adjectives and expressions
with too and enough:
It would be more interesting to go out.
The Top Club is the easiest to find.
The piano is too heavy to move.
I'm not strong enough to lift this box.
The examination was too terrible to talk about.
d) The to-infinitive is often used after ordinal numerals and the adjective last:
He was the first to answer.
She was the last to leave.

For + noun phrase + infinitive


We use for + noun phrase + infinitive after
1. an adjective
It was easy for the player to kick the ball into the empty goal.(= The player easily kicked the ball into
the empty goal.)
2. a noun phrase

It was a mistake for Helen to marry Bob. (= Helen married Bob, which was a mistake.)
3. a verb which usually has for after it, eg wait for
They are still waiting for them to reply. (= They have not replied yet.)

See someone do and see someone doing


Policeman: There's been a robbery here. I want to speak to anybody who saw anything at seven
o'clock this evening.
Mr Jackson: I was here. I saw a car arrive at about six o'clock. The driver waited for an hour. Then I
noticed him signal to somebody in the building. Then there was a loud bang inside the building.
Policeman: Did you hear anybody scream or shout? Did you see anyone come out of the building?
Mr Jackson: I heard someone shout "murderer". Then three men ran out, jumped into the car and
drove off.
a) Study this example situation:
Tom got into his car and drove away. You saw this. You can say:
I saw Tom get into his car and drive away. In this structure we use the infinitive (get, drive etc.):
Someone did something
>
I saw this

I saw someone do something

Remember that we use the infinitive without to:


I saw her go out. (not "to go out")
But after apassive ("he was seen" etc.) we use to + infinitive:
She was seen to go out.
b) Now study this example situation:
Yesterday you saw Ann. She was waiting for a bus. You can say:
I saw Ann waiting for a bus.
In this structure we use ing (waiting):
Someone was doing
something
I saw this
I saw someone doing something I
) Now study the difference in meaning between the two structures:
" I saw him do something" = he did something (past simple} and I saw this. I saw the complete
action from beginning to end:
He fell to the ground. I saw this.
I saw him fall to the ground.
The accident happened. We saw this, We saw the accident happen.
"I saw him doing something" = he was doing something (past continuous) and I saw this. I saw him
when he was in the middle of doing something. This does not mean that I saw the complete action:
He was walking along the street.
I saw this when I drove past in my car.
4J-I saw him walking along the street.
When we use a present participle we emphasize experience of part of an action:
12

I watched the boats sailing by. = , .


When we want to emphasize experience of the complete action we use an infinitive without to after
the verb of perception:
-1 watched the boats sail by. = , .
There is usually little difference in meaning between the two forms except that the -ing form usually
gives the idea of "while":
I've never seen Tom dance.
I saw my friend run down the street.
I heard the rain fall on the roof.
I've never seen Tom
dancing.
I saw my friend

running down the street.


I heard the rain falling
on the roof.
d) We use these structures especially with see and hear, and also with watch, listen to, feel and
notice:
I didn't hear you come in. I could hear it raining.
She suddenly felt someone The missing boys were touch her on the shoulder.
last seen
playing near
the river.
Did you notice anyone
Listen to the birds go out?
singing!
After smell and find you can use the -ing structure only:
Can you smell something burning?
She found him reading her letters.

Would rather
Would rather (do) = would prefer to do. After would rather we use the infinitive without to.
Compare:
Shall we go by train?
Well, I'd prefer to go by
car.
Well, I'd rather go by car.
(not "to go")
"Would you rather have tea or coffee?" "Coffee, please."
I'm tired. I'd rather not go out this evening, if you don't mind.
"Do you want to go out this evening?" "I'd rather not."
Note the structure: / 'd rather do something than (do) something else.
\

I'd rather stay at home than go to the cinema.

Had better do something


The meaning of had better (I'd better) is similar to should. "I'd better do something" = I should do
something or it is advisable for me to do something; if I don't do this, something bad might happen:
I have to meet Tom in ten minutes. I'd better go now or I'll be late.
We've almost run out of petrol. We'd better stop at the next petrol station to fill up.
The negative form is had better not ('d better not):
You don't look very well. You'd better not go to work today.
The form is always "had better" (usually 'd better in spoken English). We say had but the meaning is
present or future, not past:
I'd better go to the bank this afternoon.
Remember that had better is followed by the infinitive without to:
It might rain. We'd better take an umbrella,
Practice Infinitive as subject, complement of subject
I. Transform according to the model.
eg To skate here is pleasant. It is pleasant to skate here.
14
1. To swim on a hot summer day is marvellous. 2. To learn a foreign language is difficult. 3. To rest
there was pleasant. 4. To be given such an opportunity is important. 5. To look after the children was
her duty. 6. To marry him was her ambition. 7. To have spent a month at the seaside was very useful.
6. To be fishing now is too cold. 9. To have bought such a useless thing was stupid.
10. To be treated rudely is unpleasant.
11. Make sentences with the same meaning by usingit + infinitive.
eg Having good friends is important. It is important to have good friends.
I. Playing tennis is fun. 2. Being polite to other people is important. 3. Learning about other cultures
is interesting. 4. Walking alone at night in this part of the city is dangerous. 5. Is learning a second
language difficult? 6. Is riding a motorcycle easy? 7. Having a cold isn't much fun. 7. Learning a
second language takes a long time. 8. Cooking a soft-boiled egg takes three minutes.
III. Answer the questions.

Student A: Use it + infinitive. Student : Use gerunds.


1. Which is easier: to make money or to spend money?
A: It is easier to spend money than (it is) to make money. B: Spending money is easier than making
money.
2. Which is more fun: to study at the library or to go to a movie?
3. Which is more difficult: to write English or to read English?
4. Which is easier: to write English or to speak English?
5. Which is more expensive: to go to a movie or to go to a concert?
6. Which is more interesting: to talk to people or to watch people?
7. Which is more comfortable: to wear shoes or to go barefoot?
8. Which is more satisfying: to give gifts or to receive them?
9. Which is more dangerous: to ride in a car or to ride in an airplane?
10. Which is more important: to come to class on time or to get an extra hour of sleep in the
morning?
15

IV. Student A: Complete the sentence with an infinitive phrase. Student B: Give a sentence with the
same meaning by using a gerund phrase as the subject.
1. It is fun...
A: It is fun to ride a horse. B: Riding a horse is fun.
2. It's dangerous... 5. It is important... 8. It's a good idea...
3. It's easy...
4. It's impolite...
6. It is wrong... 7. It takes a lot of time.
9. Is it difficult...?
V. Restate the sentences by changing a sentence with a gerund as the subject to a sentence with it +
an infinitive phrase, and vice-versa.
1. Teasing animals is cruel. It is cruel to tease animals.
2. It wasn't difficult to find their house. Finding their house wasn't difficult.
3. Voting in every election is important.
4. It was exciting to meet the king and queen.
5. Hearing the other side of the story would be interesting.
6. It is unusual to see Joan awake early in the morning.
7. If you know how, it is easy to float in water for a long time.
8. Mastering a second language takes time and patience.
9. Driving to Atlanta will take us ten hours.
10. It takes courage to dive into the sea from a high cliff.
VI. Match columns A and to make sentences: eg It's not easy for old people to climb stairs.
It's not easy for old people
It's quite easy for Dutch people
It's not safe in some cities for women
It's dangerous for inexperienced people
It's not difficult for young children
It can be difficult in a big city
16

to learn English.
to climb mountains.
to learn languages.
to climb stairs.
to make friends.
to go out alone at night.
VII. Use the given information to complete each sentence. Use for (someone) and an infinitive
phrase in each completion.
1. Students should do their homework. It's important... It is important for students to do their
homework. 2. Teachers should speak clearly. It's important... 3. We don't have to hurry. There's plenty
of time. It isn't necessary... 4. A fish can't live out of water more than a few minutes. It is

impossible... 5. Students have to budget their time carefully. It's necessary... 6. A child usually can't
sit still for a long time. It's difficult... 7. My family always eats turkey on Thanksgiving Day. It's
traditional... 8. People can take vacation trips to the moon. Will it be possible... within the next fifty
years? 9.1 usually can't understand Mr Alien. It's hard... He talks too fast. 10.1 can understand our
teacher. It's easy... 11. The guests usually wait until the hostess begins to eat. At a formal dinnerparty
it's customary... 12. The bride usually feeds the groom the first piece of wedding cake. It's
traditional...
VIII. Identify exactly who the speaker is talking about using the phrase for (someone). Add for
(someone) to the following sentences 'and any other words to give a more specific meaning.
1. It's important to take advanced math courses. It's important for science students to take advanced
math courses. 2. It isn't easy to speak Spanish. 3. It's important to learn English. 4. It's unusual to be
late. 5. It is essential to get a visa. 6. It is dangerous to play with matches. 7. It's difficult to
communicate. 8. It's quite easy to do this exercise. 9. It's useful to go jogging. 10. It must be
interesting to study at the Linguistic University. 11. It is necessary to be present.
IX. Student A: Complete the sentence with an infinitive phrase. Student B: Give a sentence with
the same meaning by
using a gerund phrase. eg Her ambition is...
A: Her ambition is to become an actress.
B: Her ambition is becoming an actress. 1. My hobby is... 2. Your duty is... 3. His favourite pastime
is...4. The main thing to do is... 5. The first thing to do is...6. Her dream is... 7. The only way out
was...
17

Verb + infinitive
I. Robert is talking about the day he bought a second-hand car. Complete Robert's story using the toinfinitive form of the verbs in the boxes.
buy
be
not like
test-drive

"When I got to the garage, I managed to have a quick look at the car before the salesman came out of
his office. It seemed... in very good condition and was worth about 1000, although the garage was
asking 1400 for it. When the salesman came out, I arranged... the car straight away. The salesman
and I got in and we drove off. I liked the car immediately and decided that I wanted... it, but, of
course, I didn't say this to the salesman. Instead, I pretended... the car very much."
| try get
accept
pay
|
"When we had finished the test-drive and had pulled up outside the garage, I told the salesman that I
couldn't afford... more than 750. The salesman, of course, refused such a miserable little offer. He
told me that he expected at least 1200 for the car. I tried offering800, 850, 875, but he wouldn't
change his mind. Then I decided to do something different."
| give be
sell
accept
"I thanked the salesman politely, said goodbye, got out of the car and started to walk away. It
worked! The salesman got out of the car too and hurried after me. He told me that he wanted... fair
and was prepared ... a reasonable offer for the car. In the end, he agreed... it to me for 1100. He
even agreed... me 200 for my old car!"
II. Make up short dialogues.

seem/appear/happen/is said/is supposed + infinitive


Mr X has recently come to live in the area, but seems to wish to avoid people. This of course arouses
interest and his neighbours
18
observe him closely. Two of them are talking about him. The first speaker makes confident
assertions; the second is more cautious.
He..
A: He wishes to avoid us.
B: Well, he seems to wish to avoid us.
1. is afraid of someone.

2. suspects everyone.
3. distrusts his neighbours.
4. dislikes children.
5. likes dogs.
6. avoids people.
7. reads a lot.
8. prefers to be alone.
9. thinks he is in danger. 10. lives on pills.
1 1 . eats very little.
12. feeds his dogs well.
13. writes a lot of letters.
14. works at night.
15. has plenty of money.
16. knows several languages.
17. takes a lot of photos.
Two people keep a close eye on Mr Smith, who lives opposite. The road is wide and busy so they do
not see exactly what is happening, but they have a general idea.
A: He doesn't usually watch television. B: Well, he seems to be watching it today. A: He doesn't
usually get letters. B: Well, he seems to be getting some today. He doesn 't usually...
1 . talk to his mother-in-law.
2. help his wife.
3. use the public phone box.
4. try to please his wife.
19
5. play with the children.
6. bring his wife flowers.
7. take photographs.
,
8. do the shopping.
9. carry his wife's parcels.
10. leave the car at home.
11. let his wife drive.
12. quarrel with his neighbours.
13. walk to work.
14. pay cash.
15. collect the children from school.
4>
Two people are visiting a "stately home" built in the eighteenth " century by a famous duke. One asks
questions about the duke, which the other, who has just bought the guide book, does his'best to
answer.
A: Was he rich? (very)
(a) B: Yes, he seems to have been very rich.
(b) B: Yes, he appears to have been very rich.
(c) : Yes, he is said to have been very rich.
(d) B: Yes, he is supposed to have been very rich.
1 . Did he live here? (most of his life) 2. Did he marry? (several times) 3. Did he have children? (a lot
of) 4. Did he build any other houses? (several) 5. Did he own (large) estates? (enormous) 6. Did he
employ a large staff? (huge) 7. Was he a good landlord? (excellent) 8. Did his tenants like him? (very
much) 9. Did he entertain? (lavishly) 10. Did he drink? (heavily) 1 1 . Did he hunt? (when he was a
young man) 12. Did he keep racehorses? (all his life) 1 3 . Did they win races? (quite a lot of) 1 4.
Did he lose money gambling? (a fortune) 15. Did he sell his other houses? (two of them) 16. Did he
quarrel with his neighbours? (some of them) 17. Did he fight duels? (two) 18. Did he kill his
opponent? (both times) 19. Did he leave the country? (after the second duel) 20. Did he die abroad?
(in Paris)
The first speaker is very suspicious.

A: You asked him the time. Was it part of a plan?


: No, I just happened to ask him the time.
A: You were looking out of the window when I passed.
Was this part of a plan? B: No, I just happened to be looking out of the window.
You...
1. were in the phone box when I passed. Were you watching me? 2. looked at your watch. Was that a
signal of some kind? 3. were sitting by the window when I passed. Were you watching me? 4. were
leaning against your gate when I passed. Were you watching me? 5. were waiting for a bus when I
passed. Were you watching me? 6. gave him a lift. Was this part of a plan? 7. were standing in your
doorway when I passed. Were you watching me? 8. travelled on the same train as Peter. Was that part
of a plan? 9. were watering your window-box when I passed. Were you watching me? 10. got out at
the same station as Peter. Was this part of a plan? 11. had your tape recorder with you. Was this part
of a plan? 12. waved at Jack. Was this a signal? 13. sat at the same table as Jack. Was this part of a
plan? 14. were wearing dark glasses when I saw you. Was this part of a plan? 15. and Peter
exchanged briefcases. Was this intentional?
III. This time you have to make sentences with seem and appear.
eg Is he waiting for someone?
He appears to be waiting
for someone
Has she lost weight?
She seems to have lost
weight.
1. Is Tom worried about something? He seems...
2. Does Ann like Jack? She appears...
3. Is that man looking for something? He appears...
4. Has the car broken down. It seems...
5. Have they gone out? They appear...
6. Is Dick looking for his gloves? He seems...
7. Have they been sitting here long? They seem...
IV. Read each sentence. Then make two new sentences in the passive, beginning with the words in
brackets.
20
21
eg People expect that taxes will be reduced soon. (It) (Taxes)
It is expected that taxes will be reduced soon. Taxes are expected to be reduced soon.
1. People say that the monument is over 2000 years old. (It)
(The monument)
2. People expect that the president will resign. (It)
(The president)
3. People think the fire started at about 8 o'clock. (It)
(The fire)
4. Journalists reported that seven people had been injured in the fire.
(It)
(Seven people)
5. They say that prices will rise again this month. (It)
(Prices)
6. People consider that he is honest and reliable. (It)
(He)
7. We suppose that he is an expert in financial matters. (It)
(He)
8. People know that this place is famous for its lakes. (It)
(This place)
V. Read each sentence. Then make a new sentence with be + supposed to, as in the example.
eg People say that Whitby is a very nice town. Whitby is supposed to be a very nice town.
1. People say that the new film is very exiting.
2. People say that those cars are rather unreliable.
3. People say that he moved to New York last year.
4. People say that the new restaurant is very expensive.
5. People say that the concert was very good.
VI. Sylvia is supposed to be home by eight 'clock every evening. Which of the following things are you
(not) supposed to do? Say your answers.
eg I am supposed to tell my parents the truth.
eg I am not supposed to park my bicycle in the living-room.
22

tell your parents the truth

park your bicycle in the living-room


help at home sometimes
tell your parents where you are going every time you go out
be punctual for meals
sit at table in silence during meals
stay out all night without permission
stay in bed until lunchtime at weekends
wear dirty shoes inside the house
play loud music late at night
go everywhere with your parents
VII. Make up short dialogues.
would like + perfect infinitive, wanted+ present infinitive
A: Did you see the castle?
(a) B: No, I would like to have seen it* but there wasn't time.
(b) B: No, I wanted to see it but there wasn't time.
* Note: Would have liked to see it and would have liked to have seen it are also possible forms. Did
you...
1. ring Peter?
2. talk to the students?
3. attend the conference?
4. try the beer?
5. watch the match?
6. visit the museum?
7. see the zoo?
8. walk round the town?
9. meet your friends?
10. look at the old bridge?
11. climb to the top of the monument?
12. have coffee? (Answer with some.)
13. make a sketch? (Answer with one.)
14. take any photographs? (some)
15. hire a boat? (one)
16. send any postcards? (some)
23
17. buy any souvenirs? (some)
18. listen to the town band?
19. paint any pictures? (some)

remember/forget + infinitive
Ann's bad memory saves her a lot of trouble.
(a) A: I locked the safe. Ann had forgotten. B: Oh, Ann never remembers to lock it.
or B: Oh, Ann always forgets to lock it.
(b) A: I took down the old notices. Ann had forgotten. B: Oh, Ann never remembers to take them
down.
or
B: Oh, Ann always forgets to take them down. (Notice word order.)
I... Ann had forgotten.
1. turned out the lights. (See (b) above.)
2. switched off the TV. (See (b) above.)
3. shut the lift doors.
4. paid the milkman.
5. took the milk in. (See (b) above.)
6. washed the coffee cups.
7. made coffee.
8. swept the floor.

9. dusted the desks.


10. put up the new notices. (See (b) above.)
11. watered the pot plants.
12. thanked the office cleaners.
13. put out the rubbish. (See (b) above.)
14. stamped the letters.
15. bought the biscuits.
16. covered the typewriters.
17. locked the office.

Verb + question word + infinitive


Complete the sentences using the most suitable words in the box.
what/do how/get
how/make whether/stay
what/wear how/spell
eg Could you tell me how to get to Western Road, please?" "Yes. Go down this road and it's second
on the left."
1. "Have you decided... to the interview?" "Yes, I'm going to wear my new blue suit." 2. Could you
tell me... you name please? 3. "What are you going to do this evening?" "I can't decide... at home or
go out." 4. Do you know... a Spanish omelette? 5. 1 felt very embarrassed when she started shouting.
I didn't know..., so I just stood there.

Verb + object + infinitive


I. Complete these sentences using an object + to-infinitive after the verbs.
1. Take out a loan. My bank manager advised me to take out a loan. 2. She didn't peel the potatoes.
You didn't tell... 3. We work hard. Our teacher taught... 4. The soldiers fired. The officer ordered... 5.
The public should not approach this man. The police have warned... 6. My wife and I play tennis. My
boss invited... 7. You may take my car. He allowed... 8. At first I didn't want to play but Jack
persuaded me. Jack persuaded... 9. You should tell the police about the accident. She advised... 10.
Could you please post this letter? She asked... 11. Don't forget to buy some sugar. She reminded...
II. Make up short dialogues.

make + object + infinitive without to


(a) A: He told Ann, I hope.
(b) He put on his gloves,
I hope. B: Yes, I made him tell her.
Yes, I made him put
25

() ... I hope.
1. apologized
2. explained
3. paid the bill
4. wrote to the Smiths
5. cleaned the bath
6. took the medicine
7. reported the accident
8. waited for Ann
9. rang his parents
10. finished the book
11. answered the letter
12. made his bed
13. cleaned his shoes
14. wore his best suit
15. insured his house
16. did his exercises
them on.
(b) He... I hope.
1. hung up his coat
2. turned down the radio
3. shaved off his beard
4. took back the books

5. rang up Jane
6. took down the notice
7. rolled up the carpet
8. locked up the papers
9. threw away his old boots
10. filled up the form
11. looked up the time of the train
12. switched off the central heating
13. paid back the money
14. put away his tools
15. put on his raincoat
16. took off his coat

let + object + infinitive without to, to be allowed + to-infinitive


The Smiths and their two boys and the Browns and their two girls went to the same holiday resort but
at different times. Afterwards the boys and the girls compare their holidays. The boys had a much
more interesting time! The boys speak first.
(a) Active: A: We went rock climbing.
B: Our parents didn't let us go rock-climbing.
(b) Passive: A: We ran about without shoes.
B: We weren't allowed to run about without shoes, (stress on we and allowed)
We...
1. ran about without shoes.
2. slept in the garden.
3. practised parachuting.
4. played water polo.
26
5. sailed round the island.
6. water skied.
7. had bicycle races on the sand.
8. canoed down the river.
9. climbed the cliffs.
10. went surfing.
11. rode Peter's pony.
12. explored the caves.
13. learnt how to dive.

would prefer + object + infinitive


A: Shall I phone Tom tomorrow? B: I'd prefer you to phone him today.
Shall I... tomorrow'''
1. phone Bill
2. bring my friends
3. speak to James
4. sweep the stairs
5. begin
6. pay the milk bill
7. come
8. leave
9. go to the library
10. read the instructions
11. take the books back
12. burn the rubbish
13. get the new programme
14. write to the Smiths
15. buy your season ticket
16. make the arrangements

would like/want + object + infinitive


a)

A: Would you like to make a speech9

B: No, I'd like you to make a speech, (stress on you) (b) A: Do you want to make speech?
B: No, I want you to make a speech, (stress on you)
27

(a) Would you like to...


(b) Do you want to...
1. lead the deputation?
2. pick the team*?
3. receive the mayor1?
4. speak first?
5. introduce the speakers
6. sign the cheque
7. witness Tom's signature?
8. engage the extra staff?
9. attend the conference?
10. give a talk?
11. meet the president?
12. make the arrangements?
13. answer the queries?
14. choose the colours?
15. fix a date?
16. organize the reception?
17. open the champagne?

doesn 't/didn 't want + object + infinitive


Ann is a young married woman with a lot of time on her hands. Two of her friends think that she
would be happier if she had an occupation or hobby. Unfortunately her husband doesn't seem to share
their views.
(a) A: Have you suggested going to evening classes?
B: Yes, but apparently her husband doesn't want her to go to evening classes, (stress on want)
or
A: Did you suggest going to evening classes? B: Yes, but apparently her husband didn't want her to
go
to evening classes. Have you suggested.... Did you suggest....
1. painting?
2. riding?
3. working in the garden?
4. taking a driving test?
5. making friends with her neighbours?
28

6. inviting her mother to stay?


7. getting a part-time job?
' '
8. hiring a typewriter?
9. joining a drama club?
10. acting in a play?
11. singing in the choir?
12. buying a dog?
13. helping at the old people's club?
14. studying Russian?
15. learning judo?
16. attending keep-fit classes?
17. going to art lectures?
18. taking a course in vegetarian cooking?
19. redecorating the house?
20. training as a tourist guide?
III. Paraphrase these sentences using a to-infinitive instead of that
eg People know that he is an honest man. People know him to be an honest man.
1. I believe that she is guilty. 2. I found that the job was too difficult. 3.1 know that she has an

interest in the company. 4.1 imagine that he works very hard. 5. The teacher considered that my
answer was inadequate. 6.1 felt that it was true. 7.1 suppose that the matter is urgent. 8.1 think he is a
bore.
Infinitive of purpose
I. Where did you go yesterday, and why did you go to each place?
1. Chemist's
2. Post Office
3. Cinema
4. Hairdresser's
5. Car Rental Agency
6. Park
Make sentences using "I went to the (place) to... " and the words in the box.
eg I went to the chemist's to buy some medicine.
29

hire
buy
have
play
post
see
a haircut
tennis
a film
some letters
a car
some medicine
II. Join each idea in A with an idea from B. Make sentences using (i) in order (not) to, and (ii) so as
(not) to.
eg (i) He drank lots of black coffee in order to keep awake, (ii) He drank lots of black coffee so as to
keep awake.
A
1. He drank lots of black coffee
2.1 often write things down
3. She took an umbrella
4. We'll use the computer 5.1 want to pass the exams 6. We turned down the music

disturb the neighbours


save time
get a better job
forget them
keep awake
get wet
III. Join the sentences with in order to, or so (that).
I. I'll give you my telephone number. You can phone me at work. 2. Take some suntan cream. Then
you won't get sunburnt. 3. I'm going to the post office. I want to post a parcel. 4. We are organizing a
"Fun Run". We want to raise money for the local hospital. 5. They took the phone off the hook.
Nobody could phone them. 6. Speak louder. Then Granny can hear you. 7. Turn the sound down. I
don't want you to disturb the neighbours. 8. We are installing solar () heating. We want to
save energy.
IV. In pairs, think of five good reasons why you are learning English.
Noun/pronoun + infinitive
I. Paraphrase the following so as to use the infinitive.
eg He gave me a passage which I was to look through. He gave me a passage to look through.
30

1. There are still a lot of things which must be packed. 2. There are so many letters that must be

answered. 3. I have no money which I can spend. 4. There is nothing which we might record now. 5.
There is nothing you should worry about. 6. Here is a list of medicines which are to be sold without a
prescription. 7. He is not the man you can rely on. 8. A good housewife will always find something
that must be done about the house. 9. He is not the man who can be easily impressed. 10. The next
patient who was examined was my brother. 11. There was nothing that might keep him at home that
night, and he gladly accepted the invitation. 12. She had no one who could take care of her. 13. We've
got no time that we can lose.
II. Respond using what a/an + adjective + noun + infinitive.
A: He lives in a cave, (funny place) B: What a funny place to live!
He...
1. parked outside the police station, (silly place)
2. travels by donkey, (slow way)
3. said, "mind your own business." (rude thing)
4. sleeps in his car. (uncomfortable place)
5. makes money by telling fortunes, (interesting way)
6. swims at night, (odd time)
7. plays golf on his flat roof, (strange place)
8. makes all his important decisions in the lift, (extraordinary place)
9. lives on brown rice, (odd thing) (Keep on)
10. cooks in his bathroom, (queer place)
11. rings up his friends at 6 a.m. (inconvenient time)
12. relaxes by standing on his head, (odd way)
13. reads the telephone directory, (strange thing)
14. gets up at 4 a.m. (unpleasant time)
15. has a holiday in June, (agreeable time)
16. drives a Rolls Royce. (expensive car)
III. Paraphrase the following using a noun instead of the verb in bold type with the infinitive as attribute,
make all other necessary changes.
31

eg He offered to help us but we refused. We refused his offer to help us.


I don't want to change my mind. I have no desire to change my mind.
1.1 was surprised that he refused to go there. 2. We did not know that they planned to leave soon. 3.
They demand to be regularly informed, and you will have to comply with it. 4. I remember you
promised not to talk of it. 5.1 told him that I was firmly determined to find out the truth. 6. He was
permitted to leave. 7.1 don't intend to do anything about it. 8, They repeatedly attempted to stage the
experiment. 9. He did not wish to let you down. 10. The trainer instructed the cyclists to examine their
bicycles before the competition. 11. He consented to fill up the vacancy.

Adjective + infinitive
be + horrified/glad/surprised/amazed/ relieved etc. + infinitive
I. Paraphrase using the infinitive.
eg A: I saw smoke coming under the door, (horrified) B: I was horrified to see smoke coming under the
door. 1.1 heard cries of pain coming from the next room, (horrified) 2.1 saw a photograph of myself on
the front page, (astonished) 3.1 found a complete stranger taking food out of my fridge.
(annoyed)
4.1 saw that the beds had been made, (glad) 5.1 received an invitation to the palace, (delighted) 6.1 found
that no preparations had been made, (surprised) 7.1 heard that the last train had just left, (dismayed) 8.1
found everyone still in bed at eleven o'clock, (shocked) 9.1 found the last bus still standing there,
(relieved) 10.1 heard that you can't come skiing after all. (disappointed) 11.1 learnt that no room had been
reserved for me. (annoyed) 12. 1 saw that most of the town had been destroyed by the
explosion, (shocked)
32

13. I heard that the plane had crashed, (horrified)


14.1 heard that my brother was safe, (relieved)
15.1 found that I could make myself understood, (pleased)
16.1 saw that I had passed the exam, (glad)
17.1 found my name at the very bottom of the list, (sorry)

181 heard that I could have every weekend off. (delighted)

it is/was + adjective + of+ object + infinitive


II. Respond to the following statements.
A: He warned me. (kind)
B: It was kind of him to warn you.
1. They waited for me. (good) 2. He lent Ann his bicycle, (kind) 3. She believed him. (stupid) 4. They
invited me. (nice) 5. She told the police, (sensible) 6.1 found the way. (clever) (Use you) 7. She left her
car unlocked, (careless) 8. He had another drink, (foolish) 9. She argued with the customs officer, (stupid)
10. He refused to share his sandwiches, (selfish) 11. They ran away, (cowardly) 12. He kept the money,
(dishonest) 13. He took the only cream cake, (greedy) 14. She jumped into the river to save the child,
(brave) 15. He offered to pay. (generous) 16. He said I wasn't any use. (unkind) 17. He told lies about me.
(wicked) 18. He admitted he was wrong, (courageous)

too + adjective + infinitive, adjective + enough + infinitive


III. Respond to the following statements.
A: You sat on the grass, I suppose? (wet/dry) (a)B: No, it was too wet to sit on.
or
No, it was too wet for us to sit on. b) B: Yes, it was dry enough to sit on.
Yes, it was dry enough for us to sit on.
... I suppose?
1. You slept in the cave, (wet/dry) 2. He walked on the ice, (thin/ thick) 3. You ate the apple, (sour/sweet)
4. He wore his
33

blue suit, (shabby/smart) 5. The plane landed on the sand, (soft/ hard) 6. You drank the coffee, (hot/cool)
7. He picked the fruit, (unripe/ripe) 8. You took out the (electric light) bulb, (hot/cool) 9. She read by the
light of the moon, (dim/bright) 10. You used yesterday's milk, (sour/fresh) 11. He dived from the pier,
(high/ low) 12. She handed in her exercise, (untidy/tidy) 13. You swam in the river, (polluted/clean). 14.
He stood on the table, (unsteady/ steady) 15. You put your umbrella in your suitcase, (long/short) 16. He
put the trunk in the boot of the car, (big/small) 17. She dived into the pond, (shallow/deep) 18. You sat on
the floor, (dirty/ clean) 19. He picked up the sack of potatoes, (heavy/light)

This book is hard to get


IV. Agree or disagree with the following.
eg John is a bad-tempered man. (deal with)
I don't agree with you. He is very pleasant to deal with. eg This is a very rare stamp.
Quite so. It is so hard to get.
1. The novel is boring, (read) 2. She is a charming little creature, (look at) 3. He is a shallow man. (deal
with) 4. She is good at dancing, I must say. (dance with) 5. My friend looks altogether a new girl after the
trip, (recognize) 6. Jane is a very clever girl, (talk to) 7. The passage is too long, (learn by heart) 8. She is
a good-natured girl, (please) 9. The bicycle is broken, (repair)

find it easy + infinitive


V. Make up short dialogues using the prompts, (i) Prompt: open the windows
(a) A: Do you have difficulty (in) opening the windows?
(b) B: No, I find it quite easy to open them.
(c) B: No, I find them quite easy to open.
Note: I find it easy to open them implies that the speaker has the necessary skill. I find them easy to open
implies that it is easy to open them.
The hall porter of a block of flats is answering questions
34

1. regulate the central heating


2. organize the cleaning
3. control the cleaning staff
4. remember the tenants' names
5. answer telephone enquiries
6. deal with complaints
7. understand foreign tenants
8. operate the switchboard
9. read the meters
10. get on with the tenants

He was the first to come


VI. Paraphrase the following so as to use the infinitive.
eg He was the first who came. He was the first to come.
1. Kate was the last who saw him. 2. He was the first who broke the silence. 3. He was the first who
answered at the examination. 4.1 wonder who left the office last. 5.1 wonder who spoke at the meeting
first. 6. You will answer next. 7. She was the first who praised him. 8. He complained that he was always
the last who was informed. 9. He found that he was the only one who realized the danger. 10. Andrew was
the third who went in for the interview. 11. The first person who entered was Mrs Evans. 12. If there is a
vacancy I would like to be the one who will be offered the job.
VII. Make up sentences usinglikely, certain and sure + infinitive.
eg He is likely to arrive before dawn, eg He is sure to marry her. eg She is certain to get a scholarship, eg
He is not likely to come.

see + object + -ing, or see + object + infinitive without to


Make up short dialogues.
A: (with a note of doubt in his/her voice) Did he pay the bill?
(a) B: Well, I didn't actually see him paying it.
(b) B: Well, I didn't actually see him pay it.
35

Did he...
1. sign the cheque?
2. lock the door?
3. take the key?
4. read the instructions?
5. use the photocopier?
6. weigh the parcel?
7. post the letter?
8. burn the photographs?
9. copy the documents?
10. swallow the tablet?
11. drink the coffee?
12. cut the telephone cable?
13. open the safe?
14. take the money?

hear + object + -ing, or hear + object + infinitive without to


A: Are you sure Tom left?
(a) B: Yes, I heard him leaving.
(b) B: Yes, I heard him leave.
Are you sure...
1. Tom booked the tickets?
2. Jack invited Mrs Jones?
3. Mrs Jones accepted the invitation?
4. Mary told her husband?
5. the lift door shut?
6. Peter wound the clock?
7. the bell rang?
8. they accused Bill?
9. the bus stopped?
10. the ice cracked?
11. George spoke to Mary?
12. the passengers shouted at the driver?
13. the driver apologized?
14. Ann asked for the keys?
15. Peter complained about the delay?
36
16. the students laughed?

17. they opened the champagne?

Would rather
I. Answer these questions usingl'd prefer... or I'd rather... Use
the words in brackets for your answers.
eg Shall we walk? (prefer/go by car) I'd prefer to go by car. Shall we eat now (rather/eat a bit
later) I'd rather eat a bit later.
1. Shall we play tennis? (prefer/go for a swim)
2. Shall we watch television (rather/read a book)
3. Shall we leave now? (rather/wait for a few minutes)
4. Shall we go to a restaurant? (prefer/eat at home)
5. Shall we decide now? (rather/think about it for a while)
. Now you have to make sentences using I'd prefer... rather than... or I'd rather... than...
eg (walk/go by car) I'd rather walk than go by car.
(stay at home/go to the cinema) I'd prefer to stay at home rather than go to the cinema
1. (go for a swim/play tennis) I'd rather...
2. (read a book/watch television) I'd prefer...
3. (wait for a few minutes/leave now) I'd prefer...
4. (eat at home/go to a restaurant) I'd rather...
5. (think about it for a while/decide now) I'd prefer...

Had better
Read each sentence and make up a sentence with had better. eg You're going out for a walk with
Tom. You think you should take an umbrella because it might rain. What do you say to Tom?
We'd better take an umbrella.
eg Tom doesn't look very well. You don't think he should go to work today. What do you say to Tom?
You'd better not go to work today.
37

1. Ann suddenly begins to feel ill. You think she should sit down. What do you say to her?
2. You and Tom are going to the theatre. You've just missed the bus. You think you should take a taxi.
What do you say to Tom? We...
3. Ann wants to play the piano late at night. You know that she'll wake up the people next door. What do
you say to Ann?
4. You and Ann are going to a restaurant for a meal. You think you should reserve a table because the
restaurant might be crowded. What do you say to Ann?
5. Tom has just cut himself. You think he should put a plaster on the cut. What do you say to him?
6. You are by a river. It's a very warm day and your friend suggests going for a swim. You don't think you
should do this because the river looks very dirty. What do you say?

Uncompleted infinitives
(a) I've never met Rita but I'd like to.
In (a): I'd like to an uncompleted infinitive;
I'd like to meet Rita the understood completion.
Complete the sentences with the words in brackets. Use any appropriate tense, discuss the understood
meaning of the uncompleted infinitives.
1. A: Why didn't you go to the concert?
B: I (want, not) I didn't want to.
2.1 haven't written to my parents yet this week, but I (intend). 3. Did Jane enjoy the play? She (seem).
4. I'd like to buy fresh flowers for my desk every day, but I can't (afford). 5. I've never eaten at that
restaurant, but I (would like). 6. Want to go to the jazz festival with us tomorrow night? I (would love).
7. Are you going to the historical society meeting? Yes, I (plan). And you? 8. Oh!
I'm sorry I closed the door in your face! I (mean, not). 9.1 don't play with toys any more but I (use). 9.
Have you called Jennifer yet? That's the fourth time you've asked me. I (be going)! I (be going)! Don't
be a nag! 10. Tina doesn't feel like going to the meeting, but she (have) 11. Are you planning to go to the
market? No, but I suppose I (ought). 12. Why didn't you pay the bill for him? I (offer) but he
refused. 13. Why didn't you hit him? I (be afraid). 14. Why doesn't he try again? He (want, not).

Various infinitive constructions


Replace the group of words in italics by an infinitive or an infinitive construction.

It is important that he should understand this. It is important for him to understand this.
He was the first man who arrived. He was the first man to arrive.
1. The captain was the last man who left the ship. 2. He got to the top and was very disappointed when he
found that someone else had reached it first. 3. There are a lot of sheets that need mending. 4. I was
astonished when I heard that he had left the country. 5. It is better that he should hear it from you. 6. /
was rude to him, which was stupid. (It was stupid...) 7. If he had another child with whom he could play
he would be happier. 8. It is necessary that everyone should know the truth. 9. There was no place where
we could sit. 10. He put his hand into his pocket and was astonished when he found that his wallet wasn't
there. 11. He rushed into the burning house, which was very brave of him. (It was very brave...) 12.1 can't
go to the party; I have nothing that I can wear. 13. is expected that he will broadcast a statement
tonight. (He is expected...) 14.1 want a kitchen where (=in which) I can cook. 15. He reached the station
exhausted and was very disappointed when he learnt that the train had just left. 16. Haven't you anything
with which you could open if. 17. It seems that the crime was committed by a left-handed man. (The crime
seems... Use perfect infinitive passive.) 18. Is it likely that he will arrive before six? (Is he...) 19. It is said
thathe was a brilliant scientist. (He is said...) 20. It is advisable that we should leave the house
38

39
separately. 21. You signed the document without reading it, which was very stupid. (It was stupid...) 22. It
is said that she has a frightful temper. (She..) 23. He was the first man who swam the Channel. 24. They
believe that he is honest. (He...) 25.It appears that he was killed with a blunt instrument. (He appears...
Use passive infinitive.) 26. He was the only one who realized the danger. 27. It is said that the earth was
originally part of the sun. (The earth...) 28. It is said that he is hiding in the woods near your house. 29. It
is said that this palace was built in three years. This palace is said... 30. They expect thathe will arrive on
Tuesday. (He...). 31.1 knew that he was a boring man. (I knew...)

Self check
I. Insert to where necessary before the infinitive in brackets.
1. He made me (do) it all over again. 2. He will be able (swim) very soon. 3. You ought (go) today. It may
(rain) tomorrow. 4. He made her (repeat) the message. 5. They won't let us (leave) the Customs shed till
our luggage has been examined. 6. I used (smoke) forty cigarettes a day. 7. Will you help me (move) the
bookcase? 8. He is expected (arrive) in a few days. 9. Please let me (know) your decision as soon as
possible. 10. He made me (wait) for hours. 11. I'd like him (go) to a university but I can't (make) him
(go). 12. You seem (know) this area very well. Yes, I used (live) here. 13. The kidnappers told the
parents (not inform) the police, and the parents didn't dare (disobey). 14. I'm sorry (disappoint) you but I
can't (let) you (have) any more money till the end of the month. 15. It is easy (be) wise after the event. 16.
Do you (wish) (make) a complaint? 17. We don't (want) anybody (know) that we are here. 18. If you can't
(remember) his number you' d better (look) it up. 19.1 want her (learn) Esperanto; I think everybody
ought (know) it. 20. He is said (be) the best surgeon in the country. 21. Visitors are asked (not feed) the
animals. 22. He should know how (use) the film projector, but if he doesn't you had better (show) him.
23. He was made (sign) a paper admitting his guilt. 24.1 heard the door (open) and saw a shadow (move)
across the floor. 25. He tried (make) me (believe) that he was my stepbrother. 26. As we seem (have
missed) the train we may as well (go) back to the house. 27.1 felt the house
(shake) with the explosion. 28. Before he let us (go) he made us (promise) (not tell) anyone what we had
seen. 29. Would you (like) (come) in my car? No, thanks, I'd rather (walk). 30. I advised him (ask) the
bus conductor (tell) him where (get) off. 31. It is better (put) your money in a bank than (keep) it under
your bed in an old stocking. 32. Did you remember (give) him the money? No, I didn't, I still have it in
my pocket; but I'll (see) him tonight and I promise (not forget) this time. 33.1 saw the driver (open) his
window and (throw) a box into the bushes.
34. That is too heavy for one person (carry); let me (help) you.
35. The children were made (obey). 36. She was seen (cross) the street and (turn) round the corner. 37.1
didn't expect her (marry) him. 38. They were supposed (know) German well.
II. Choose the correct answer.
1. Are you sure you told me? I don't recall... about it.
A. having told C. to have told
B. having being told D. to have been told.
2. Dan appears... some weight. Has he been ill?
A. having lost C. to have lost
B. having been lost D. to have been lost

3. Tom made a mistake at work, but his boss didn't fire him. He's lucky... a second chance.
A. having given
B. having been given
C. to have given
D. to have been given
4. Dr Wilson is a brilliant dedicated scientist who had expected to be selected as the director of the
institute. She was very surprised not... the position.
A. having offered C. to have offered
B. having been offered D. to have been offered
5. By the time their baby arrives, the Johnsons hope... painting and decorating the new nursery.
A. having finished C. to have finished
B. having been finished D. to have been finished
40

41

6. We would like... to the president's reception, but we weren't.


A. having invited C. to have invited
B. having been invited D. to have been invited
7. The stockbroker denied... of the secret business deal.
A. having informed C. to have informed
B. having been informed D. to have been informed
8. George mentioned... in an accident as a child, but he never told us the details.
A. having injured C. to have injured
B. having been injured D. to have been injured
9. The Smiths wanted to give their son every advantage. However, they now regret... him by
providing too many material possessions.
A. having spoiled
B. having been spoiled
C. to have spoiled
D. to have been spoiled
10. The spy admitted... some highly secret information to enemy agents.
A. having given C. to have given
B. having been given D. to have been given
11. We were shocked to hear the news of your...
A. having fired C. to be fired
B. having been fired D. to have been fired
12. Marge's children are used to... after school every day. They don't have to walk home.
A. picking up C. be picked up
B. being picked up D. pick up
13. The bus driver was so tired of... the same route every day that he asked for a transfer.
A. to drive
B. being driven
. driving
D. drive
14. I'm sure it's not my fault that Peter found out what we were planning. I don't remember... anyone
about it.
42

A. having told C. to tell


B. being told D. to be told
15. Even though she was much younger than the other children, Alexis demanded... in the game they
were playing.
A. including C. to include
B. being included D. to be included
16. The baby continued... even after she was picked up.
A. being crying
B. having cried
C. to cry
D. having been crying
III. Put the verbs in brackets into gerund or infinitive.
1.1 used (ride) a lot but I haven't had a chance (do) any since (come) here. I ride sometimes.
Would you like (come) with me next time? 2. Most people prefer (spend) money to (earn) it. 3.1
resented (be) unjustly accused and asked him (apologize). 4. It isn't good for children (eat) too many
sweets. 5.1 didn't feel like (work) so I suggested (spend) the day in the garden. 6. Why do you keep
(look) back? Are you afraid of (be) followed? 7. Do you remember (post) the letter? Yes, I do; I
posted it in the letter-box near my gate. 8. Did you remember (lock) the door? No, I didn't. I'd

better (go) back and (do) it now. 9. You still have a lot (learn) if you'll forgive my'(say) so. 10. It's no
use (try) (interrupt) him. You'll have (wait) till he stops (talk). 11. I'm for (do) nothing till the police
arrive. They don't like you (move) anything when a crime has been committed. 12. He didn't like
(leave) the children alone in the house but he had no alternative as he had (go) out to work. 13. I'm
very sorry for (be) late. It was good of you (wait) for me. 14. I keep (try) (make) mayonnaise but I
never succeed. Try (add) the yolk of a hard-boiled egg. 15. Do you feel like (go) to a film or
would you rather (stay) at home? 16. He took to (get up) early and (walk) noisily about the house.
17.1 liked (listen) to folk music much better than (listen) to pop. 18. The car began (make) an
extraordinary noise so I stopped (see) what it was. 19. You'll never regret (do) a kind action. 20. He
decided (put) broken glass on top of his wall (prevent) boys (climb) over it. 21. He annoyed me very
much by (take) the piece of cake that I was keeping (eat) after my supper.
43

22. He kept (ring) up and (ask) for an explanation and she didn't know what (do) about him. 23. We
got tired of (wait) for the weather (clear) and finally decided (set) out in the rain. 24. He made me
(repeat) his instructions (make) sure that I understood what I was (do) after he had gone. 25. I
suggest (leave) the car here and (send) a breakdown van (tow) it to the garage. 26. She apologized for
(borrow) my sewing-machine without (ask) permission and promised never (do) it again. 27. I didn't
mean (offend) anyone but somehow I succeeded in (annoy) them all. 28. He never thinks of (get) out
of your way; he expects you (walk) round him. 29. You don't need (ask) his permission every time
you want (leave) the room. 30. The police accused him of (set) fire to the building but he denied
(have been) in the area on the night of the fire. 31. It's much better (go) to a hairdresser than (try)
(save) time by (cut) your own hair. 32. I'd rather (earn) my living by (scrub) floors than (make)
money by (blackmail) people. 33.1 always remember (turn) off all the lights before I leave my house.
34. I'll never forget (carry) my wife over the threshold when we moved into our first house. 35.1
regret (listen, not) to my father's advice. He was right. 36. We went for a walk after we finished
(clean) up the kitchen. 37. Sometimes students avoid (look) at the teacher if they don't want (answer)
a question. 38. The club members discussed (postpone) the next meeting until March. 39. Did Carol
agree (go) (camp) with you? 40. The taxi driver refuse (take) a check. He wanted the passenger (pay)
in cash. 41. The soldiers were ordered (stand) at attention. 42. The travel agent advised us (wait, not)
until August. 43.1 don't mind (wait) for you. Go ahead and finish (do) your work. 44. Keep (talk), I'm
listening to you. 45. The children promised (play) more quietly. They promised (make, not) so much
noise. 46. Linda offered (look after) my cat while I was out of town. 47. You shouldn't put off (pay)
your bills. 48. The doctor ordered Mr Gray (smoke, not). 49. Don't tell me his secret. I prefer (know,
not). 50. Could you please stop (whistle)? I'm trying (concentrate) on my work. 51. Did you
remember (turn off) the stove? 52. Jack was allowed (renew) his student visa. 53. Pat told us (wait,
not) for her. 54. Mr Buck warned his daughter (play, not) with matches. 55. Would you please remind
me (call) Alice tomorrow'? 56. I'm considering (drop) out of school, (hitchhike) to New York, and
(try) (find) a job. 57. Sally reminded me (ask) you (tell) Bob (remember) (bring)
44

his soccer ball to the picnic. 58. Alex broke the antique vase. I'm sure he didn't mean (do) it. 59. Mrs
Freeman can't help (worry) about her children. 60.1 appreciate your (take) the time to help me. 61.1
can't afford (buy) a new car. 62. Julie finally admitted (be) responsible for the problem. 63. She keeps
(promise) (visit) us, but she never does. 64.1 don't enjoy (laugh) at by other people. 65. I'm angry at
him for (tell, not) me the truth. 66. It is easy (fool) by his lies. 67. Sharon wants us (tell) her the news
as soon as we hear anything. If we find out anything about the problem, she wants (tell) about it
immediately. 68. You must tell me the truth. I insist on (tell) the truth. 69. Martha doesn't like to have
her picture taken. She avoids (photograph). 70. It's been nice talking to you. I really have enjoyed our
conversation, but I have to leave now. I'm very happy (have) this opportunity to meet you and talk
with you. 71. This letter needs (send) immediately. 72.1 thought Sam was sick. So did I. But he
seems (recover) very quickly. He certainly doesn't seem (be) sick now. 73. Last year I studied abroad.
I appreciate (have) the opportunity to live and study in a foreign country. 74. This year I am studying
abroad. I appreciate (have) this opportunity to live and study in a foreign country. 75. Mrs Jackson
complained about (tell, not) about the meeting. In the future, she expects (inform) of any and all
meetings. 76. The dog needs (wash). He's been digging in the mud. 77. Alice didn't expect (ask) to
Bill's party. 78. Matthew left without (tell) anyone. 79. It's useless. Give up. Enough's enough. Don't

keep (beat) your head against a brick wall. 80. His (be, not) able to come is disappointing. 81. I hope
(award) a scholarship for the coming semester. 82. We are very pleased (accept) your invitation. 83.
It is exciting (travel) to faraway places and (leave) one's daily routine behind. 84. He wants (like) and
(trust) by everyone. 85. I can't help (wonder) why Larry did such a foolish thing. 86. She admitted
(drive) too fast through the town. 87. Mr Carson is very lucky (choose) by the committee as their
representative to the meeting in Paris. 88. (Live) in a city has certain advantages. 89. It is very kind
of you (take) care of that problem for me. 90. She opened the window (let) in some fresh air. 91.1
don't remember ever (hear) this story before. 92. You should stop (drive) if you get sleepy. It's
dangerous (drive) when you're not alert. 93. After driving for three hours, ^e stopped (get) something
to eat. 94. Please forgive me for
45

(be, not) here to help you yesterday. 95. Polly was in the garden, so she didn't hear the phone (ring)
96. The guard observed a suspicious-looking man (come) into the bank. 97.1 was almost asleep last
night when I suddenly heard someone (knock) on the door. 98. I remember it distinctly. At 5:30
yesterday afternoon, I saw Jim (walk) to his car, (open) the door, and (get in). 99. I got Mary (lend)
me some money so I could go to a movie last night. 100. The teacher had the class (write) a 2000word research paper. 101. Susie pretended (be) asleep. She pretended (hear, not) me when I spoke to
her. 102. You seem (be) in a good mood today. 103. Janice is thinking about (look) for a new job.
104. Dick appears (have) a lot of money. 105. My father expects me (get) high marks in school. 106.
According to the sign on the restaurant door, all diners are required (wear) shirts and shoes. 107.1
appreciate your (pay) for my dinner. I'll pay next time. 108. Children shouldn't be allowed (watch)
violent programs on TV. 109. The sign warns you (turn, not) right on a red light. 110. After hearing
the weather report, I advise you (go, not) skiing this afternoon. 111. Janice misses (take) walks with
her father in the evening now that she has moved away from home.
IV. Translate from Russian into English.
Infinitive as subject, complement of subject
1. . 2. . 3.
. 4.
. 5. . 6.
. 7. . 8. . 9.
. 10. . 11.
. 12. . 13.
. 14. , . 15. :
- -? 16. . 17.
. 16. . 19.
46
? 20. . 21.
. 22. . 23.
, ? 24. ,
. 25. . 26.
. 27. . 28. ,
, . 29. . , , . 30.
. 31. . 32.
. . 33. ,
, . 34. , , .
35. , , , . 36.
. 37. -
.
Verb + infinitive
1. , . 2. . 3.
. 4. . 5.
. 6. . 7. ,
. 8. 7 . 9.

. 10. . 11.
. 12. . 13. . 14.
. 15. . 16.
. , . 17.
, . 18.
. 19. . 20. . 21.
, .
47

seem/happen/appear/prove/pretend + infinitive
1. , . 2. , . 3. . 4.
, . 5. . 6.
, . 7.
. 8. , . 9. ,
. 10. , , . 11. , ,
. 12. , . 13. , . 14. ,
. 15. ,
1986 . 16. , . 17. ,
. 18. , . 19. , ,
. 20. , -, . 21. , , . 22. , , . 23.
- . 24. , , . 25. , -, . 26.
. 27. . 28. ,
. 29. , . 30. , ,
. 31. , -, . 32. , ,
. 33. , , . 34. . 35.
. 36. . 37. ,
.
38. , , .
39. , , .
40. , , . 41. , -, . 42.
, . 43.
.
48

Verb + object + infinitive


I asked John to help me. I made/let him come. He was made to come. He was allowed to come.
1. . 2.
. 3. . 4. ,
. 5. . 6.
. 7. . 8. . 9.
. 10. . 11.
. 12.
. 13. . 14.
. 15. . 16. ,
.
17. , .
18. . 19.
. 20. . 21. . 22.
. 23. . 24.
, . 25. , . 26.
. 27. . 28.
. 29. . 30. .
I want you to come. I'd like you to come. I expect him to join us.
1. , . 2. , . 3.
, . 4. , . 5. ,
? 6. , . 7. , . 8.
, . 9.
49

, ? 10. , . 11. ,
. 12. , . 13.
, . 14. , . 15. ,
? 16. , . 17. ,
. 18. , .
I know him to be an honest man.
1. , . 2. , . 3. ,
. 4. , . 5. ,
? 6. , . 7. ,
. 8. , . 9.
. 10. , .
is said/supposed/thought, etc. to be clever.
1. , . 2. , . 3. ,
. 4. , . 5.
, . 6. , .
7. , 15 . 8. ,
. 9. , . 10. ,
. 11. , . 12. ,
. 13. , . 14. ,
. 15. ,
. 16. , .
50
The infinitive of purpose
1. , . 2. , .
3. 6 , . 4. ,
. 5. . 6. ,
. 7. , . 8. ,
. 9. , . 10.
, . 11. , ,
. 12. , . 13.
, . 14. ,
. 15. , . 16.
, . 17. , .
The infinitive after adjectives
1. . 2. , . 3. ,
. 4. , . 5. ,
. 6. , . 7. . 8. . 9.
, . 10. , . 11.
, -. 12. . 13.
, . 14. , . 15.
, . 16. . 17.
. 18. . 19. . 20. . 21.
( ). 22. . .
23. . .
51

The infinitive after nouns


1. - , ?
2. . 3. . 4.
, . 5. , ?
6. , . 7.
; . 8. . 9. .
. 10. , . .
. 12. . 13.
.
The infinitive after question words
1. , .

2. , . 3. , ? 4.
, . 5. ,
. 6. , . 7. , . 8.
, . 9. , . 10.
, .
See someone do and see someone doing
1. , -. 2. , . 3.
, . 4. , , ,
. 5. , ,
. 6. , , , . 7. ,
- . 8. , . 9.
, . 10. , ,
. 11. , 52
. 12. , . 13. (), . 14.
, . 15. ,
-. 16. , , - . 17.
, .
likely/unlikely/certain/sure + infinitive
1. , , . 2. ,
. 3. . 4. ,
. 5. , , . 6. . 7. ,
. 8. () . 9. .
10. , . 11.
. 12. , , 1- . 13.
. 14. , .
15. , . 16. ,
. 17. .
18. .
Would rather/had better + infinitive
1. . .
2. . . 3.
. ? 4.
? . 5. .
. 6. , .
7. . . 8.
? .
. 9. , . 10.
53
. . 11.
. , . 12. ?
. . 13.
, . . 14.
? , . . 15.
. . . 16.
. , .

Fluency
Listen, read and practise.
Computer Czazy
When Alan was ten he seemed to be very interested in computers. His mother knew that he would
love to have one, but she couldn't afford to buy him one. He learned how to use a friend's computer,
but he couldn't wait to get one of his own. His mother decided to give him a computer for his twelfth
birthday. At first she only let him use it for an hour a day. She didn't want it to damage his
eyes.
By the time Alan was fifteen he had become very good at using his computer, but it was his only
hobby. His mother wanted him to go out and do things, but he had very few friends. Nobody could

persuade him to do anything and nothing could make him turn his computer off.
In the end, his mother threatened to turn off the electricity. Alan went to bed and pretended to be
asleep, but at midnight he got up to work at the computer again. He didn't want to sleep or to eat. He
just couldn't bear to be away from his computer.
Alan's mother didn't know what to do. Her sixteen-year-old son had become a computer addict. Not
even the family doctor knew how to help. One morning Alan's mother found him lying on the
bedroom floor. He had collapsed with exhaustion. Two weeks in hospital finally made Alan realize
that his computer had become a dangerous obsession.
Now Alan is eighteen. He has lots of friends and hobbies. He
hopes to study computer science at university and would like to find a job in computer research.
A. Questions
1. Why didn't Alan's mother buy him a computer when he was ten? 2. When did his mother decide to
give him a computer? 3. How long did she let him use it? 4. Why didn't she let him use it for longer?
5. What made Alan's mother realize that he had become a computer addict? 6. What did she threaten
to do? 7. What did Alan do that night? 8. What made him realize that the computer had become an
obsession? 9. What does he hope to do next? 10. What would he like to do when he has finished
studying?
B. Read the text and then complete the sentences from the text.
When Alan was ten, he ... very interested in computers. His mother knew that he... one, but she
couldn't... him one. He learned ... a friend's computer, but he ... one of his own.
His mother... him a computer for his twelfth birthday. At first she only... it for an hour a day. She
didn't... his eyes. By the time Alan was fifteen he had become very good at using his computer, but it
was his only hobby. His mother... out and do things, but he had very few friends. Nobody could...
anything and nothing could ... his computer off.
In the end, his mother ... off the electricity. Alan went to bed and... asleep, but at midnight he got
up ... at the computer again. He didn't... or... He just couldn't... away from his computer.
Alan's mother didn't know ... Her sixteen-year-old son had become a computer addict. Not even the
family doctor knew ... One morning Alan's mother found him lying on the bedroom floor. He had
collapsed with exhaustion. Two weeks in hospital finally ... that his computer had become a
dangerous obsession.
Now Alan is eighteen. He has lots of friends and hobbies. He ... computer science atuniversity and...
ajob in computer research.
C. Complete the sentences about Alan with the correct form of make or let.
1. Before Alan had a computer, his friend... him use his. 2. When Alan was twelve, his mother... him
use the computer for an hour a day. 3. Then she ... him turn it off. 4. She said Alan shouldn't... the
computer damage his eyes. 5. At first, Alan ... his friends
play games on his computer. 6. Alan's friends tried to ... him go out with them, but he didn't want to.
7. His mother tried to... him take up other hobbies, but she couldn't persuade him. 8. The family
doctor couldn't... him change his attitude either. 9. A stay in hospital finally ... him realize that his
computer was ruining his life. 10. If he hadn't stopped when he did, Alan might have ... himself
extremely ill. 11. Alan... his obsession take over his life.
D. Study and practise the text.
E. SituationWork with a partner. Imagine that you have five friends who have problems, like Alan. With your
partner invent some problems and say how you tried to help. Write five sentences using the verbs
below + him/her + to + infinitive. Describe the problem first, like this:
We have a friend who wants to stop smoking, but he can't. We advised him to read some brochures
about the dangers of smoking.
1. advise 2. help 3. warn (not to) 4. persuade 5. invite
F. Whose future?
Alan hopes to study computer science at university. What do you hope to do when you leave school?
a) On a piece of paper, write a short paragraph, using some of the following verbs: hope, would like,
want, expect, prefer. Remember to use to after the verbs. Do not write your name on the paper:
After school I would like to go to America for a year. My favourite hobby is playing tennis. I hope to
be a professional tennis coach.

b) A pupil collects the papers and gives them to other pupils. Take turns to read the paragraph you
have been given to the class. If you think there is a mistake, correct it. Then try to guess who wrote it.
G. Mary and Rick don't know how to work with the computer. Complete what they say with a question
word (how, where, which etc.) + to, like this:
eg Rick: I don't know how to turn it on.
56
Rick: Do you know ... do first?
Mary: Yes, I do, but I'm not sure... put this disk.
Rick: I'd like to know... start this game.
Mary: There are so many keys. I don't know... press first.
Rick: We'll have to find out... make it start. Just press all the keys.
Mary: It's flashing! And it's making a funny noise! Do you know ... turn it off?
Rick: No. Let's look at the book. Perhaps that will tell us... do.
Mary: I don't know... look at first. There are at least five computer books on the shelf.
H. Make up sentences using (In order,) to + infinitive to show purpose or the reason why someone does
something. Use the prompts.
eg 10 Downing Street
I'm going to 10 Downing Street to talk to the Prime Minister, eg the kitchen
I'm going to the kitchen to wash the dishes.
Prompts: England, Moscow, France, Rome, China, the supermarket, the station, the post office, the
library, the shoe shop, the booking agency, the University, the bank.
~What's Wrong?
Jenny: What's wrong, Jane? You look upset.
Jane: I want to go sailing, but my aunt won't let me go. She's too strict. She lets Ben do everything,
and he's younger than me. Yesterday she let him watch TV until midnight. She makes me do the
washing up every day, but she never makes Ben do anything. It isn't fair.
Later, Jenny tells Nick about Jane's problem.
Jenny: Jane says that she wants to go sailing, but her aunt won't let her go. She says her aunt makes
her do the washing up every day but she never makes Ben do anything.
A. Questions
57

1. Why does Jane look upset? 2. What is she complaining of?


B. What do these things make you or others do? Use words from each list to make ten sentences.
eg Onions make my sister cry. Onions don't make me cry.
onions
puzzles
jokes
presents
toothache
quizzes
a new hair style
funny cartoons
exercise
sad films

you
me
make (s)
doesn't/don't make
some people

my sister
my friend

feel happy
laugh
cry
feel cross
think
feel tired
feel good

C. Say four things from the box that your parents let you do. Say four things that they don't let you do.
eg They let me have parties. They don't let me stay out late.
have parties
stay out late
go on holiday with friends
buy your own clothes
go out in the evenings alone
bring friends home
listen to loud music
wear whatever clothes you want
watch late films on TV
talk on the telephone for hours
spend lots of money on records

D. What do your parents make you do? What don't they make you do? Write a short paragraph. Here
are some ideas:
keep all your things in your room
help at home
get up early on Sundays
do homework every night
do the washing up
clean your shoes
58

Susan is ~WoZied
It's a fine spring day. Tom is sitting in his garden at home, marking some books.
Susan: Tom? Do you think you could come into the kitchen for a second? There's something I'd like
you to look at.
Tom: What? Just let me finish these books and I'll be right there.
Susan: Would you mind coming right away, please? It's the washing machine. It's making a funny
noise. I want you to listen to it. I'm worried.
Tom: Oh, no! Not again. (In kitchen now. Tom has to shout above a loud whirring and pumping
noise) It's the pump, that's what it is.
Susan: I can't hear you. Let me turn the machine off!
Tom: The pump isn't working properly. What do you want me to do about it?
Susan: What do I want you to do about it? Repair it, of course. You don't think I made you leave your
work for nothing, do you?
Tom: But I'm not a mechanic. Why don't you ring the shop where we bought the thing? Ask them to
repair it.
Susan: Are you sure that's what you want me to do?
Tom: Of course I'm sure? Why do you ask?
Susan: Because the last time they came you got very angry.
Tom: Did I?
Susan: Yes. It was a small question of money. Don't you remember? The men were only here for half
an hour but they still charged 8 for an hour's work. You didn't like that at all.
Tom: Oh? Hmm ... yes. I remember now.
A. Questions
1. Why is Susan worried about the washing machine? 2. What exactly does she want Tom to do about
it? Ask why! 3. What does he want her to do? 4. What happened the last time something went wrong
with the machine?
B. Study and practise the conversation.
59
. Make progressive substitutions. Let me finish these books.
help you
stay here
him
me
repair your bike do it
her
think
I'd like you to look at the washing machine.
help me
to come
her
him
phone us
go abroad
buy the tickets
you
them
study German
stay with us
make a cake
There's something I'd like you to look at.
do
read
remember cook
see
type
think over listen to
forget
pay attention to

Do need a Ride?
Jim: Hi,-Keiko.
Keiko: Oh, hi, Jim.
Jim: What are you reading?
Keiko: A mystery. "Murder on the Nile" by Agatha Christie.
Jim: That reminds me. Can you tell me where the library is?
Keiko: Yeah. It's on Young Street across the City Hall.
Jim: You don't know what time it closes, do you?
Keiko: Gee, no, I don't. I always have Sandra return my books. She goes there all the time.
Jim: Sandra?
Keiko: Sandra Green. The new designer. She does a lot of research at the library.
Jim: Oh, I haven't met her yet.
Keiko: I'll introduce you. You'll like her. She's very nice. Say, don't forget the meeting at Butler's
Department Store
60
this afternoon. It's at 2:00. Jim: Oh, right. Do you need a ride? Keiko: No. Jessica made me
promise to get there early, so I'll
probably leave about 1:00. I'll get Sandra to give me
a ride. She has to be there early, too. Jim: OK. See you this afternoon.
A. What can you infer from the conversation? Answer "I think so " or "I don't think so ". Give
reasons for your answers, as in the example.
Jim often borrows books from the library.
I don't think so, because he doesn't know where the library is.
1. Jim and Keiko work together. 2. Jessica is their boss. 3. Keiko and Sandra are probably friends. 4.
Jim and Sandra work in the same room. 5. Sandra gets ideas for new clothing designs from books in
the library. 6. Keiko drives to work every day.
B. Study and practise the conversation.
C. Pretend you are talking to someone you do not know very well. Make these questions more polite.
Can you tell me Could you
Where's the library? tell me I wonder if you
could tell me

where

the library is?


the library is.

\. When does the library open? 2. What time does it close? 3. What kind of books do they have? 4.
Which floor are the mysteries on? 5. Who should I talk to to get a library card? 6. How much does a
library card cost? 7. What information does the librarian need? 8. How long can I keep a book?
D. There are many ways to tell someone to do something. Look at these sentences from the
conversation. Then make sentences about Jim and his mother.
Ask:
I always have Sandra return my books.
Persuade: I'll get Sandra to give me a ride.
Force:
Jessica made me promise to get there early.
61
1. When Jim was a little boy, his mother had a lot of rules for him. What did she make him do?
Mother. Finish your homework before dinner. Clean your
room every Saturday. Brush your teeth before you go to bed. Promise to go to bed by 10:00.
2. When Jim went to college, he was very busy so he persuaded his mother to help him. What did he
get his mother to do?
Jim: Mom, could you do my laundry, please? I have a huge test tomorrow and I really have to study.
Would you iron my clothes, please, Mom? You iron so well, and I do it so badly. Mom, could you
lend me $10? I'll pay you back tomorrow. Really, I will. You're really a terrific mother. Say, could
you mend my shirt? You sew so well.
3. Today, Jim lives alone and his mother lives far away. He doesn't have time to do some things, and
he doesn't know how to do other things. What does he have other people do for him?
Jim
Please paint my apartment. Please fix my car. Please clean my house. Please take care of
my garden.

You're "Driving Too Fast Bert and Jill are in Bert's sports car. He is driving very fast.
Jill: Bert... uh... don't you think you should slow down a bit?
Bert: Slow down? What do you want me to do that for?
Jill: But the speed limit is 70 and you're doing at least 80 and...
Bert: Look! I've told you before that you mustn't talk to me while I'm driving. I can't concentrate!
Jill: But the speed limit...
Bert: And you don't have to tell me what the speed limit is, either. I know all about it!
Jill: I only want you to slow down a bit. And there's something else. There's a pol...
Bert: When I'm in my car, I'm the boss! So if you don't want me to lose my temper, keep quiet.
Jill: All right, Bert.
62

Bert: I don't want you or anyone to tell me how to drive. Jill: No, Bert, (a pause. Suddenly there is
the sound of a police car horn.)
Bert: Good Lord! What's that? Jill: A police car, Bert. They're following you. I think they
want you to stop. Bert: A police car! Why didn't you tell me? Do you want me
to lose my driving-licence?
Jill: But that's why I wanted you to slow down before, Bert. I saw the car behind us and tried to tell
you, but you said I mustn't talk to you while you're driving. A, Questions
I. What is the speed limit and how fast is Bert driving? 2. What does Bert say when Jill tries to say
something about the speed limit? 3. What exactly does Jill want Bert to do? 4. What does the police
car want Bert to do?
B. Recall the sentences with "want someone to do something".
C. Study and practise the conversation.
D. Make sentences with "want someone to do something".
1. Richard thinks everyone should understand science. Why does he often buy his son books on
science? 2. The boys don't want to work. Why is their father shouting at them? 3. It is five o'clock
and Jane's boss has a lot of letters to be typed this evening. Why is he phoning Jane? 4. When Jill was
8, she still could not read. Why did her father get a special teacher for her? 5. Two students in a
language class do not understand a word in the text. Why are they holding up their hands? 6. Lady
Ottoway has a young daughter, Caroline. Lady Ottoway always invites rich, young men to dinner.
Why? 7. Richard never used to be on time in his job. Why did his wife buy him an alarm clock when
he got a new job? 8. Richard's son cannot go to sleep. Why is his mother singing to him?
E. Make progressive substitutions. Follow the model. They don't want him to hear.
63
1. We
2. He
3. me
4. us
5. know
6. find out
7. them
8. her
9. see it 10. have it
What Do You Want to Be ?
1.
Jenny: What do you want to be?
Jane: Dad wants me to be a dentist but I want to be a doctor. I'm learning to do first aid. It won't be
easy, but I have decided to work hard at school. What about you? What would you like to do?
Jenny: Well, I like reading. I would like to study languages and literature. I hope to go to university.
Then I would like to work abroad for a while. Uncle Joe has offered to help me. He could help me to
get a job in the States.
Jane: Will your parents allow you to leave England?
Jenny: Why not? They would prefer me to stay here, but it's up to me. And what about Ben?
Jane: He has decided to become Prime Minister.

A. Study and practise the conversation. 2.


Max: I want to be a mechanic. I like repairing cars. I would like to have my own garage one day. I
don't want to go to university. My uncle has offered to give me a job at his garage.
Marion: I hope to study biology and chemistry. I love doing experiments. I would like to be a
research scientist one day. I hope I'll manage to get a job at a university
Dave: We can't afford to buy many things at home, so I would like to have a job that pays well
like a pop star. I'm learning to play the guitarI'm pretty good. I would love to buy a big house for
my family.
Jill: I don't like being indoors. I would hate to have ajob in an office. I would prefer to be a gardener.
I have decided to leave school next year. I don't want to do any more exams.
A. Say the answers to the questions in full sentences.
eg What does Max want to be? He wants to be a mechanic.
eg What would Dave love to buy?
He would love to buy a big house for his family.
1. Who wants to be a research scientist? 2. What is Dave learning to play? 3. Who doesn't want to do
any more exams? 4. What would Marion like to get? 5. What would Dave like to be? 6. What does
Marion hope to study? 7. Who would prefer to have an outdoor job? 8. What has Jill decided to do?
9. What would Max like to have one day? 10. What has Max's uncle offered to do?
B. Complete the sentences with the verbs in brackets. Use to + infinitive or an -ing form.
1. Max has decided (become) a mechanic, because he likes (repair) cars. 2. Max's uncle has offered
(give) him ajob, but he would like (have) his own garage one day. 3. Marion wants (be) a research
scientist because she likes (do) experiments. She would like (go) to university. She hopes (study)
biology and chemistry. 4. Jill would love (have) an outdoor job. She doesn't like (stay) indoors. She
has decided (leave) school next year. She would love (be) a gardener. 5. Dave is learning (play) the
guitar. He hopes (become) a pop star, because he likes (write) music. He wants (earn) a lot of money
because he would like (buy) a big house for his family.
C. What do/don '(you like doing? What would/wouldn 't you like to be?
D. Say eight sentences about yourself using the to + infinitive form. Use words from the lists or use your
own ideas.
eg I have decided to do all the housework.
have offered can (not) afford have decided (not) hope
buy a motor bike/car/boat do all the housework stay out late
become a film star/rock star/international model
64
65

have promised (not) spend lots of money on clothes/shoes have (not) agreed
read every play by
Shakespeare would (not) like
do nothing all day (don't) want
live in the mountains
can (not) manage
study physics at university
write a book about gardening become an opera singer learn every word in the English language play
professional basketball
E. Conflicts
What do they want to do?
What do other people want them to do?
Write the answers.
eg Jenny: I'm going to the cinema on Saturday.
Jane: Why don't you go to the theatre with me instead?
Jenny wants to go to the cinema, but Jane wants her to go to the theatre.
1. Tom: I'm going to the music shop.
Nick: Why don't you go to the fun-fair with me instead?
2. Jane: I'm staying at home tonight.
Amanda: That's boring. Go to the basketball game with me.
3. Ben:
I want to go to the air show on Sunday. Tom: Can't you go with me on Saturday?
4. Jenny: I'm going to watch television now. Amanda: Let's go to the snack bar instead.
5. Ben:
I'm going to give my old computer games to my
cousin. Amanda: Oh? Can't you give them to me?

6. Mike: I'm going to visit my friends in London tomorrow. Sue:


Can't you visit them next
week instead?
7. Jane: I'm going to the swimming pool.
Ben:
But you said you would help me with my chemistry.
F. I'dlike them to...
What would you like other people to do? Say two things that
66
you would like each of these people to do: your friend; your parents (father/ mother); your brother
(sister).
I'm bored
Jenny: Hi. How are you?
Amanda: Bored. What are you going to do today?
Jenny: Well, do you want to play tennis?
Amanda: My racket's broken and I can't afford to buy another one.
Jenny: Do you feel like swimming?
Amanda: I can't stand swimming. You get all wet.
Jenny: Jane has invited us to go riding with her.
Amanda: I don't know how to ride. Tom offered to teach me once but the horse kicked me as soon as
I went near. I refused to carry on.
Jenny: Nick wanted us to go to the zoo with him ...
Amanda: I'm against keeping animals in zoos. I stopped visiting zoos two years ago.
Jenny: I don't know what to suggest. You don't want to do anything.
Amanda: Exactly! That's why I'm so bored.
A. Recall the sentences with the gerund and the infinitive.
B. Study and roleplay the conversation.
C. Complete the story about the inventor Thomas Edison with to + infinitive or an -ing form.
Thomas Edison was one of the greatest inventors of all time. But as a child, he didn't enjoy (go) to
school. When Edison was only seven, the headmaster decided (expel) him because he refused (do)
his school work. He only went to school for three months, but he never stopped (learn). His mother
managed (teach) him the most important things, and she persuaded him (read) about science. He
didn't mind (stay) at home and he enjoyed (read). He couldn't afford (buy) the books ' needed, so at
twelve he began (sell) newspapers and sweets in trains.
He loved (do) experiments, and he set up a laboratory in the luggage van of a train. When he was
older, he invented the phonograph and the light bulb,
67
Do you know the story of Edison and the egg? He wanted (boil) his egg himself, so he asked his
housekeeper (bring) an egg and a pan of hot water to his laboratory. She told him (not forget) about
the egg. He seemed (listen) to her. But when she returned half an hour later he was boiling his watch
and timing it with the egg.
D. Use the verbs in brackets with to + infinitive or an -ing form to complete the questions.
1. Are you for (smoke) in public places? 2. Are you against (advertise) cigarettes? 3. Do you dislike
(breathe) other people's smoke? 4. Would you refuse (let) people smoke in a car? 5. Do you mind
people (smoke) around you? 6. Do most people start (smoke) too young? 7. Should shopkeepers
refuse (sell) cigarettes to children? 8. Can most smokers manage (stop) smoking? 9. Do smokers risk
(damage) their health? 10. Are most teenagers persuaded (smoke) by their friends?
'Planning a "Wedding "Reception Lynn is talking to Gina's fiance, Frank.
Lynn: You know, I love going to weddings especially the
receptions. I like to have a good time, and I love to
dance. Frank: Well, I hope you'll have a good time at our wedding. I
prefer to have a big wedding, but Gina wants a small
one. Lynn: Oh, a small wedding will be nice. When are you going
to start planning the reception. Frank: Soon, I think. In fact, I think Gina is going to ask for
your help. You know Gina she hates organizing
parties. Lynn: Yeah, and she'll probably continue to work until the
last minute, too, so she'll need some help. Frank: You're right. Lynn: Well, I'd be glad to help. In

fact, I'm going to begin


thinking about it right now. Frank: That's great, because I can't stand to plan parties
either.
A. Both answers in each sentence are correct, but which ones did you hear? After you check your
choices, read the conversation two ways, once with infinitives and once with gerunds.
Lynn: You know, I love (to go/going) to weddingsespecially
the receptions. I like (to have/having) a good time, and
I love (to dance/dancing). Frank: Well, I hope you'll have a good time at our wedding. I
prefer (to have/having) a big wedding, but Gina wants
a small one.
Lynn: Oh, a small wedding will be nice. When are you going
to start (to plan/planning) the reception? Frank: Soon, I think. In fact, I think Gina is going to ask for
your help. You know Gina she hates (to organize/
organizing) parties. Lynn: Yeah, and she'll probably continue (to work/working)
until the last minute too, so she'll need some help. Frank: You're right.
Lynn: Well, I'd be glad to help. In fact, I'm going to begin
(to think/thinking) about it right now. Frank: That's great, because I can't stand (to plan/planning)
parties either.
B. Study and practise the conversation.
A letter Dear Dennis,
We just wanted to say thank you for putting us up before we caught the plane last week. It was a
lovely evening, and we enjoyed meeting your friends, Pete and Sarah. We managed to get to the
airport with plenty of time to spare. We even tried to get an earlier flight, but it wasn't possible.
We had a wonderful holiday in Spain. We just loved driving through the countryside, and we often
stopped to walk round a mountain village. We met our friends, Bill and Sue, and they invited us to
have a meal with them. They wanted us to stay with them, but we couldn't, as we had already booked
a hotel. The Weather was fantastic. The sun didn't stop shining all the time We were there. Leaving
Spain was very sad. It made me want to cry. Anyway, we're looking forward to hearing from you, and
69
hope to see you soon. Let us know if you're ever in the area. You must call in.
Best wishes, Sandra
A. Analyse the use of the infinitive and gerund in the text.
B. Study and practise the text.
C. Make sentences with both "stop doing " and "stop to do "for each situation like this.
Lawrence Morrel was typing when his wife came in. "You must eat something," she said. He stopped
and ate a sandwich. He stopped typing. He stopped to eat.
1. Everybody was working in the office. Then the tea-woman came in. 2. The painter finished a detail
in the picture. Then he had a cigarette. 3. The gardener cut some more grass. Then he looked at the
lawn. 4. Peter and his wife were arguing. Then the doorbell rang. 5. The speaker's throat became very
dry. He drank some wine. 6. The director, in the middle of a sentence, lit his cigar. 7. The student
threw his books down and went for a walk. 8. The librarian put her book down and answered my
question. 9. In the middle of the lesson, the teacher went over to the window and closed it.
I'd rather Watch a Soap
Gina: Do yon watch that show every week?
Victoria: Yes. Did you like it?
Gina: Not really. I don't care much for soap operas.
Victoria: What kind of programs do you like?
Gina: Well, I don't watch much television, but I like either news or science programs programs
with information for the audience. Soap operas are usually too confusing.
Victoria: I'd rather watch a soap. You don't have to think about it and it's entertaining.
Gina: Frank takes after you. He watches more soap operas and TV movies than anybody I know.
He says his job is so demanding that he doesn't want to come home at night and think. He wants to
be entertained.
70

Victoria: I can understand that.

Gina: Oh, I can, too. But I guess I like being both entertained and informed. For example, there was a
program about Mexico on last week. On one hand, it showed beautiful pictures of different places
around the country. And on the other hand, it gave statistics about tourism and travel costs. Neither
soap operas nor TV movies offer me that.
A. Questions
I. Who likes soap operas? 2. Who doesn't care for soap operas? 3. Who likes to be entertained? 4.
Who likes to be informed, and learn things from TV programs?
B. Study and practise the conversation.
C. Choose the correct answer.
1. When I told Tim the news he seemed ...
A. surprise
B. to be surprised
2. Mrs Thompson is always willing to help, but she doesn't
want... at home unless there is an emergency.
A. to call
B. to be called
3. The children agreed... the candy equally.
A. to divide
B. to be divided
4. Janice is going to fill out an application. She wants ... for
the job.
A. to consider
B. to be considered
5.1 expected ... to the party, but I wasn't.
A. to invite
B. to be invited
6. The mail is supposed ... at noon.
71

A. to deliver
B. to be delivered
7.1 expect... at the airport by my uncle.
A. to meet
B. to be met
8. Mr Steinberg offered... us to the train station.
A. to drive
B. to be driven
9. The children appear... about the trip.
A. to excite
B. to be excited
10. Your compositions are supposed ... in ink.
A. to write
B. to be written
11. Instead of... about the good news, Tom seemed to be indifferent.
A. exciting
B. being excited
C. to excite
D. to be excited
12. The new students hope... in many of the school social activities.
A. including
B. being included
C. to include
D. to be included
13. You'd better save some money for a rainy day. You can't count on... by your parents every time you
get into financial difficulty.
A. rescuing
B. being rescued

C. to rescue
D. to be rescued
14. Please forgive me. I didn't mean ... you.
A. upsetting
B. being upset
C. to upset
D. to be upset
15.1 don't remember... of the decision to change the company policy on vacations. When was it decided?
A. telling
B. being told
C. to tell
D. to be told
16. Mrs Drake expects... about any revisions in her manuscript before it is printed.
A. consulting
B. being consulted
C. to consult
D. to be consulted
17. Sally gave such a good speech that I couldn't resist... loudly when she finished.
A. applauding
B. being applauded
C. to applaud
D. to be applauded
18. If you want to develop inner tranquillity, you have to stop ... by every little thing that happens.
A. bothering
B. being bothered
C. to bother
D. to be bothered
19. Anne hoped... to join the private club. She could make important business contacts there.
A. inviting
B. being invited
72
73

C. to invite
D. to be invited

Why Are you Studying English?


Mrs Brennan: Why did you come to the United States, Roberto?
Roberto:
To study English.
Mrs Brennan: Why do you want to learn English?
Roberto:
So I can travel around the world.
Mrs Brennan: Do you want to do anything with your English besides travel?
Roberto:
Well, of course I'm studying English in order
to do a better job. I'm a reporter and I meet people from many different countries. I often have to
speak to them in English.
Mrs Brennan: How about you, Lynn?
Lynn:
I'm here to learn English, too. I want to speak
English perfectly so that I can work here in the United States as a photographer.
Mrs Brennan: Why are you studying English, Lucy?
Lucy:
So I can speak to my patients.
Mrs Brennan: Any other reasons?
Lucy:
Yes. To speak to my kids and their friends and
teachers. We live here now and my kids speak better English than I do. And besides, you have to
speak English in order to succeed in an English-speaking country.
A. Recall the sentences expressing purpose or reason.
B. Study and practise the conversation.
C. Match the two halves of the sentences.
eg 1. Sally's going to the airport

g) to meet a friend from New York


1 Sally's going to the airport
2. I've got to go to the library
3. Sam's gone to the station
4. I'm going to the newsagent's
a) to see Youcef s family.
b) to get the train to York.
c) to learn Italian.
d) to buy some aspirin.
74

5. We're going to the cafeteria


6. She's gone to the post office
7. I've got to go to the chemist's
8. She's gone to the medical centre
9. We're going to Algeria
10. They went to evening classes
e) to see the doctor.
f) to buy a magazine.
g) to meet a friend from New York. h) to post a parcel.
i) to return my books. j) to have a cup of tea.

C. to invite
D. to be invited
Why are you studying English?
Mrs Brennan: Why did you come to the United States, Roberto?
Roberto:
To study English.
Mrs Brennan: Why do you want to learn English?
Roberto:
So I can travel around the world.
Mrs Brennan: Do you want to do anything with your English besides travel?
Roberto:
Well, of course I'm studying English in order
to do a better job. I'm a reporter and I meet people from many different countries. I often have to
speak to them in English.
Mrs Brennan: How about you, Lynn?
Lynn:
I'm here to leam English, too. I want to speak
English perfectly so that I can work here in the United States as a photographer.
Mrs Brennan: Why are you studying English, Lucy?
Lucy:
So I can speak to my patients.
Mrs Brennan: Any other reasons?
Lucy:
Yes. To speak to my kids and their friends and
teachers. We live here now and my kids speak better English than I do. And besides, you have to
speak English in order to succeed in an English-speaking country.
A. Recall the sentences expressing purpose or reason
B. Study and practise the conversation.
C. Match the two halves of the sentences
eg 1. Sally's going to the airport
g) to meet a friend from New York
1 Sally's going to the airport
2 I've got to go to the library
3 Sam's gone to the station
4 I'm going to the newsagent's
a) to see Youcef s family
b) to get the tram to York.
c) to learn Italian
d) to buy some aspirin
5 We're going to the cafeteria
6 She's gone to the post office
7 I've got to go to the chemist's
8 She's gone to the medical centre
9 We're going to Algeria
10 They went to evening classes
e) to see the doctor
f) to buy a magazine.
g) to meet a friend from New York, h) to post a parcel

i) to return my books j) to have a cup of tea

D. Match the two parts of the sentences Then continue them with so (that) or in order to, changing
words where necessary.
eg I The police use hidden cameras 2 She gave me her telephone number
3 Keep your voices down
4 We got up early
5 He shut the door quietly
6 I'm going on a diet
7 Take a map with you
8 My wife's working overtime
a) people won't hear our conversation
b) I want to lose weight
c) we can have a holiday this year
d) I could phone her at work
e) they want to catch speeding motorists
f) we wanted to catch the 8 o'clock train
g) he wouldn't wake the baby h) you won't get lost

E. Adam wrote a list of things to do. Use Adam's list to say what he has got to do.
Things to do
75

1. cash cheque
2. buy toothpaste
3. buy stamps
4. collect photos
5. buy birthday card for Mum
6. return video
7. buy newspaper
8. book ticket
eg He's got to go to the bank to cash a cheque.
Discuss other reasons why you can go to a bank, a post office a chemist's or a newsagent's.
A. You can go to a bank to get travellers' cheques. : Or to change money.
Make a list of five things you have got to do m the next few days at different places. Then talk about
them.
A: I've got to go to the chemist's.
B. Really. Why?
A: To buy some aspirin and a new toothbrush.
F. Talk to your classmates and take notes.
NOTES
NOTES NOTES
1 . why they came
to this school 2.
why they are
studying English

Lynn to learn
English so she
can travel around
the world and
take pictures

Now report your findings to the class.


"What to "Do in Scotland
Maurice: I've been to see a travel agent. I asked him about where to go in Scotland and what to do
there on a first visit. He gave me all these brochures.
Enrico: Oh, fine. That's just what we need for our trip. "Where to stay: bed and breakfast", "What to
do in Edinburgh", "How to find your way in the Highlands".
Maurice: And this will be very useful, too. I got it at that new bookshop. "Scotland: 1001 things to
see". It tells you all about where to go, castles and museums to visit, walks to take, and so on. In the
agency they also told me who to write to for more publications it's the Scottish Board in
Edinburgh.
Enrico: Well, with all this information, we shall certainly know how to make the most of our
holiday ...
Maurice:... and how to spend all our money!

A. Questions
1. What are Maurice and Enrico going to do? 2. What brochures did Maurice get? 3. What sort of
information does the brochure "Scotland: 1001 things to see" contain?
B. Recall all the infinitives after question words used in the conversation.
C. Roleplay the conversation
D. Do some exercises. Use the infinitive after question words
I 1. At the bank
Annegret- Where can I change money, please?
The bank clerk told her where to change money.
1. Who do I ask about money transfers? 2.Which counter shall I go to? 3. Where can I cash travellers'
cheques? 4. How do I open an account? 5. Where must I sign the form? 6. How do I use a cheque book?
2. At the post office
AH: How do I register this parcel?
The assistant told him how to register a parcel.
1. Where can I get special issue stamps 9 2. How do I make a telephone call to Egypt? 3. Where can I get a
postal order? 4. How much postage do I have to put on this letter? 5. Where can I register this parcel? 6.
Which counter can I send a telegram from?
3. A trip to Scotland
Mikis: Are you going to Scotland by train or plane? Maurice: We haven't decided yet whether to go by
train or plane.
1. Are you going to hire a car?
2. Where are you going to stay?
3. When are you leaving?
4. How long are you staying?
5. Are you going to stay in hotels or bed and breakfast places?
6. Are you going to Shetland Islands?
We haven't decided yet. We don't know. We haven't decided yet. We haven't decided. We don't know.
We haven't decided.

Fancy That!
(First Old Man=First; Second Old Man=Second; Bus Conductor Bus C.)
First:
Did you see that schoolgirl who got off then?
Second: What about her?
First.
She looked more like a boy than a girl!
Second: I think it's the other way around. All the boys look
77

more like girls these days. It's all that long hair!
First: The trouble is these days they don't teach the girls how to cook or how to take care of children
or even how to keep house!
Second: My granddaughter's going to university. She's learning how to build bridges and things like
that! Fancy that! A girl learning how to be an engineer!
First: Things aren't what they used to be, are they?
Second: No, they aren't. Everything's upside down these days. People haven't even got good
manners any more. Look at the way children act.
First: That's right! Why don't they teach the girls to behave like ladies and the boys to behave like
gentlemen!
Second: Exactly!
Bus C.: Excuse me. Would one of you give a passenger your seat? She's a mother with a baby and
you're nearest the door. It'll only be for a few minutes!
First: What? Give up my seat? Me!
Second: Tell her to stand! I'm not giving up my seat to anyone!
A. Questions
1. What are some of the things one of the men thinks girls should learn? (cook/children/house) 2.
What does the other man say about his granddaughter? 3. What is the first old man's question
beginning with "Why don't they ...?" (girls/like ladies etc.) 4. Now mention some of the things you
learned how to do in school. 5. What are some of the things you think schools should teach girls how

to do? 6. What are some of the things you think everyone who gets a "modern" education should
learn how to do?
B. Study the conversation and roleplay it in class
C. Make a sentence with show or tell or ask for these situations, like this.
Situation: A secretary does not know how to use a new machine. The representative of the firm that
makes them is demonstrating it.
Response : He is showing her how to use it.
1. A man asked me where the bus station was. I said: "Go down the road, then turn right."
2. Larry is training two Indian machinists. He is operating a machine and they are watching.
3. A sergeant has two soldiers in front of him. He is taking a rifle to pieces, bit by bit.
4. Bert is trying to fix his brakes. He has a problem so he is going to phone a friend who knows a lot
about such things.
5. The man who installed my new TV set pointed out all the controls and demonstrated them.
6. A week ago I had no idea how to do the new dance. Then Jane demonstrated it for me.
youth hostels
Peter: Have you ever stayed in youth hostels?
John: Yes, of course. It's a cheap way to see a country. But it
isn't a holiday for lazy people. You have your own beds
to make and your room to clean. Peter: And you sometimes get quite a lot of jobs to do. John: Yes,
that's true. Sometimes it's a lot of fun. Last year
in a youth hostel in Germany, I was given 10 kilos of
potatoes to peel! I'm very good at it now! Peter: Yes, that's a terrible job. You usually get dirty dishes
to wash or floors to clean. John: At some youth hostels you always get a lot of work to
do, at others you only get a little. My friend has made
a list of the best youth hostels to stay at where there's
no work to do!
A. Recall the sentences with the infinitive after nouns.
B. Study and practise the conversation.
C. John would like to go to the cinema, but nobody has time to go with him. All the students have
other things to do.
Helen is going to write some letters.
Helen: Sorry, but I have some letters to write.
1. Mary is going to iron some shirts. 2. Mike is going to finish some exercises. 3. Betty is going to
learn a poem. 4. Dick is going
78
79

to write an essay. 5. Tom is going to keep an appointment in town. 6. Kate is going to make some
phone calls. 7. Jane is going to clean her room. 8. Lucy is going to cook a meal for friends. 9. Bob is
going to finish a library book. 10. Pam is going to wash some clothes. 11. Dan is going to repair his
brother's bicycle.
D. Make similar sentences.
eg There are a lot of museums to visit, (which you can visit) I have an exercise to do. (which I must
do)
We'll Be late
In the station buffet
Michael: Come on, Susan! Hurry up! Drink your coffee! The train's leaving in a minute. We'll be
late!
Susan: I can't finish it. It's much too hot for me to drink.
Michael: Why don't you put some milk in?
Susan: I don't like white coffee ... oh... OK.
Michael: There! Is it cool enough for you to drink now?
Susan: Yes... but it tastes awful!
On the platform
Susan: Oh! There's the train ... bring the cases.
Michael: Ooh! What have you got in these cases?

Susan: Only clothes. Why? Are they heavy?


Michael: Yes, they are!
Susan: The taxi driver managed to carry them.
Michael: Well, they're too heavy for me to carry.
Susan: Well, I'm not strong enough to help you ... Porter!
On the train
Susan: Oh, Michael... I didn't tell you. My sister phoned yesterday.
Michael: Oh? Which sister? Andrea?
Susan: Yes... she wants to get married.
Michael: Married! But she isn't old enough to get married. She's only seventeen. Who's she going to
marry?
Susan: Basil Caraway.
Michael: Basil Caraway! I don't believe it! He's much too old for her. He's over sixty!
Susan: I know ... but she loves him!
At their destination
Susan: Oh, no! That was the last bus home! And we've missed it!
Michael: Well, let's walk ... it's a nice, warm evening.
Susan: It's four miles! It's too far forme to walk. Call a taxi!
Michael: A taxi! My name isn't Rockfeller! We aren't rich enough to travel everywhere by taxi.
Susan: Michael! You've forgotten something!
Michael: What?
Susan: We've got three suitcases. Do you really want to walk? Michael: OK... OK... Taxi!.
A. Recall the sentences with too and enough + infinitive.
B. Study and practise the conversation.
C. Join the sentences using too and enough. eg He can't lift the table. It's very heavy.
The table is too heavy for him to lift.
1. They can't drink the tea. It's very hot. 2. She can't buy the coat. It's too expensive. 3. He can't
answer it. It's very difficult. 4.1 can't see it. It's very small. 5. The soup is too salty. She can't eat it. 6.
The text is very difficult. I can't translate it. 7. The problem is very complicated. We can't solve it. 8.
The book is too boring. He can't read it.
eg My son is too young. He can't get married. My son is too young to get married.
1. I'm too busy. I can't go to the movies. 2. It's too cold. We can't go out. 3. She was too excited. She
couldn't speak. 4. He was very weak. He couldn't walk. 5. We are too tired. We can't work.
eg He is clever. He will answer all the questions. He is clever enough to answer all the questions.
1. He isn't confident. He won't pass the driving test. 2. She works hard. She will pass the exams. 3.
She isn't 16. She can't leave school. 4. He isn't tall. He can't play in the basketball team.
5. They didn't get home early. They didn't watch the chat show.
6. He is strong. He will lift the box. 7. She isn't hard-working. She won't be able to do this work. 8.
They are not rich. They can't buy this house.
80

81
A Letter
Dear Pam,
I've just been staying with my cousin Kate in Egypt. We went to Luxor and got the chance to go up in
a hot air balloon! I didn't have time to worry about being scared. We just climbed into the basket,
impatient for the balloon to take off.
As soon as we were in the air, Kate started taking photographs, but she soon stopped to look at the
breathtaking view. I wanted to take photographs too, but I hadn't remembered to take my camera with
me. It was stupid of me to be so careless.
We floated over the Nile. What a feeling! The view of the boats below us was wonderful to watch.
We left very early in the morning. There was a gentle wind at first, but after an hour the sun started to
shine. At the end of our trip we stopped looking at the view and began looking for a safe place to
land. People shouted and waved to us on the way down and tourists stopped to watch us landing. I
was happy to be on the ground again, but it was a day I'll never forget.
Love,

Christine
A. Study the text and practise it.
B. Make sentences beginning with the words in brackets, as in the example.
eg You lent me the money. (It was kind) It was kind of you to lend me the money.
1.1 forgot my keys. (It was stupid) 2. She sent me a birthday card. (It was nice) 3. He opened your
letter. (It was wrong) 4. You found the answer. (It was clever) 5. I left my keys at home. (It was
careless) 6. She helped me. (It was kind)
C. Complete the sentences using the to-infinitive form of the verbs in the box.
eg Are you hungry? Would you like something to eat?
say unlock catch wear eat write tell
82
1. Have you got a key ... this door? 2. Can we meet today? I've got something important... you. 3. I'm
staying at home this evening. I've got some letters... 4. "Why are you so quiet?" "1 haven't got
anything..." 5.1 need some new clothes... to the party. 6.1 really must go now. I've got a train...
D. Complete the sentences with infinitives.
1.1 was glad... a letter from you. 2. Sue is lucky... alive after the accident. 3. The children are
anxious... to the circus. 4. Dick didn't feel like going anywhere. He was content... home and... a book.
5. The teacher is always willing... us. 6. The students are motivated... English. 7. Be careful not... on
the icy sidewalks! 8. Sally is afraid... home alone. 9. Ann is proud... the top student in her class. 10.1
was surprised ... Mr Robinson at the meeting. 11. We were sorry... the bad news. 12.1 was happy...
my friend at the club.
E. Rephrase the sentences. Use the words brackets + for + object + to-infinitive, as in the example.
eg You needn't explain. (It isn't necessary) It isn't necessary for you to explain.
1. You needn't pay me back the money. (It's unnecessary) 2. We must leave immediately. (It's
essential) 3. She isn't normally late for work. (It's unusual) 4. Everyone should try to keep calm. (It's
important) 5. He doesn't normally complain. (It's unusual)
F. Rephrase the sentences.
eg It's very hard to deal with my uncle. My uncle is hard to deal with.
1. It isn't easy to do this work. 2. It's pleasant to look at her. 3. It is difficult to recognize him. 4. It is
interesting to talk to him. 5. It is difficult to please you. 6. It is hard to get this book.
G. Complete the sentences with the words in brackets. Use to + infinitive or an -ing form
1. Mr Bell used to smoke, but he stopped (smoke) ten years ago. 2. Mrs Bell must remember (phone)
the butcher to order meat for the weekend. 3. The milkman thinks that Mrs Bell forgot to pay him,
but she can remember (pay) the bill. 4. Mr Blake
83

asked the class to stop (talk). 5. Nick can remember (go) to school for the first time. 6. Ben didn't
remember (oil) his bicycle. The breaks still squeak. 7. On his way to the station Mr Bell stopped
(post) a letter. 8. Jenny, stop (bite) your nails! Don't be so nervous!
There'll Be a R.ise for You
Life was beginning to get Linda down. London sometimes seemed intolerably noisy and dirty. At
times she felt very lonely. But now there was something worse. There were rumours going about that
the EBC was in financial trouble, and would have to cut down on staff. Linda knew that since she
had been one of the last to come, she would probably be one of the first to go. Then, one Friday
afternoon, she was told that Wilson wanted to see her. Her heart sank. People always got the sack just
before the weekend.
Wilson looked uncomfortable. He said he had meant to tell her something earlier but had forgotten.
Linda almost broke down. She went very pale. She could feel her heart thumping. Wilson asked her
if she was all right. She bore up somehow and asked him to go on. Then he said that the department
had certain difficulties and that he would like to explain them to her. She sat back and waited for the
blow to come.
"We're expanding the department; taking on new staff. But there's a shortage of space. I wonder if
you'd mind sharing your office with two new reporters. It's only temporary," he said. Linda was so
relieved she hardly knew what to say. Then Wilson mentioned that he would like to put her in charge
of training the new reporters. "There'll be a rise for you, of course," he added.
A. Questions

1. Which things were getting Linda down? 2. What were the rumours? 3. Why did she think she
would get the sack? 4. Why did her heart sink that Friday? 5. How did the interview begin? 6. What
were Linda's feelings? 7. What exactly was it that Wilson said that made her feel relieved?
B. She had been one of the last to come.
In the same way say that she did these things among the last.
84
She:
1. started work
2. heard the rumours
3. went out to lunch
4. was told about it
5. was given a rise
6. saw Wilson that day
C. You are writing an essay on "Pioneers in Science, Art and Technology ". List some of the people
or countries who were the
first to do certain things.
D. She waited for the blow to come.
What did she wait for if she thought that:
1. he would give her the sack
2. her heart would stop thumping
3. the phone would ring
4. the weather would clear up
E. You went to the Olympic Games. Describe the excitement and expectation in phrases like, "The crowd
sat there, waiting for a new world record to be made. " For example, say what happened before
1. the gates opened
2. the flame was lit
3. the 100 metre race began
On the Way to Dallas
Gina: It was nice to run into your mother.
Frank: Yeah. I'm sorry we can't stay for dinner.
Gina: Me too, but I really have to get back to Dallas. I don't want to miss class.
Frank: I know. And I should go home and work on that report, anyway. It's due on Monday and I still
have to go to the library to look for some information.
Gina: That reminds me. I have ten words to look up in the dictionary. I have to find out their
meanings and make up sentences with them.
Frank: That doesn't sound like fun.
85
Gina: It isn't. But it's a good way to learn vocabulary.
Frank: Shall we stop and get something to eat on the way home? We could try out that restaurant we
passed on our way here. I hear they have good hamburgers and French fries.
Gina: Frank, you really should cut down on fried foods. You're getting fat.
Frank: I am not! I'm in great shape. And did you know that I've kept up my jogging for over three
months now?
Gina: I'm only kidding about getting fat. But I'm not kidding about fried food. It's not good for you.
Anyway, let's eat at home. I don't really want to stop at a restaurant.
Frank: Fine. But first we'd better stop at a gas station or we'll run out of gas.
A. 1. Where is the scene taking place? 2. Where are Gina and Frank going? 3. Why are they in a
hurry to get back to Dallas? 4. What does Frank suggest? 5. What does Gina say?
B. Refer to the conversation and match these two-word verbs with the definitions on the right.
1. run into
2. get back
3. look for
4. look up
5. find out
6. make up

7. try out
8. cut down (on)
9. keep up
10. ran out (of)
a. find information in a book
b. return
c. invent
d. decrease
e. meet by chance
f. test
g. find
h. discover information i. use all of something j. continue
C. Study and practise the conversation.
D. Respond using had better + infinitive without to
Alan and Bill have got work abroad for a year and each is taking his car. They mean to leave
together, but Bill is a bit behindhand with his preparations.
A: I've rung my parents.
B: Oh, I'd better ring my parents. (Stress on my)
1. paid my bills.
2. said goodbye to my colleagues.
3. sub-let my flat.
4. told my landlord.
5. written to my new boss.
6. applied for my visa.
7. stopped my newspapers.
8. bought my maps.
9. worked out my route.
10. read my instructions.
11. had my injections.
12. collected my traveller's cheques.
13. insured my luggage.
14. put on my roof rack.
15. adjusted my brakes.
16. tested my lights.
17. checked my tyres.
18. changed my money.
19. done my packing.
E. Complete the sentences using the correct form of the words in the box.
eg Goodbye. It was very nice to meet you.
impossible/finish pleased/hear
safe/go nice/meet easy/use
interesting/plan
1. My new video recorder looks complicated, but it's actually very ... 2. That is a very dangerous part
of the city. It isn't... out there at night. 3.1 was...that you had passed your exam. 4.1 don't like
package holidays. I think it's much more... your own holiday. 5. It's... all that work today. There just
isn't enough time.
E. Make up completions to the following. Express the purpose of the action.
eg I went to Chicago to visit my relatives.
1. I went to the market.... 2.1 went to the doctor... 3.1 swim
86
87

every day... 4. He came here... 5. He stopped... 6.1 have to go to the bank... 7. He went to the store...
8.1 came to this school...
G. Complete the sentences using the infinitive as attribute (take the words from the box):
lose see laugh at follow speak to do worry about eat answer talk about wash type
go
1. This is just the man... 2. There is no time... 3. Here are some instructions... 4. There is nothing... 5.

Packing was the first thing. 6. She will always find something... 7. The best place... in out town is the
Art Gallery. 8. There was nothing... 9. These are the letters... 10.1 have a lot of dishes... 11. Is there
anything... ? 12.1 have several articles... 13. When is a good time...
An Unusual Shopping
As soon as Linda went into the department that sold raincoats, she sensed there was something
unusual in the atmosphere.
First of all, there was a salesman there and not a saleswoman. That was very unusual in the women's
coat department. He asked if he could be of any help. But when she said she was just looking he did
not seem to be listening. He did not look very much like a salesman, either.
A second later a raincoat caught her eye. She asked him a question about it. He did not even hear her
at first. She asked again. She wanted to know if he had any coats like it with a detachable lining. He
did not seem to understand what a detachable lining was. She explained. Then she went on looking.
She noticed that the salesman seemed to be watching another customer in the department all the time.
The other customer, a middle-aged woman, left the department. The salesman immediately went to
the phone and told somebody on the other end that the woman had gone and had definitely taken two
leather belts without paying for them. Then he turned to Linda and explained that he was not a
salesman at all but a store detective. Later, Linda read in the paper that a woman had been arrested
for stealing some belts from a department store, or, in other words, for shoplifting.
. Questions
1. What was the first unusual thing Linda noticed? 2. What was the first thing Linda said? 3. What
was the salesman's reaction? 4. What did she ask him a few seconds later? 5. What was strange about
the salesman's reaction then? 6. What did Linda notice then? 7. What happened after that?
B. Study and practise the text.
C. Join two sentences into one by using without.
eg She left. She did not pay. She left without paying.
1. She came in. She did not knock.
2. He walked five miles. He did not stop.
3. He spoke for ten minutes. He did not pause. 4.1 lay there for five hours. I did not go to sleep.
Z). Mr X. thinks the train is leaving, but he is not absolutely sure. He says:
"The train seems to be leaving now." What does he say if he thinks:
1. the train is running late
2. it is waiting for something
3. the other passengers are getting angry
4. they are arguing with the conductor
5. all the trains are running late
E. The woman had stolen some belts and was arrested, in other words:
She was arrested for stealing some belts. What were these people arrested for?
1. A bank clerk stole 5000.
2. A woman threw some paint at the Prime Minister.
3. A man cheated people.
4. A man kidnapped a child.
5. Two Irishmen got into a fight and smashed up a pub.
I Knew Her "Wll
Shopkeeper: I knew Mrs Carter very well. She was a tall, handsome woman who used to come into the
shop at least twice a week. She lived alone in a large house on an old farm about three miles from
here. People ask me if I am certain she did it. The answer is yes. I was absolutely certain, otherwise I
would never have called the police. In the first place, I saw her do it. I watched her put the things into her
bag and I watched her walk out of the store. In the second place, we found the things in her bag, and
finally, she had done it before. It wasn't the first time.
A. Recall the sentences with the infinitive after the verbs of perception.
B. Retell the text.
Oh, No!
It was quite late on a Saturday night and we were having supper in our new house. Things still felt a bit
strange so we didn't take much notice when we heard someone moving about noisily in the house next
door the house was semi-detached. We thought it was a bit strange that our neighbours should be doing

their housework so late on a Saturday night but thought no more of it. Then we heard men's voices talking
softly. From the window ! could see figures moving backwards and forwards in the front garden. We
assumed that our neighbours were having some sort of party. Not long after, we heard the front door slam
shut. Then complete silence. We thought this was a bit strange, because we naturally expected to hear
other people leave/leaving and say/ saying goodbye. However we went to bed and forgot all about it. At
breakfast time, early the next day, we heard someone shouting "Oh, no!" Our neighbours had just arrived
back home from holiday to discover that thieves had taken all their furniture and valuables from the
house.
A. Recall the sentences with the infinitive and participle after the verbs of perception.
B. Retell the text.
C. Choose the correct form of the verb in brackets to complete these sentences.
1.1 looked out of the window and watched the children (play/ playing) in the yard for a few minutes. 2. I
saw Linford Christie (win/winning) the 100 metres final at the Barcelona Olympics. 3.1 heard a wild
animal (cry/crying) out suddenly, as if it had been caught in a trap. 4. We heard someone (play/playing)
loud music in the flat above us well after midnight last night. 5. She ran into the kitchen because she
could smell something (burn/burning). 6.1 can feel something (crawl/crawling) down my back! 7.1
jumped when I heard the door (slam/slamming). 8. They saw the boy (fall/ falling) into the water. 9. I saw
Sue (drop/dropping) the bag and (pick/picking) it up again. 10. As I walked past the room, I heard two
people (argue/arguing). 11. We stopped for a moment and watched them (build/building) the new hospital.
12. Did you see someone (break/breaking) the window? 13. We watched them (climb/climbing) up to the
top of the hill and then come down again. 14. We saw the man (post/posting) a letter and walk down the
street. 15. As I looked out of the window I noticed the woman (repair/repairing) her car. 16. I turned
roimd because I suddenly felt someone (grab/grabbing) my sleeve. 17. As we walked through the streets
of the city, we were shocked to see so many people (sleep/sleeping) in shop doorways. 18.1 was driving
down the road when I saw a woman (walk/ walking) straight in front of a bicycle. 19.1 woke up because I
heard people (shout/shouting) in the street. 20. All of a sudden I heard the branch (break/breaking) 21.
When I was downtown yesterday I saw the police (chase/chasing) a thief. 22.1 like to listen to the birds
(sing/singing) when I get up early in the morning. 23. While I was waiting for my plane, I watched other
planes (land /landing) and (take off/taking off). 24. Do you hear someone (call/ calling) for help in the
distance? I do.

Text Exercises
I. David has just met an old friend of his called Nigel. They're having a cup of coffee together. Nigel has
some bad news. Complete the conversation by putting in an infinitive with to or without to. Use these
verbs: answer, borrow, catch, do, find, go, hear, know, lend, look, make, pay, see, spend, stay, think. (You
90
91
will need to use some of the verbs more than once.). After you have done the exercise, roleplay the
conversation.
David: Are you still working for Electrobrit, Nigel? Nigel: No, I'm not. I'm afraid I lost my job
there. And Polly's lost her job too. We're having rather a difficult time at the moment.
David: Oh, dear. I'm sorry... that.
Nigel: I've been out of work for six months now. I expected.. a new job fairly quickly, but it isn't so
easy, I've discovered.
David: Jobs are hard... these days.
Nigel: With Polly not working we've very little money... After I lost my job I managed... my bank
manager... us some money, but he won't let us... any more now. And there are lots of bills... I really
don't know what... David: Do you think you might... a job if you moved somewhere else?
Nigel: Well, perhaps. We've talked about it of course. We've even wondered whether... abroad. We
could always., a fresh start in a different country. Polly wants me... for a job in America. And I've
written to Australia House, although I'm still waiting for them.... David: Do you like the idea of
living abroad? Nigel: I don't know really. I think on the whole I'd rather... here if I had a job. But the
situation has made us... carefully about our future. We decided we ought... out what opportunities
there are. I've agreed... about all the possibilities.
David: Well, I hope you find something soon. Nigel: I simply must... a job soon, or I don't know
what we
shall...

David: Well, let me... what happens, won't you? Look, here's my new address and phone number.
Give me a ring some time.
Nigel: OK, David, I'd better... now. I've got a bus... David: I hope... you again soon. Nigel: Bye,
David.
II. Grandy United is a very successful football club. It's got a
good club chairman and the team manager, Bill Grace, is one of the best in the country. Tim Bennett
of the Daily Talk is interviewing people at the club. He's going to write an article about United. Write
out Tim's notes as full sentences using verb + object + infinitive. Put to with the infinitive if
necessary.
eg the players don't miss a training period Bill doesn't allow it
Bill doesn't allow the players to miss a training period.
eg they train five days a week he makes them He makes them train five days a week.
1. they work very hard Bill makes them
2. they take the game seriously he forces them
3. the players feel proud of the club Bill wants that
4. they play well together Bill teaches them
5. they watch films of other teams he makes them
6. they can relax after the game Bill lets them
7. the players have to behave the club expects it
8. they don't go to night clubs Bill doesn't allow it
9. the team does well the fans want that
10. the club can't win everything but that's what the fans would like
11. schoolboys visit the club Bill invites them
12. local companies are giving money to the clubthe chairman has persuaded them
Activity
Discuss the function of a teacher in a class of students. What do you expect a teacher to do? How
does a teacher want students to behave? What should a teacher make students do or allow them to
do?
III. Kelly is a seven-year-old girl whose parents have been killed in a road accident. She's living in a
children's home, but she isn't happy there. Two social workers, Valerie and Roy, are talking about
Kelly. Rewrite the underlined parts using for + noun phrase + infinitive. Roleplay the conversation.
eg It'll be the best thing for her to live in a family.
Activity.
Use for + noun phrase +infinitive to talk about parties. Do you enjoy parties? Do people have parties in
your country? Say what they're like. (It's usual...) What makes a good party? (It's best.../ It's important...)
What makes a bad one ? (It's a mistake...).
VI. Amanda is a secretary. She's got a new job, but she doesn't like her boss. She's telling her friend about
him. Rephrase using an infinitive or an -ing form.
eg The boss insists on everyone being in the office at nine o'clock. He doesn't allow us to make personal
phone calls.
Amanda: Everyone has to be in the office at nine o'clock. The boss insists on it. And we can't make
personal phone calls because he doesn't allow it. We don't have coffee breaks because he's stopped that.
We have to work hard that's what he's always telling us. People can't work at their own speed; he
doesn't agree with that. I have to work late because he quite often wants me to. If he asked me
occasionally, I wouldn't mind. But I have to spend my life at the
94

office. He seems to expect it. And he watches me all the time, which I don't like. People can't be friendly
with him he hates that. Activity.
Write three or four similar sentences about your boss or about your parents. Say what they expect (or
don't expect) you to do, or what they insist (or don't insist) on you doing, and so on.
V. Complete the newspaper article by putting in the infinitive or the -ing form of the verbs in brackets.
After you have done the exercise retell the text.

Weenie WiC Stay


Milchester Council has decided (let) 82-year-old Mrs Nellie Battle go on (live) at her home at 29 Croft
Street. The Council had wanted (knock) down all the old houses in the street because they were planning
(build) a new car park there. The future of this plan is now uncertain.

The story began five years ago when the people of Croft Street agreed (move) to new homes.
Unfortunately the Council forgot (ask) Mrs Battle. When they finally remembered her, everyone else had
already gone. But the Council failed (persuade) Nellie to do the same. "My grandson's just finished
(decorate) the sitting-room for me," she said at the time. "I can't imagine (leave) now."
The Council offered (pay) Mrs Battle i 1000 and promised (give) her a new house, but she still refused
(move). "I can't help (like) it here," she told our reporter. "I miss (see) the neighbours of course. I enjoyed
(talk) with them." Croft Street has stood almost empty for the last five years. There seemed (be) no way
anyone could move Nellie from number 29.
Now comes the Council's new decision. Mrs Battle is very pleased. "I kept (tell) them I wouldn't move,"
she said today. " I don't mind (be) on my own any more. And I expect (live) till I'm a hundred. I hope (be)
here a long time yet."
We have also heard this week that the Council cannot now afford (build) the car park. One or two of the
people who used (live) in Croft Street have suggested (repair) the old houses so that they can move back
into them. They dislike (live) in the new houses they moved into five years ago.
95
VI. Peter and Sue are in the shopping centre. Complete their conversation by putting the verbs in brackets
into the infinitive or the -ing form. After you have done the exercise roleplay the conversation.
Peter: Have we done all the shopping now?
Sue: Yes, I think so. I must remember (post) this letter.
Peter: I remember (pass) a postbox somewhere.
Sue: Just a minute, where's my purse? It isn't in my handbag.
Peter: Did you forget (bring) it?
Sue: No, I had it not long ago. And my credit card is in there.
Oh, my God, what are we going to do? Peter: Just stop (worry) and think. You must have put it down
somewhere and forgotten (pick) it up. Try (remember)
when you had it last.
Sue: I remember (have) it in the shoe shop. Peter: Then you stopped (buy) a newspaper... Sue: Oh, it's
all right. It's here in the shopping bag. Sorry. I
can't remember (put) it there. Peter: You could try (chain) it to your hand next time.
Activity A
Can you remember things you did when you were very young? Give examples of things you remember
doing.
Activity
Do you ever forget to do things such as turning off lights or locking doors? Give examples.
Activity
What advice would you give to someone who wants to stop smoking? Use the verb try.

UNITS
TOPIC : JOBS AND WORK Listen, read and practise.

She Seems to Be the Best Qualified


A vacancy had arisen in Mr Kay's small office. His secretary, who
was pregnant, was suddenly advised by her doctor to give up
working. Mr Kay had to find a replacement quickly and he
advertised her post in the press. He placed an advertisement in
; three newspapers. Several girls (and a few men) applied for the
^ job. He looked through their applications and discussed them with
his assistant, Mr Samuel, when he came back from his time off
that afternoon. There were some good candidates, some not so
good. One girl wrote that she had been trained as a cook but she
didn't like working in hot kitchens. One man wanted to work as a
salesman but thought that working as a secretary was the best way
to start. One was a college student who wanted to earn some money
to support herself in the university vacation. She only wanted to
. work part-time. But eventually Mr Kay made the appointment.
Dialogue A
Mr Kay:
Twenty applicantsthat's not bad for one advert.
I've made a shortlist of five, so we'd better call
them for interview. Mr Samuel: Will next Monday do? Mr Kay:
Monday, all right. I'll see this one

first, Janita
Ling. She seems to be the best qualified. Mr Samuel: Is she the graduate in business studies? Mr Kay:
Yes, and I hope she's good at typing as well.
Dialogue
Mr Kay:
Now, Miss Ling, about your qualifications. I see
that you have fluent French as well as English and that you were working with your last company for four
years. Tell me, why did you leave?
Candidate (A): Actually, I didn't leave. The company closed down.
96
97

Mr Kay:
Closed down?
Candidate (A): Yes, it went bankrupt. So I was out of job. Mr Kay:
1 see. And have you been
doing anything since?
Candidate (A): I had a couple of temporary jobs, and now I really need something permanent.
Dialogue
Mr Kay:
So tell me, why are you applying to work in my
company? Candidate (B): Well, I was trained in book-keeping and office
practice and I'd like to use my secretarial skills. Mr Kay:
I see. And apart from typing what
experience
do you have with office machinery? Candidate (B): I know how to use the telex machine and the
photocopier. Mr Kay:
All right. Well, I'll think it over and we'll get in
touch with you in a day or two. Thank you for
coming.
Dialogue D
\
Mr Kay: Now let me tell you a few things about the job. You know the salary already. We pay a bonus
twice a year and we give three weeks' holiday a year. Office hours are nine to five thirty and we work a
five-day week. Do you have any questions?
Candidate (C): Er, yes. Well, I insist on a doctor's certificate if staff are away for longer than a couple of
days.
Dialogue E
Mr Kay: Miss Ling is still my first choice, so could you give her a ring and I'll offer her the job. If she accepts I'll write to the others straight away so as not to keep them waiting.
Mr Samuel: Are you going to take up her references?
Mr Kay: No, there's no need to do that. I'm pretty sure we can trust her. If she accepts I'll write her a letter
of appointment.
A. Questions
1. What post did Mr Kay advertise and why? 2. Was Mr Kay pleased with the number of applicants? 3.
How many applicants was Mr Kay going to interview? 4. Does Miss Ling have a degree? 5. Why was she
out of work? 6. What particular skills was Mr Kay looking for in his applicants? 7. How many hours a
week does Mr Kay's office work? 8. Was Mr Kay offering a full-time or apart-time job?
B. Ask and answer questions about a) the vacancy in Mr Kay s office b) the candidates who applied for
the job c) the interview
C. Retell the text and roleplay the conversations.
D. Special Difficulties
I. Translate the following sentences.
1. This sort of work won't do for him. 2. He will do for us. 3. This hat will do. 4. Will these brown shoes
do? 5. This room will do for an office. 6. Can I have a bottle of red wine? Will port do? 7. When shall
we meet? Will Friday do?
II. Answer the questions as in the example.
eg What does your father do?
He works as an engineer at one of the city plants.
1. What does your husband do? 2. What is your brother's job? 3. What does your sister do? 4. What do
you do? 5. What does Henry do? 6. What does your mother do? 7. What is your friend's job?
III. Make up sentences. Do it as in the example. eg Travelling is the best way to make friends.
IV. Respond giving reasons.
eg Shall we send a telegram?

No, mere's no need to do that. She knows about our arrival.


1. Shall I buy some meat? 2. Shall I help her? 3. Shall I phone him? 4. Shall we tell her? 5. Shall we take
a taxi? 6. Shall I write to her? 7. Shall we have to start early?
98
99
V. Complete the sentences using had better and the verbs in the box.
eg The phone is ringing. I'd better answer it.
park stay hurry answer put out be not leave
1. This knife is very sharp. You... careful when you use it. 2. Oh, no! Look! There's a "No Parking"
sign here. We... somewhere else. 3. You're not very well. I think you... in bed today. 4. We're late.
We.... 5. There's a lot of crime in this area. We... any doors or windows unlocked. 6. The plane is just
going to take off. You... that cigarette.
People and their Jobs
1. Lucy works in a travel agency. Her salary is very low. She only gets three weeks' holiday a year
and she works long hours. But Lucy doesn't mind, because she enjoys her work. She has a nice boss
and she meets a lot of people during the day. Her work is interesting and varied. Also, every year her
company gives her a free two-week holiday in Europe.
A. Imagine you meet Lucy. Ask her questions about her job.
B. Think of other jobs with good "perks ".
C. What are good working conditions?
2. Paul works on a car assembly line in a factory. He is a skilled worker and he does a lot of
overtime; so at the end of each week he takes home quite a good wage. However, he doesn't enjoy his
work. He finds it boring and monotonous. He gets four weeks' holiday a year, but because there are
several public holidays and sometimes strikes in the factory, he doesn't usually work 48 weeks a year.
A. Imagine you meet Paul. Ask him questions about his job.
B. Would you like to work in a factory? Why? Why not? Are there a lot of strikes in your country?
3. Tom is unemployed. He is a university graduate and he has a degree in sociology. However, Tom
cannot find a good job. Each
100
week he receives some money from the government called "Social Security". With this money he
pays the rent and buys his food, but at the end of the week he is always "broke".
A. Imagine you meet Tom. Ask him questions about his life.
B. Does your government give money to the unemployed? Are there many unemployed graduates in
your country?
4. Mr Charles is a successful businessman. He is a company director. He earns a lot of money, and he
also pays a lot of income tax. He is 64 and next year he is going to retire. He will get a good pension
from his company and also an old age pension from the state. He is looking forward to his retirement.
He wants to read a lot and go fishing.
A. Ask Mr Charles some questions.
B. What is the usual retirement age in your country? Can you talk about pension schemes in your
country?
5. Henry: I'm a pop star. I earn about 60,000 a year. Being a pop star means all sorts of things. It
means I don't have to worry about money any more. It means I can do what I want to do. For
example, I hate having to get up early. I can't stand working in offices or in factories. I can't bear
having to work at fixed hours. That's why I enjoy being a pop star. I like playing in front of large
audiences. I even like all those young girls screaming and trying to tear my clothes off.
A. Imagine you meet Henry. Ask him questions about his job.
B. Would you like to be a pop star? Do you think it is an interesting job?
6. Alice: I'm a nurse and I don't earn very much money at all. In fact, I have a lot of difficulty in just
making ends meet, as we say. But I like being a nurse. I suppose it's because I enjoy helping people.
Being a nurse is hard work. It means working all sorts of hours. And it isn't very pleasant sometimes.
There are all sorts of things I don't enjoy. For example, I don't enjoy seeing people in pain. Working
ten hours a day and more in a hospital isn't much fun, but at least you know you're doing something
worthwhile. A. Imagine you meet Alice. Ask her questions about her job.
101

B. Tell your classmates about your job. Say what you like and what you don't like about your job.
C. Tell about your friend's (mother's, father's, etc.) job. Say whether she/he likes it or not. Say why.
7. John: The job that I have recently started is as a sales representative with a company that produces
garden furniture. The company, called "Sunnosit", is based in Thornton, a small town in the
Midlands. The area manager, who has been with the company for over thirty years, is due to retire
next year, which means I might get his job if I do well. One great advantage is having a company car,
which I have to have, because the job involves visiting different parts of the country. My colleagues,
who I get on well with, are quite ambitious, which means the atmosphere at work is rather
competitive. I don't mind. Apart from that, the job is fine.
A. Imagine you are John. Ask him questions about his job.
B. Are you ambitious? What are your colleagues like? Do you like your boss? What is he/she like?
Is your work challenging?
Getting a 'Job
In Britain there is a special service for school leavers, the Careers Advisory Service, which helps
young people who are looking for their first jobs. Careers Officers give practical advice on interview
techniques, application forms, letters, pay, National Insurance and Trade Unions. This is an extract
from a leaflet which is given to young people by Dorset Careers Service.
The interview
You've got an interview for a job good! So now for the hard work. To do well at an interview you
need to put some thought first.
The employer wants to know if you are the person he wants, so you'll be asked about yourself. Think
about it now:
What do I do well? What are my good points?
School activities? School subjects?
Why would I like this job? Spare-time interests? What is my family like? What do I like doing and why? What do I not
like doing and why?

You will want to ask questions too.


The job itself? Training? Prospects? Further Education? Conditions?
Previous work? Saturday job?
Can I see where I would be working? Hours? ?
102

Write your questions down and take them with you. Before the interview
1. Find out what you can about the firm.
2. Find out the interviewer's name and telephone number.
3. Find out where the interview is.
4. Find out how long it will take to get there.
5. Make sure you know what the job involves.
6. Dress to look clean and tidy.
At the Interview
1. Do arrive early. Phone if you're held up.
2. Do try to smile.
3. Do show interest in the job and ask questions.
4. Do be polite.
5. Don't panic, even if faced by more than one person.
6. Don't slouch around and look bored.
7. Don't smoke or chew.
8. Don't give one word answers or say you don't care what you do.
Look at these job advertisements.
Trainee computer programmer
Good opportunity for a start in computers. Ability at maths is essential. Application forms to:
Personnel Department, Continental Computers, Honeywell Rd., Bournemouth.
103

Fernside Engineering
Require a junior clerk for the accounts department. Apply in writing to: The Personnel Officer, Fernside
Engineering, Western Rd., Poole.
Shop assistant
A vacancy for a smart, lively young person.

Good prospects. Please write to:


Mrs J. Frost, "Cool Boutique", 39 High St., Dorchester
Applying by letter
1. Remember that first impressions are important.
2. Write clearly and neatly on good notepaper, unlined if possible.
3. Check for spelling mistakes. Use a dictionary if you are not sure of a word.
4. Describe yourself, your qualifications and your experience clearly.
5. If the advertisement asks you to write for an application form you will not need to give detailed
information in your letter.
6. Address the letter and the envelope clearly.
44 Deepdale Road, Boscombe, Bournemouth, BH92 7JX 4th April, 1982
The Personnel Department, Continental Computers, Honeywell Road, Bournemouth
Dear Sir or Madam,
I read your advertisement in yesterday's "Evening Echo". I am interested in training as a computer
programmer. Could you please send me an application form, and any further details. Yours faithfully,
Joanne Evans
A. Questions
1. Have you ever had an interview for a job? 2. Is there a Careers Advisory Service in your
country/school? 3. How do people find jobs? 4. How would you find a job?/How did you find your first
job? 5. Where can you find job advertisements?
B. Ask students to re-read the "Before the interview" section. Ask questions.
1. What would you want to find out about the firm? (Discuss in pairs, make up a list and report back
size, location, business, etc.)
2. What would you wear? Would you wear jeans?/a suit?/ a tie?/ a dress?
C. "At the interview. " Askstudens to re-read this section. Do you agree with the advice? Why?/Why not?
D. "The interview. " Ask individuals questions. (Ask him/her/me/each other.)
,
1. What are your spare-time interests? 2. What's your family like? 3. Have you got any brothers or sisters?
How many? How old are they? What do they do? Do they like their jobs? 4. What do you like doing?
Why? 5. What don't you like doing? Why? 6. What subjects have you studied at school? Did you study...?
Uo/Did you enjoy studying history/ geography/mathematics/etc.? Do/Did you enjoy learning
English/French/etc.? 7. What do you do well? What do you do badly? 8. What are your good points? (I'm
friendly, honest, sensible, practical, etc.) 9. What school activities do/did you do? (sports, clubs, etc.) 10.
Have you worked before? 11. Have you done a part-time job? (in the English leaflet it is a "Saturday
job".)
E. Focus attention on the rest of "The interview" (the questions to ask). Ask students to suggest questions
using the prompts (a) in pairs (b) to the class. Draw up a list of possible questions, and ask a few
individuals.
1. What does the job involve? 2. What are the working hours? 3. What are the holidays? 4. Is there a
restaurant? 5. Is there any training? What is it? 6. Will I get any qualifications? 7. Can I see where I
would be working? 8. What's the salary? 9. What are the prospects for promotion? 10. Is there a pension?
104
105
F. Focus attention on the job advertisements. Ask:
1. Which would you apply for? 2. Why would you like this job?
G. Pair work. Students role-play an interview, using the leaflet and the job advertisement (select one
job for each pair).
H. Focus attention on "Applying by letter". Do you agree with the advice? Why/Why not?

Applying for a Job Before Your Interview


Here are some questions to think about. Your answers will help you choose the right job. Your answers
will also help you answer the interviewer s questions.
Do you have the right skills?
If you want to be a salesperson, do you enjoy travelling, and are you good at meeting people? Are
you aggressive?
If you want to be a secretary, are you interested in working in an office? Can you type and file
quickly? Are you patient?
If you want to work in a store or restaurant, do you like helping people? Are you good at working

with numbers? Are you friendly? What skills do you need for the job you would like to have?
Are you responsible? Do you work hard? Do you always do the best job you can? Do you help your
co-workers?
Are you reliable? Do you start working on time? Do you come to work every day? If you begin
working on something, do you finish it?
What are your strengths?
For example, do you work well with people? Are you good at math? Can you type fast? Do you learn
quickly? Are you reliable? Can you work independently?
What are your weaknesses?
For example, perhaps your English is still not very good, but you're taking a class to improve it.
Perhaps you are impatient because your co-workers do not work very fast, but you are learning to be
more patient.
106
A. You and your partner want to hire a new salesperson for your company. The salesperson will sell
school supplies to colleges and universities. Look at the chart and study the likes, dislikes and
experience of the applicants. Discuss the applicants with your partner. Decide which applicant you
want to hire. Read the example.
NAMES

LIKES

DISLIKES

EXPERIENCE

Georgia Hall

responsibility
working with
people

clerical work
working with
numbers

worked in a school

Greg Otero

working independently
responsibility

large companies
worked in a college
travelling by plane bookstore

Susan White

travelling big
companies

selling working at
night

worked as a
bookkeeper

Albert Wu

selling helping
people

working alone
travelling

was a salesman in a
shoe store

eg A: What do you think about hiring Greg Otero?


B: I think he could do the job. He enjoys working independently, and he likes having responsibility. Also, he
used to work in a college bookstore. A: Yes, but he hates working for large companies, and he
isn't interested in travelling by plane.

A letter of Application
Paulo has read this advertisement in "Health and Fitness" magazine.
Keen on sport? Busy health club requires outgoing person for part-time work (including late hours).
June to September. Good command of English. Must be adaptable. Please write to: The Manager,
Sundance Health Club, Harbour Lane, Chichester, Sussex, PO1 2JE including a recent photograph.
107

This is Paulo's letter of application.


Ruade Gloria 10 3000 Coimbra Portugal 15th April 1995
The Manager, Sundance Health Club, Harbour Lane, Chichester, Sussex, PO1 2JE
Dear Sir/Madam,
I'm writing in reply to your advertisement in "Health and Fitness" magazine for general part-time
work in your health club. I am a 20-year-old Portuguese student and I come from Coimbra in the
north of Portugal. At present I am still studying at college but I am taking my final exams in May. I
have studied English for six years but I want to spend some time in England in order to improve my
spoken English.
I am interested in sport and fitness and at home I go to a sports centre three times a week. I am also a
member of the college swimming team. I get on very well with people and I like making new friends.
I don't mind doing any sort of work including cleaning, washing up and helping in the gym.

I am prepared to work any hours but ideally I would like to work in the afternoons and evenings only
so that I can attend English classes in the mornings. I have friends who live in Chichester, so
accommodation is not a problem. My term ends on 28th May, so I would be able to start on 1st June.
I look forward to hearing from you. Yours faithfully, Paulo Freitas
A. Study and practise the text.
B. You want to go to Britain in the summer and would like to earn a little money while you are
there. Read the following job advertisement.
108
Winsdor Leisure Centre
Stowell Road, Winsdor
wants part-time summer helpers
The employer: runs two leisure centres and employs about ten casual staff
Season: July to September
Work period: evenings, weekends and holidays
The work: setting up and taking down sports equipment; involvement in children's summer activity
programme; working as lifeguards
Pay and conditions: 3.50 4.00 per hour
Qualifications: lifeguards must be strong swimmers, preferably trained in first aid. Life saving
training will be given. Good knowledge of English is essential.
Age: 18
Application: to the manager at the above address
Now in pairs discuss the information you need to include in your letter of application for the job.
Make notes under the following headings.
you and your personal details
knowledge of English
current course of study or current job
stability for job
availability
any questions
Write a letter to the manager of the Winsdor Leisure Centre applying for the job. Use Paulo s letter
as a guide.
Your career history
A CV ("curriculum vitae" or "resume") is essential if you're applying for a new job or for promotion
within your own company, or even to register as a delegate at a conference. Some information might
be given in your CV, some in your letter of application and perhaps some on a Supplementary
Information sheet (giving information relevant to the particular job you're applying for). There are no
fixed international rules about this: different countries have different practices.
109
Work in pairs. Decide where you in your country and in your line of business would normally give
this information:
1. Your name, address and telephone number.
2. The title and reference number of the job.
3. Your date of birth.
4. Your marital status.
5. The name and address of present (or last) employer.
6. Your hobbies and leisure interests.
7. The sports you play.
8. Details of all the jobs you have had.
9. The languages you speak, read or write.
10. Details of the examinations you passed at school.
11. Details of the professional diplomas or degrees you have gained.
12. Details of training courses you have attended.
13. Details of your achievements and responsibilities in your working career.
14. Your suitability for the job advertised.

15. Your reasons for applying for this job.


16. When you are available for interview.
17. Details of your present (or last) job.
18. Your current (or last) salary.
19. The salary you would expect to receive.
20. The names and addresses of two or three referees.
in your CV or resume?
in your Letter of Application?
on a Supplementary Information sheet?
or on an Application Form?
Out of Work
In Britain a lot of people are out of work. Tracey Chapman is 18, and she left school a year ago. She
lives in the North East, an area of high youth unemployment. She hasn't been able to find a job yet.
"My dad just doesn't understand. He started working in a steel mill when he was 15. Things are
different now, but he thinks I should start bringing home some money. Oh, I get my unemployment
benefit, but that isn't much and I'm fed up with queuing for it every Thursday. I hate having to ask my
mum and dad for
110
money. Oh, mum gives me a couple of pounds for tights now and then, but she can't stand seeing me
at home all day. I've almost given up looking for a job. I buy the local paper every day but I'm really
tired of looking through the "Situations Vacant" column. There are 50 applicants for every job. I was
interested in being a dentist's receptionist because I like meeting people, but now I'd take any job at
all. People ask me why I don't move to London, but I don't want to leave my family and friends.
Anyway I'm scared of living on my own in a big city."
Tracey Chapman went to the Careers Advisory Service. She had to complete this questionnaire.
Questionnaire
1. Are you seeking
a) full-time employment?
b) part-time employment?
2. Which of these is most important for you?
money?
job satisfaction?
people?
an interesting job?
security?
3. Do you like
Yes
No
a) meeting people?
b) working alone?
c) working with other people?
d) working with your hands?
e) travelling?
4. What do you like doing in your free time?
George Morley is 54. Until last year he was a production manager in the textile industry. He had
worked for the same company since he left school. He had a good job, a four-bedroomed house and a
company car. When his company had to close because of economic difficulties, he became
redundant.
"It's funny really... I don't feel old, but it isn't easy to start looking for a job at my age. I've had so
many refusals. Now I'm frightened of applying for a job. All the interviewers are twenty years
younger than me. You see, I'm interested in learning a new
111
skill, but nobody wants to train me. I can see their point of view. I'll have to retire in ten years. It's
just... well, I'm tired of sitting around the house. I've worked hard for nearly forty years and now I'm
terrified of having nothing to do. When I was still with Lancastrian Textiles I was bored with doing
the same thing day after day, but now I'd really enjoy doing a job again... any job really. It's not the
money... I got good redundancy pay, and the house is paid for... and I've given up smoking... no, it's
not just money. I just need to feel... well, useful... that's all."
A. Play the cassette of the introduction about Tracey Chapman. Answer the questions.

1. What's her name? 2. How old is she? 3. She isn't a student, is she? 4. Where does she live? 5. Does
she work? Why not? 6. Is she happy? Why not?
B. Play the cassette again. After each sentence with an -ing form pause to ask questions, for example
Cassette: He thinks I should start bringing home some money. (Pause)
T:
What does he think?
St:
He thinks she should start bringing home some money, etc.
Questions:
1. Where did he start working? 2. What does he think? 3. What's she fed up with? 4. What does she
hate? 5. What can't her mother stand? 6. What has she almost given up? 7. What's she tired of? 8.
What was she interested in? 9. What does she like? 10. What's she scared of?
C. Read the text. Speak about Tracey Chapman. Use the -ing forms.
D. Play the cassette of the introduction about George Morley. Answer the questions.
1. What's his name? 2. How old is he? 3. What was his job? 4. How long had he worked there? 5.
Why did his company have to close? 6. What happened to him?
E. Play the cassette pausing as in "B ".
112

Questions:
1. What isn't easy? 2. What's he frightened of? 3. What's he interested in? 4. What's he tired of? 5.
What's he terrified of? 6. What would he enjoy? 7. What's he given up?
F. Read the text. Speak about George Morley Use the -ing forms.
G. Focus attention on the "Questionnaire ".
Pair work. Students complete the questionnaire for a partner. Ask a few students about their partners'
answers. H. Exercise 1
/ like meeting people. Make sentences about yourself with: love/enjoy/don't like/dislike/hate/can't
stand. Exercise 2
I'm scared of living on my own. Make sentences about yourself with: afraid of/frightened of/terrified
of. Exercise 3
I'm bored with doing the same thing. Make sentences about yourself with: fed up with/tired
of/interested in.
Exercise 4
I gave up smoking.
Make sentences about yourself with:
start/begin/stop/give up.
Conversation Practice
Resume
Name: Present address
Telephone: Date of Birth: Place of birth:
Stephen Lo
2315 South Sierra Drive,
San Diego, California, CA 92126
(619)076 5581
9/17/70
Oakland, California
113

Education:
1 977 84 Millard Fillmore Elementary School, Oakland, Calif.
1984 88 James Garfield High School,
Oakland, Calif.
1 988 92 College. U.C.L.A., Los Angeles, Calif.
Graduated with a B.S. in Business Administration.
Employment history: Summer vacations: 1 987 1991. Camp counsellor.
Camp Redwoods, Mendocino County,

Calif.
Swimming instructor. 1 992 present:
Administrative Assistant, Soledad Computers. Pacific Beach, San Diego. Foreign languages: Chinese excellent, Spanish fair, \
I have a California driver's licence.
A 'Job 'Intetview (Mrs D=Mrs Dukakis)
Mrs D: Come in. Mr Lo, isn't it? Please have a seat.
Mr Lo: Thank you.
Mrs D: Did you have a good trip?
Mr Lo: Yes, thanks. I came up from San Diego yesterday.
Mrs D: And did you find a nice hotel?
Mr Lo: No. I'm staying at my parents' place in Oakland.
Mrs D: Oh, that's right, you're from the Bay area, aren't you?
Mr Lo: Yes. I was born and raised in Oakland.
Mrs D: When did you leave?
Mr Lo: I went to college in L.A. That was in 1988.
Mrs D: So, where are you presently working?
Mr Lo: Soledad Computers in San Diego. Have you heard of them?
Mrs D: No, not really. How long have you been with them?
Mr Lo: I've been working there since I graduated from college.
Mrs D: Why do you want to change jobs now?
Mr Lo: I'd like to do some travelling. I want to use my languages, and I want a better job.
114
Mrs D: Yes. I see here that you speak Chinese and Spanish.
That's OK.
Do you want to live closer to your parents? Mr Lo: That's not the reason why I want this job. But yes, I'd
like to live in this area again. Mrs D: Well, thank you, Mr Lo. We'll be in touch.
A. Questions
I. Where is Mr Lo presently working? 2. What is he doing in Oakland? 3. Where was Mr Lo born? 4.
When and why did he leave Oakland? 5. Why does Mr Lo want to change his job? 6. What languages can
he speak?
B. Speak about Mr Lo.
C. Roleplay the conversation.
D. You are applying for a job. Write a brief description your interests, your character, any work
experience you already have and your ambitions for the future.
Resume
Name: Address:
Crystal Rosemary Danziger
1031 Stormont Avenue,
Long Beach, California, CA 90806
(213)097 6544
12.13.67
Telephone number: Date of birth: Place of birth: Education (from High School on):
Previous Employment: Languages spoken: Driver's licence:
(Mrs Du=Mrs Dukakis; Mrs Da=Mrs Danziger)
2. Mrs Du: Come in Mrs Danziger. Please have a seat.
Mrs Da: Please call me Crystal. My, you have a nice office.
Mrs Du: Thank you. Did you have a good trip?
Mrs Da: It was OK. I got in on the early flight this morning.
Mrs Du: Ah, you're from Los Angeles, aren't you?
Mrs Da: I live in L.A. at the present time, but I'm originally
115

from New York. Of course, I'm not often in L.A. I've been to seven countries this year.
Mrs Du: Tell me about your present job.
Mrs Da: I'm a sales representative for a book publisher... Travel Books Incorporated. We sell guide
books and maps. I travel around Latin America. You see from my resume that I speak Spanish and

Portuguese. I majored in Spanish for my Bachelors degree and then...


Mrs Du: Where did you get your degree?
Mrs Da: I got it from the University of Chicago. Then, after that, I did my Masters at the University
of New Mexico.
Mrs Du: How long have you been with Travel Books?
Mrs Da: Two years. Before that I was with the Disney company for a year in Florida, and before that
I worked at a commercial stationery company in Dallas for six months.
Mrs Du: Have you ever sold computer software?
Mrs Da: No, but selling is selling. It's all the same to me.
Mrs Du: And do you speak any Asian languages?
Mrs Da: No, but I learn fast. I majored in languages. Now I want to ask you some questions about
this job...
A. Crystal's resume is not completed. How much of her resume can you complete?
B. Speak about Crystal s career.
C. Roleplay the conversation.
D. Situation: You have applied for a job. At the moment you're being interviewed.
(I = Interviewer; N = Nancy Mann)
3. I: Who do you work for at the moment, Mrs Mann? N: Um, I work for the BBC World Service.
I: Ah, and how long have you worked for the BBC? N: I've been with the BBC for five years. Yes,
exactly five
years.
I: And how long have you been their German Correspondent? N: For two years. I: And what did
you do before the BBC?
116
N: I worked as an interpreter for the EU.
I: As you know, this job is based in Geneva. Have you ever lived abroad before?
N: Oh yes, yes I have.
I: And when did you live abroad?
N: Well, in fact I was born in Argentina and I lived there until I was eleven. Also, I lived and worked
in Brussels for two years when I was working for the EU.
I: Mmm... That's interesting. Have you travelled much?
N: Oh yes, yes indeed. I've travelled all over western and eastern Europe, and I've also been to many
parts of South America.
I: Mmm... And why did you go to these places?
N: Well, mostly for pleasure, but three years ago I went back
to Argentina to cover various political stories in Buenos
Aires for the BBC.
A. Study and practise the conversation.
B.
Here are some more events from Nancy Mann's life. She was born in Argentina in 1959.
She went to boarding school in England from 1970 to 1977. She studied French and German when
she was at Oxford University.
She hasn't spoken Spanish since she was in Buenos Aires three years ago.
She's worked in both eastern and western Europe at various
times in her life.
She worked in Brussels for two years from 1989 to 1991.
She's worked for the BBC for the last five years.
She hasn't worked abroad since her son was born four years
ago.
She married for the first time when she was twenty-one. She's been married three times. She married
for the third time last year. Speak about Nancy Mann's life and career. C. Speak about your life and
career.
(I=Interviewer; Miss J=Miss Jones) 4. I:
Good morning, Miss...
117

Miss J: Miss Jones.


I:
Miss Jones, yes, right. Hi. Urn... now, you'd like to

join our team, I gather. Miss J: Yes, I would.


I:
That's very good. Er... I'd like to know a little bit
about you. Perhaps you could tell me a little bit about your education.
Miss J: Oh yes, right. Well, I left school at 18 and for the first two years I went to Gibsons, you might
know them, they're an engineering firm. Um... and after that, I wanted to do a course, so I did a oneyear full-time PA course and went back to Gibsons. I was PA to the Export Director. I stayed there for
two years and... and then moved on to my present company. That's Europa Marketing... um... Mr
Adair, the marketing director, offered me a job because Gibson had worked quite a lot with Europa
Marketing. And I've been with them for three years now... um... first working with the Marketing
Director and now I'm with the Sales Director.
I:
That's all very interesting, Miss Jones. Um... I'd like
to know, what did you enjoy most at school? What was the course that you enjoyed most? Miss J:
Ah... foreign languages I liked best. We did French
and German. Yes.
I:
Mhm. Are you quite fluent in those now or...?
Miss J: Yes, a bit rusty now, but... urn... obviously the more travel I can do the more I can use my
languages and I'd like to learn another language. I'd like to add Italian as well. I:
Italian?
Miss J: Yes.
.
Very good, very good, that might be very useful. Now...
er... tell me a little bit about the work you're doing at present.
Miss J: Um... well... er... Europa Marketing is a marketing and public relations company and they do
consultancy work for companies operating in the UK and European markets. Er... our clients come
from all over the world... um...we deal with some of them by post,
118

but most of them come to our offices at least once during a project. I assist the sales director by
arranging these visits, setting up meetings and presentations and I... I deal with her correspondence.
I've not been able to go with her on any of her trips abroad, but I... I've been to firms in this country,
several times on my own... um... to make these arrangements.
I:
It sounds as if you're very happy there, Miss Jones.
I'm curious why you'd like to leave them and join our company.
Miss J: Well... um... I know the reputation of Anglo-European and it has a very good reputation. And
I feel that I would have more scope and opportunity in your company and that the work will be more
challenging for me. I might be able to possibly travel and use my languages because at the moment
most of my work is... is rather routine secretarial-type and I like the idea of more...um... challenges in
my life really...
A. Questions
I. What is Miss Jones' educational background? 2. What firm is she working for at present? 3. What
does she do? 4. Why does she want to change her job?
B. Speak about Miss Jones' career.
C. Roleplay the conversation between Miss Jones and the interviewer.
D. Interview your teacher or a person whom your teacher invites to class. Use the outline given below.
I. Professional life
A. Present teaching duties
B. Academic duties and activities outside of teaching
C. Past teaching experience
D. Educational background
II. Personal life
A. Basic biographical information (eg. place of birth, family background, places of residence)
B. Spare-time activities and interests
C. Travel experiences
119
That must be an exciting job
Peter: So you're a journalist. That must be an exciting job. Helen: It is, at times. It's certainly better
than being a teacher! Peter: Oh, really? Helen: Yeah. I used to be a teacher, but I hated it! The worst
thing about teaching is correcting homework. That's

why I quit. Peter: I guess you travel a lot now and meet lots of interesting
people.
Helen: Yes, that's one of the best things about my job. Peter: Sounds great. I wish I had a job like
that. Helen: Where do you work? Peter: In an office. It's kind of boring. I'm stuck inside all day,
and I have to work long hours. Helen: Oh? What do you do? Peter: I'm a vice president.
A. 1. What is Helen's job? 2. Does she like her job? 3. What did she use to do some time ago? 4.
What didn't she like about teaching? 5. What does Peter do? 6. What does he say about his job?
B. Roleplay the conversation.
C. 1. Which do you think is more interesting, being a teacher or being a journalist? Why? 2. Have
you or has a family member ever quit a job? Why? 3. Would you like to exchange jobs with your
boss? Why or why not? 4. What are five well-paid jobs in your country?
What are you doing?
Carlos: Julia!
Julia: Hi, Carlos. It's so good to see you!
Carlos: It's great to see you! How are you?
Julia: I'm terrific.
Carlos: It's been a long time! What are you doing now?
Julia: I got a new job. I'm a model.
Carlos: That's wonderful!
Julia: Oh, it is, it's terrific. There's lots of variety. I... I meet
120

very interesting people. I travel a lot. And the best thing is working with all these wonderful people.
And I get a fabulous salary...
Carlos: Oh, that's great!
Julia: However, I have to tell you it's very long hours, and I have to work weekends sometimes. How
about you? What are you doing?
Carlos: Oh, well. I'm still at the restaurant, but I was promoted. I'm a manager now.
Julia: Wonderful! And do you like it?
Carlos: Oh, I like it. It's a lot more challenging in a lot of ways. The salary is much better... I'm much
better paid... it's a lot more interesting. You know, the worst thing about being a waiter was that, you
know, I wasn't getting any tips. The salary was not as good.
Julia: Mmm...
Carlos: Now I have more responsibility... it's just a lot better. But one thing I really don't like is I
have to wear a suit and tie every day.
Julia: Oh, no!
Carlos: So, but, you know, it's a small price to pay for being a
manager.
Julia: Oh, that sounds terrific! Carlos: So I'm having a great time. Julia: Great! Well, it was great
seeing you again. Carlos: Oh, it was great to see you! Good luck with everything! Julia: Thank you.
Carlos: OK. Julia: Bye-bye! Carlos: Bye!
A. Questions
1. What is Julia's job? 2. Why does she like her job? 3. What doesn't she like about it? 4. What does
Carlos do? 5. Why is his present job better than his last job? 6. What doesn't he like about his job?
B. Roleleplay the conversation.
C. What is your job? What do you like or dislike about it? Compare your present job with your last
job.
121

D. Compare these jobs:


a teacher and a student a mechanic and an engineer a pilot and a flight attendant a nurse and a doctor
I'd rather Be on Commission
John: Have you thought about what you want to do after you
graduate, Rita? Rita: Oh, yeah. I think about it all the time. I've been looking
for some jobs in the newspaper, but I really need to
start interviewing soon. John: You know, I've heard there're some really good jobs
in the government. Those jobs are pretty secure and...

and you get excellent medical benefits. Rita: Yeah, but I'd rather not work for the government.
Those jobs seem so boring and the salaries are low.
I' d prefer to find an interesting company to work for
where I could work on my own... John: Uh-huh...
Rita: You know, be creative and really use my skills. John: Well, what about something like
saleswork? You could
be independent, creative... Rita: Well, yeah, I've thought of that... and I really like the
idea... I could meet lots of different people and... John: Sure!
Rita: ... do some travelling and maybe get out of the office. John: Yeah, sounds like it's right up
your alley! I wonder
how much money you can make in sales, though. Do
you have any idea what starting salaries are like? Rita: Mmm, I don't know... but, actually, I think
I'd rather
be on commission... John: Oh? Rita: ... so that way I'd get paid according to how successful
lam.
John: Ah?
Rita: I could make much more money that way. I think I'd prefer that to getting a salary.
122

John: Well, Rita, I think you've got a great future in sales.


A. Questions
1. What will Rita have to do soon? 2. Why doesn't she want to work for the government? 3. What
kind of work would she prefer?
B. Roleplay the conversation.
C. Gmup work. Can you think of (a) three jobs where you can get commissions, (b) three jobs that
are challenging, and (c) three jobs that have a lot of responsibility? Choose three of these jobs and
list three advantages and three disadvantages for each.
D. homemaker
teacher
taxi driver travelling salesperson construction worker
police officer How interesting are the jobs above?
On the way to Seoul,
Franco: Hello, Bill.
Bill:
Franco, hello.
TogetherWhat are you doing here?
Bill:
I'm flying to Seoul, of course. Well, well, this is a surprise! How are you?
Franco: Fine. Fine. What are you working for? Are you still with BTB?
Bill:
Oh no. I'm with Macdonald Harris. I'm one of their project managers.
Franco: Really? I'm sorry I don't know them.
Bill:
We're part of Excel.
Franco: I see. So why are you going to Seoul?
Bill:
I have to visit a possible supplier of components. I'm checking the quality and the
specifications and then I'm flying to Taiwan. There's an assembly plant there using some of our
equipment and they're having some trouble with it.
Franco: Where are you staying in Seoul?
Bill:
At the Sheraton. For two nights.
Franco: So am I. Perhaps we get together, go out for a meal or something.
123

Bill: That sounds like a great idea. Anyway, how are you Franco? What are you doing in the Far
East?
Franco: I'm visiting a friend.
Air hostess: Would passengers please return to their seats and fasten their seat belts?
Bill: Eh, Franco. I'd better get back to my seat. I'll catch you later.
A. I. Where are Bill and Franco flying? 2. What is Bill going to do in Seoul? 3. Why is he flying on
to Taiwan? 4. Where are the two friends staying in Seoul? 5. What does Franco suggest?
B. Give a brief account of the conversation.
C. Roleplay the conversation.
D. Write a report on a business trip.

E. Speak about the company you are working for.


What's your Background? Klaus and Anna are speaking about their careers.
Klaus: What did you do at university?
Anna: Economics.
Klaus: Where was that?
Anna: At the University of Uppsala.
Klaus: Did you enjoy your time there?
Anna: Oh, yes. It's a very good university.
Klaus: Yes, it has a high reputation. And after that. What did
you do then? Anna: I worked for my father. He has a small engineering
business. I'd worked for him during the vacation, you know, while I was studying. But we didn't get
along very well so I got a job in a post office. Klaus: A post office! I can't imagine you in a postoffice! Anna: No, I didn't like it very much. It was very boring. Anyway, I finally got a job in the
International Exchange Department at Svensaka. Klaus: How long were you in that job? Anna: Oh,
about two and a half years. Then I answered an internal advert for this job in the Purchasing
Department.
124
Klaus: Do you like it?
Anna: Yes, I really enjoy it because you meet so many different
people and I often have to travel abroad. Anyway, how
about you? What's your background?
A. Study and practise the conversation.
B. Write a synopsis of Anna s career history.
C. Write a synopsis of your career history.
D. Situation: You and your classmate are speaking about your educational and business background.
"Do you Enjoy r Work? (I=Interviewer)
I:
What do you do?
Peter: I'm described as an area sales manager. I go round
visiting shops, maybe five or six per day when I'm travelling. The rest of the time I spend in the
office, answering queries from customers about sales and planning the next trip. My trips usually last
about two or three weeks and I go mostly to Germany, Austria and Switzerland.
I:
What do you find rewarding about the work?
Peter: Well, the travel as much as anything else. Um... the job is fairly badly paid, but the fact that I
get free trips to the foreign countries more or less of my choice for most of the year does in some
measure recompense for that.
I:
What do you find frustrating or annoying about it?
Peter: Well, I've already mentioned the pay. Um... obviously frustrating is also customers that leave
one waiting, but on the whole the frustrations of the job are minimal.
A. Questions
1. What does Peter do? 2. What does he find rewarding about his work? 3. What does he find
frustrating about it?
B. Find out more about your partner s career. Ask about his or her:
125
Present job its rewards and frustrations.
Work experience previous jobs (or educational courses, if your partner hasn't worked. But do find out
about any temporary or part-time jobs your partner has done.)
Education and training.
Ambitions and prospects for the future.
When you have both finished, join another pair and tell them what you have discovered about each other.

I'ii, take you on a little tour


Margaret:
Mr Bronson, you wanted to see me? Mr Bronson: Oh... Margaret, yeah, thanks for coming
down. This is Michelle Duhamel... er... Margaret Brown. Margaret:
Hello Michelle. Michelle:
Pleased to meet you. Mr Bronson: You'll be working with her. Margaret: Ah.
Mr Bronson: Margaret, ah... what I'd like you to do is to show Michelle around the offices, just so that she
can get an idea where everything is. Is that OK? Margaret:
Of course. Er... yes, I'll take her on a little

tour,
shall I?
Mr Bronson: Yeah, good idea. I'll see you later this afternoon, Michelle. Let's say... at 3 o'clock. OK? Bye
bye now.
Margaret: All right, Michelle, let's go out into the corridor. Michelle: The trouble is I've noticed not
all the doors have
got names on them, so it's all a bit confusing. Margaret: Well, I think the best thing is if we go back to
Reception and then I'll take you round the offices on this floor.
Michelle:
OK, that's a good idea... (Some minutes later)
Margaret:
...well here we are... er... back at the main entrance. So let's go through Reception into the
main corridor. OK? Michelle:
Hm, hm.
Margaret:
Right opposite us is the Post Room, you see? Michelle:
Yes.
126
Margaret: Then if we go up the corridor... we come to Mr Gru-ber's office.
Michelle: Aha.
Margaret: He's the General Manager. His secretary is Mrs Santini. And we just passed the Personnel
Manager's office on the right, that's where we started from.
Michelle: What was all that noise coming from the room between Reception and the Personnel Manager's
secretary's office?
Margaret: Aha, yes. That's the Photocopying Room. And that room on the right is the Accounts
Manager's office. And the other door on the right is Bookkeeping. On the left is our Typing Pool as
you can hear.
Michelle:
Er... what's through the glass doors at the end?
Margaret: Ah, that's the Canteen.
Michelle: Er... just one more thing...um...where's the ladies?
Margaret: Oh, I'm sorry, yes of course. The toilets are right opposite the Photocopying Room.
Michelle: Aha, fine.
Margaret:
OK, here's the lift. Shall we go up to our floor?
A. Study and practise the conversation.
B. Talk about your place of work. This may include actually showing someone physically around the
office or premises. Furthermore, people in business may often be called upon to describe to outsiders or
friends what their company does; they may even be expected to talk about what their company has done
in the past and about the contemporary developments of a firm.

Listening
Alecture of uncleTheo
My uncle Theo is a grey-haired man whose thoughts were always on learning and nothing else. Once he
applied for a post in Camford University. It was a very good post and there were hundreds of candidates
who applied for it, and about fifteen, including Theo,
127
were asked to come to Camford. There is only one hotel in Camford, and this was so full that they had to
put the candidates two in a room. The man who shared the room with Theo was a fellow called Adams
with a loud voice and a laugh that you could hear all over the hotel. But he was a clever fellow all the
same.
Well, the Dean and the committee interviewed all the candidates and as a result of this interview, the
number was reduced to two, Uncle Theo and Adams. The committee could not decide which of the two to
take, so they decided to make their final choice after each candidate gave a public lecture in the college
lecture-room. The lecture was to be given in three days' time.
For three days Uncle Theo never left his room. He worked day and night at that lecture almost without
eating or sleeping. Adams didn't seem to do any preparations at all. He asked Theo how he was getting on
with his lecture and then told him how he had spent the evening.
The day of the lecture came. And then Theo discovered, to his horror, that the typewritten copy of his
speech had disappeared. The Dean said he would call on the candidates in alphabetical order, Adams first.
Theo watched Adams calmly take his stolen speech out of his pocket and read it to the professors who
gathered to hear it. He read it well. Now it was Theo's turn. But what could he do? He could only repeat
the lecture, word for word in a low, dull voice. The Dean and the committee went out to decide who the
successful candidate was, but everyone was sure what their decision would be. Then they came back.
"Gentlemen," the Dean said, "the candidate we have chosen isMr Theo." The audience were completely

taken by surprise and the Dean continued. "I think I ought to tell you how we arrived at that decision. We
were greatly impressed by the lecture of Mr Adams. But you will remember, Mr Adams read his lecture to
us. When Mr Theo's turn came, he repeated that speech, word for word, from memory, though of course,
he had never seen a line of it before. Now a fine memory is absolutely necessary for this post. That is why
we decided that Mr Theo was exactly the man we wanted."
A. Questions
1. What post did Uncle Theo once apply for? 2. Were there many candidates for that post? 3. Who were
the most successful candidates? 4. How did the committee decide to make their final
128
choice? 5. Who did Theo share his room with? 6. How did they prepare for the lecture? 7. What happened
on the day of the lecture? 8. Why did the committee choose Uncle Theo for that post?
A Dog
(after M. Twain)
A few days ago I met General Miles at my friend's house. General Miles was a very nice man and we
became friends quickly.
"Did you live in Washington in 1887?" asked me the general. "Yes, I did', I answered. "Why didn't we
meet then?" said the general. "General", I said, "you forget that you were already a great general then, and
I was a poor young writer whom nobody knew and whose books nobody read."
"You do not remember me," I thought, "but we met once in Washington at that time."
I remember it very well. I was poor at that time. Once I needed three dollars. I don't remember why I
needed those 3 dollars but I remember well that I needed the money by the evening. I did not know where
to go and how to get those 3 dollars. For an hour I was walking along the streets of Washington and was
very tired. At last I came to a big hotel. "I shall go and have a rest," I thought.
I went into the hall of the hotel and sat down on a sofa. I was sitting when a beautiful dog ran into the
hall. The dog was very nice and I began to play with it.
I was playing with the dog when a man came into the hall. He wore a beautiful uniform and I thought:
"That is General Miles." I knew him by the pictures in the newspapers.
"Oh, what a beautiful dog! Is it yours?" I did not have time to answer when he said, "Do you want to sell
it?" When I heard those words I thought about the 3 dollars which I wanted to get.
"Well, ...I... I think..."
"That is good," said the general, "how much do you want for it?"
"3 dollars," I answered at once.
"Three dollars?" he asked, "but that is very little. I can give you 5 dollars for it."
"Oh, no, I want only 3 dollars." "Well, it is your dog. If you want 3 dollars for it, I shall be glad to buy
your dog."
53 1111

129

General Miles paid me 3 dollars, took the dog and went to his room.
A few minutes later an old man came into the hall. He looked round the hall. I saw he was looking
for something. "Are you looking for a dog, sir?" I asked. "Oh, yes! Did you see it?" said the man. "I
saw a man who took it. I'll be glad to help you to find it but it will take some of my time..." "I am
ready to pay for your time," cried the man. "How much do you want for it?" "3 dollars," I answered.
"Three dollars?" said the man. "But it is a very good dog. I can pay you 10 dollars." "No, sir, I want
only 3 dollars," I said. Then I went to General Miles' room. I gave back his money saying that the
dog wasn't mine and I must return it to its master. The general was very angry.
When I brought the dog back, its master was very happy and he paid me three dollars with joy. I was
happy too because I had the money and I felt I had earned it.
A. Questions
1. Who did the writer meet at his friend's house? 2. What did the general ask him? 3. Had Mark
Twain met the general before? 4. Where and when did they first meet? 5. How did Mark Twain earn
the money he needed?

Reading
industry and the Workforce
By the end of the 1980s Britain's working population the workforce was around 22 million (38 per
cent of the total population). Those in employment include full-time, part-time and self-employed
people.

People are employed in three sectors: primary, manufacturing and service. The primary sector is
concerned with raw materials such as cereals and minerals. Processing these materials is the field of
the manufacturing sector. The service sector provides services of various kinds such as transport or
distribution, but does not manufacture goods. Employment is also often divided into sections
according to types of work and social class. These categories include professional, manual and nonmanual. A doctor, for example, would be classified as a professional in the
130

service sector, while a steelworker would be a manual worker (skilled or unskilled) in the
manufacturing sector. The old distinction between white-collar (non-manual) and blue-collar
(manual) has become less clear: fewer people now make cars or work in coal mines; more work for
banks and hotels.
In 1951 96 per cent of the people in work in Britain had full-time jobs and the majority of these (70
per cent) were held by men. By 1988 25 per cent of jobs were part time and 45 per cent of workers
were women: so one basic trend in employment in the 1980s was a general rise in the number of
part-time jobs for women, particularly in service industries. The number of people who were selfemployed also rose considerably, increasing by over half a million between 1983 and 1987. This was
due to changing work patterns and to the high levels of unemployment of the 1980s.
As well as regional and occupational variations there are big differences in pay between men and
women (whose average wage is around two-thirds of the male average wage) even when the same
job is involved. Certain higly-paid occupations such as surgery are still almost exclusively confined
to men.
A. Questions
1. How many people in Britain had jobs at the end of the 1980s? Which categories of work are
mentioned? 2. In which industrial areas did the number of workers (a) decline and (b) increase? 3.
What examples of jobs are given in the text and how are they classified? 4. Are there any differences
between the average earnings of men and women in Britain?
B. Discussion
1. Explain the following: a white-collar worker, a surgeon, the workforce, self-employed.
2. Which sector of industry would the following people be involved in: a nurse, a shipbuilder, a
waitress, a building-site foreman, a secretary, a farmer, a teacher, a factory worker, a bank manager?
Patterns of Unemployment
During the 1980s high unemployment was a political and social problem which refused to go away,
although the number of people
131

without jobs began to fall from the mid-1980s onwards. One result was high government spending on
unemployment and social security payments. For those without jobs the effects on health, family and
prosperity were often serious.
When the Conservative government came to power in Britain in 1979 the number of people without
work totalled approximately 3 per cent of the workforce. By 1986 this figure had increased to nearly
10 per cent with unemployment in some areas (Northern Ireland for example) being as high as 20 per
cent. By 1988 the position had improved and government figures stated that the total number of
people out of work and claiming benefit had dropped to around 7 per cent of the workforce, the
lowest figure for eight years. Regional differences remained, with the South East having the lowest
figures and the North of England and Northern Ireland still having much higher rates than the
national average.
During the 1980s the government introduced a large number of different schemes to retrain older
people and to give school-leavers and young people a better chance of getting a job. But despite these
schemes, as in a number of other countries, the unemployment figures remained high and continued
to be one of the major political issues of the 1980s.
A. Questions
1. How did unemployment change between 1979 and 1988
according to government figures?
2. What effects did unemployment have on:
a) government spending?
b) individuals?

3. Where was unemployment lower than the national average?


Where was it higher?
B. Discussion
1. Compare the rate of unemployment in Britain with other countries.
2. Which areas of your country have suffered most from unemployment? What sort of industries have
had the most problems? What new industries have appeared?
132

At Work
For many people with jobs, there was an improvement in pay and working conditions. The amount of
holidays increased (for example over three-quarters of all manual employees had between four and
five weeks' paid holiday per year) and the average working week, excluding overtime, fell to under
40 hours. Negotiations took place in a number of industries to reduce the retirement age from the
traditional 65 for men and 60 for women.
For many, working conditions improved and under the "enterprise economy" some people did very
well. Others, especially women and part-time workers in the service industries were not so lucky.
Britain had reputation during the 1970s for frequent strikes and bad industrial relations, although
some other industrialised countries in fact had worse records. There was a dramatic decrease in the
number of strikes m Britain during the 1980s but industrial relations continued to be an area of
dispute. The Conservative government passed laws limiting the powers of the trade unions, which
helped to reduce the numbers of people in unions. Some industrial action still occurred: miners,
teachers, seamen and health workers were all involved in arguments overpay and conditions during
the 1980s.
A. Questions
1. For most workers in Britain what has happened to:
a) the working week?
b) paid holidays?
c) the standard of living?
2. Who benefited least from the "enterprise economy"?
3. What sort of jobs are the best paid and the worst paid in
Britain?
B. Discussion
1. What sort of jobs pay the most and the least in your country?
2. Is Britain's reputation as a country with lots of strikes still justified? What happens in your country
when there is an industrial dispute? Are there any laws against strikes?
133
Jennifer's Career
This is Jennifer Bradbury. In this unit she describes some of her earliest memories and other things that
happened to her when she was young.
1
I think my first memories start when I was about three or perhaps four years old. I remember falling from
a tree and breaking my arm. I think I was playing in the garden of the big, old house we lived in. It was in
a suburb of London. I can also remember starting school when I was five. There was a little boy called
Thomas in the same class. He used to pull my hair when the teacher wasn't looking. One day I hit him
over the head with a book and he began to cry. The teacher was very very angry with me. I remember him
saying, "Little girls don't do things like that!" But Thomas never pulled my hair again.
Q What are some of Jennifer's earliest memories?
Even though I didn't have any brothers or sisters, I had a happy childhood. I don't remember feeling
lonely or anything like that. I had a lot of friends. But I had to leave them all when I was eight. My father
worked for a big international company and they sent him to Chicago, in the United States. Naturally my
mother and I went with him. At first I didn't like Chicago at all.
The winters were terribly cold and the children at school there laughed at my "funny accent". But after a
while I got used to my new life and began to enjoy it very much.
Q Why did Jennifer have to leave her friends? 3
We stayed in Chicago for six years. Then the company sent my father back to London and I had to get

used to living in England all over again. I also had to think about what I wanted to do later. I remember a
teacher asking us once what our ambitions were. I was sixteen at the time. Most of the other girls in the
class said they wanted to get married as soon as possible or to get jobs as secretaries. I don't remember
exactly what I said. But one thing
134

was clear to me even then. I didn't intend to be a housewife or a mother. And I certainly didn't want to
spend the rest of my life behind a typewriter, either. I wanted some kind of career, but I didn't really know
what it was.
At the age of eighteen I left school and took a job for the summer in a Tourist Information office. It was
hardly a career. But something happened there which changed my life.
Q In what way was Jennifer different from most of the other girls in her class?
When Jennifer was eighteen, she took a job for the summer in a Tourist Information office. Something
very important happened to her there.
1
It was the first time I had ever worked, so I was glad to have the experience. The job consisted mostly of
dealing with letters, phone calls and tourists who came into the office. There was a young man called
Howard who worked there, too. He was about a year older than I was. I think he was rather shy. I often
saw him looking at me. When I looked back at him, he used to go red in the face. One day he asked me if
I liked musicals. When I said I did, he told me he had two tickets for one and that he hoped I would go
with him. I think I said I wanted to study that evening or something. But then he looked very sad and I
felt sorry for him. Finally I said I would go with him after all.
Q Do you think Howard liked Jennifer very much? Give reasons for your answer.
After that, I went out with Howard several times. He was very kind and generous, and in a way I was
rather fond of him, but that was all. Unfortunately, his feelings for me were much deeper than that. One
evening he suddenly told me he loved me and that he hoped we would get married. At first I was so
surprised that I just didn't know what to say. I didn't want to hurt him, so I finally told him that marriage
was out of the question for me until I finished university. Later I realised that this was a mistake and that I
should have told him the truth.
135

Q What was "the truth"?


Howard obviously hadn't understood what I was trying to say. He seemed to think we were almost
engaged. Then, one day, a well-dressed American came into the office and asked for a list of good
hotels. We started talking and he told me he was a professional photographer. He also said that he
was looking for new faces. When he mentioned his name, I realised I had heard it before. He was
Adam Sutherland and his photographs were used in all sorts of advertisements and in some very
famous magazines. He said I had a fine face and that he would like to take a few pictures of me. Then
he invited me to lunch later in the week.
Q Who was this "well-dressed" American and why did he invite Jennifer to lunch?
After he left, I saw Howard looking at me. He had been there all the time and had heard everything.
"You're not really meeting that fellow for lunch, are you?" he asked. I could see that he was very
jealous. I told him I wasn't sure. But I was really very eager to see Sutherland again. In fact, I could
hardly wait! Somehow I knew it was a wonderful opportunity and I just couldn't afford to miss it.
Q What do you think this "wonderful opportunity" was?
Jennifer Bradbury is now a successful businesswoman in her thirties. She was recently interviewed
for a magazine article about her earlier career as a model.
1
Five years ago, Jennifer Bradbury was a famous model at the top of her profession. Her face was
used to sell everything, from beauty soap to fast sports cars. Ten years before that she had been
"discovered" by the fashion photographer, Adam Sutherland. She was working in a Tourist
Information office in London at the time. One day, Sutherland came in and saw her. He immediately
realised she had exactly the kind of face he was looking for. A few days later he photographed her in
a rose garden and called
136

the series of pictures English Roses. They were a great hit when they were later published in an
American magazine. Other photographers saw the pictures and wanted to use Jennifer as well. "I was
amazed at how much I could earn and started modelling full-time," she says.

Q How and why did Jennifer become a model?


2
But Jennifer soon discovered that a model's life is not all wine and roses. Often, after a late party or a
hard day's work, she had to get out of bed feeling, as she puts it, "like death warmed up". But she still
had to look as fresh and beautiful as a morning flower. However, she admits there were some
advantages, too. "Itravelled a lot. and saw all sorts of places I would never have seen otherwise. I
worked in Rome, Frankfurt, New York, Paris and even Tokyo. But there wasn't much time for
sightseeing. And after a while I got tired of looking into a camera and smiling all the time!"
Q What did she like about being a model? What did she dislike?
3
About five years ago Jennifer gave up her career for a number of reasons. "First of all," as she says,
"I wanted to finish while I was still at the top, and after the age of thirty there is a lot less work for a
model. Secondly, I just wasn't enjoying the work very much any more." A third reason was
undoubtedly her bad experience with her agent, Murray King. Almost all models work through an
agent. The agent finds work for them and the money they earn is usually paid to the agent first. "I had
always trusted Murray. I realise now that was foolish of me. I didn't know that he was a big gambler
and that he owed a lot of people a great deal of money. One day he disappeared. His body was later
found in the river. When he disappeared, he still hadn't paid me over r2,000. After that, I decided I
had had enough of being a model and that it was time to do something else."
Q Who was Murray King? What happened to him?
137

Q This is part of another magazine article about Jennifer


Bradbury.
1
More and more women today can be found in the top positions in business and industry. An example of
this trend is Jennifer Bradbury. After a very successful career as a model, she became a clothes designer.
Then, with money she had saved and borrowed, she bought part of a small company that manufactured
sportswear and became one of its directors. As she says, it was then that "the real battle began". The other
directors often asked her opinion about the design and the colour of the company's products, but they
refused to believe she understood anything about the "hard side of business". Jennifer gives an example.
"The company sold its sportswear only through small, specialist shops. I was sure we would never
increase our sales unless we sold through big department stores and even supermarkets. The other two
directors didn't like the idea at all, at first. They were afraid we would lose some of our traditional
customers if we did what I wanted. I think part of the trouble was they didn't take the idea very seriously
simply because it came from a woman!"
Q What exactly was Jennifer's idea?
But Jennifer and her ideas are certainly taken very seriously now. Under her leadership, the company has
increased its sales and the number of customers. It also manufactures a much wider variety of
sportsclothes, many of them designed by Jennifer herself. One of the other two co-directors has resigned.
She has far fewer problems with the one who remains. But there are still many things that annoy her
about being a woman in business. "For example, I don't really like it when men compliment me about my
clothes or appearance, especially at business meetings. Perhaps this sounds strange. But I know those
same men wouldn't like it if their secretaries or another woman told them they liked their haircuts or the
suits they were wearing, or the colour of their socks! In this respect, women still aren't treated as equals!"
Q What kind of things doesn't Jennifer want to hear at business meetings?
138

Jennifer Bradbury says she has found great satisfaction in business. But what about some of the other
things in life that are still very important to many women? Things like marriage and children. Does
she regret not having time for these things? Jennifer thought about the question for a moment and
then answered very calmly. "I'm the sort of person who is happy in a serious relationship. But I don't
like the idea of being tied down, and I've never really wanted children."
^ What are some of the things Jennifer hasn't had time for in her life?

Self check
I. Put the verbs in brackets into the correct tense. Dear Peter,
You by any chance (know) where Bob is? I (like) to find out because I just (hear) of a job that exactly
(suit) him, but if he (not apply) fairly soon of course he (not get) it.

I last (see) him about a month ago, when he just (leave) his job with the film company. He (say) he (go) to
France for a holiday and (promise) to send me a postcard with his French address as soon as he (find) a
place to stay. But I (hear) nothing since then and (not know) even whether he (go) to France or not.
If you (know) his address I (be) very grateful if you (phone) me. I (try) to phone you several times but
your phone (not seem) to be working.
Yours, Jack
II. Here are sentences about t\venty-one people travelling to work on the London Underground Just
write the verbs in brackets in the correct form, using the other words given and putting in
prepositions where necessary
Peter objects (start) work at 9.00 and wants to start at 9.30. Mary doesn't approve (the new typist
take) such long tea breaks.
139
Jane wishes her boss wouldn't insist (she not eat) sandwiches in the office. John's thinking, "I hope
they'll have repaired my car by the time I get home this evening. I've got no wish (travel) on the
underground again tomorrow." Ann's angrily thinking about the man next to her who's smoking a
pipe, "Some people seem to take a delight (spoil) the comfort of other people." Chris has just
received his telephone bill, "It's far too high. I've got a good mind (not pay) it." Mr Martin is standing
because he offered his seat to a lady; he takes pride (be) a gentleman. Mrs Bell is having difficulty
(read) her newspaper because she forgot her glasses. Barry's going to work in spite (have) a very bad
cold. Sam sitting next to Barry, is worried (catch) his cold. Philip sometimes looks up and then
carries (read) his newspaper. Simon is good (do) crosswords and usually finishes the one in his paper
before he gets off. Jack can't stand the underground and is thinking (go) to work by bus. Denis, who
owes his bank 500, thinks, "There's no point (worry) about it." Kate's wondering whether she can
afford (buy) some expensive perfume or not. Mr Caner is looking forward (his daughter get) married
next week. Jenny isn't used (travel) on the underground and feels a bit ill. Mr Combes doesn't believe
(be) late and always gets to work very early. Martha is very pleased because her boyfriend has
invited her (go) to the opera. Ron's eating sweets because he resolved at the beginning of the year
(give up) smoking. Larry's pleased because he ran for the train and just managed (get on).
III. Here s a little story of someone who decided to work on an oil rig.
Martin decided to get a job on an oil rig in the North Sea. He was fed up with working in a factory
and wanted to try something completely different. He wasn't married, so there were no family
problems. A month later he was working on a rig. It was hard, often dangerous work, and he had to
be careful to make sure that he didn't injure himself. The men were careful and there were no
accidents. In the evening there was plenty to do to stop the men getting bored. Martin usually
watched films or read. The food wts top-class. No one ever complained about the food. The rooms
were top-class too. The oil company had made sure that the men would be comfortable, and that was
why they worked so well.
140
Three weeks later Martin finished his first period of work. The system was simple, three weeks'
work, followed by three weeks' holiday. Three weeks on the rig was long enough. The men didn't get
too tired that way. As Martin got into the helicopter to fly back to Scotland he decided that he felt
satisfied with things and that life wasn't boring any more.
Now imagine that a few months later Martin is describing what happened. For each of the spaces in
Martin's description below, write a few words in the past conditional.
'"I was bored with factory work. If I hadn't been bored 1(1), but I'd had enough. Of course, if I'd been
married (2), but luckily I wasn't. When I started I found it was hard work. If (3) I would have injured
myself. But we were all very careful. If we hadn't been careful, (4). It was nice relaxing in the
evenings. We had plenty to do. If we (5) plenty to do, we (6). I usually watched cowboy films, or
read. The food was marvellous. I've never eaten so well. If it (7) top-class, of course, (8). You can't
do a full day's work if the food's not good. They knew how to look after us. The oil company knew
that if (9) we (10). That three-weeks-on three-weeks-off is a good system. If (11) we would have got
too tired. Anyway, I'm glad I changed jobs. Life would have been boring if 1(12), and I (13) as
satisfied as I did when I got into that helicopter. I enjoyed that feeling."

UNIT 9 GRAMMAR: PASSIVE VOICE (REVIEW)


. Form

a We form passive verbs with the different tenses of be (eg is, vas, is being, have been) + past participle.
Present simple:
am/are/is + past participle
The office is locked every evening.
Present continuous:
am/are/is + being + past participle
The house is being painted at the moment.
Past simple:
was/were + past participle
My car was stolen last night.
Past continuous:
. was/were + being + past participle.
The bridge was being repaired last week.
Present perfect simple: have/has + been + past participle
Sarah has been invited to the party.
Past perfect simple:
had + been + past participle
I thought that you had been told the news.
Future Simple:
will + be + past participle
The letter will be posted tomorrow.
Future Perfect Simple:
will + have been + past participle
The texts will have been typed by 3 o'clock.
Perfect continuous passives are very uncommon.
b The rules for choosing tenses in the passive are the same as in the active. For example, to talk about
something that is in progress now, we use the present continuous.
The house is being painted at the moment.
142

2 Use
a We often use the passive when we do not know who or what does something.
My car was stolen last night. (I do not know who stole the car.)
b We also use the passive when we are not interested in who or what does something.
The factory was painted last year. Sarah has been invited to the party.
In these sentences we are interested in the factory and Sarah, not who painted the factory, or who
invited Sarah.
c We also use the passive when we do not want to say who or what does something. Compare:
Active: I made a mistake. Passive: A mistake was made.

Verbs with two objects in the passive


Some verbs eg give can have two objects.
Someone gave Jimmy the money. (The two objects are Jimmy and the money.)
In cases like this, we can make two different passive sentences.
Jimmy was given the money. The money was given to Jimmy.
In general, it is more usual for passive sentences to begin with the person.
Other verbs which can have two objects include send, offer, show, pay, teach, promise, tell and
others.
I was sent a telegram. She will be told the news.
143
The passive with by and with
1 By + agent
Compare:
Active: Columbus discovered America. Passive: America was discovered by Columbus. Active:
The strong winds blew down a number of trees. Passive: A number of trees were blown down by the
strong winds.
We sometimes use the subject of an active sentence (eg Columbus, the strong winds) as "the agent" in
a passive sentence. When this happens, we use by to introduce the agent in the passive.
We only use by + agent when it is important to say who or what is responsible for something.
2 With + instrument
We use with to talk about an instrument which is used by the agent to do something. Compare:
I was hit with an umbrella. I was hit by an old lady.
3 With + material
We also use with to talk about materials or ingredients.

The room was filled with smoke. Irish coffee is made with whisky.
Stative passive
a) I locked the door five minutes ago.
b) The door was locked by me five minutes ago.
c) Now the door is locked.
d) Ann broke the window.
e) The window was broken by Ann.
f) Now the window is broken.
The passive form may be used to describe an existing situation or state, as in (c) and (f). No action is
taking place. The action
144

happened before. There is no "by phrase." The past participle functions as an adjective.
When the passive form expresses an existing state rather than an action, it is called the "stative
passive."

Self check
I. Supply the correct form of the verb in brackets.
1. There isn't any food left. All of it (eat)! 2.1 couldn't wear my suit last Saturday. It (clean). 3. We
didn't go to the party on Saturday because we (not/invite). 4. Wine (produce) in many parts of France.
5.1 can't find my car anywhere. I think it (steal). 6. By the time I arrived at the concert hall, there
were no tickets left. They (all/sell). 7. How many languages (speak) in Switzerland? 8. The Tower of
London (build) at the beginning of the eleventh century. 9. "What's going on in the hall?" "The
windows (wash)". 10. Our house (break into) last week. 11. We couldn't use the photocopier
yesterday morning. It (repair). 12. When (television/ invent)? 13. A compass (use) for showing
direction. 14. Have you heard? The old police station (repaint). 15. The 1986 World Cup for soccer
(play) in Mexico. 16. Millions of cars (export) from Japan every month. 17. Football (play) all over
the world.
18. I (frighten) to death when I drove through Paris last month.
19. His car (damage) in an accident last month. 20. "What's happened?" "The window (break)." 21.
"Can I take the documents?" "I'm afraid not. They (not/type) yet." 22. An island (surround) by water.
23. The electric bulb (invent) by Thomas Edison. 24. Even though construction costs are high, a
new dormitory (build) next year. 25. The class was too large, so it (divide) into two sections. 26. A
bracelet (wear) around the wrist. 27. The Johnsons' house burned down. According to the inspector,
the fire (cause) by lightning. 28. "Is the plane going to be late?" "No. It (expect) to be on time." 29.
The new highway (complete) sometime next month. 30. The World Cup soccer games (televise) all
over the world. 31. The Washington Monument (visit) by hundreds of people every day. 32.1 had to
wait a little. When I came the students (test). 33. Last week I (offer) a job at a local bank, but I didn't
accept. 34.1 read about a hunter who (kill) by a wild animal. The hunter's fatal accident (report) in
the newspaper
145
yesterday. 35. My sweater (make) in England. 36. Language skills (teach) in every school in the
country. 37. Beethoven's Seventh Symphony (perform) at the concert last night. 38. This composition
(write) by AH. That one (write) by Yoko. 39. Paper, the main writing material today, (invent) by the
Chinese. 40. When (the room/clean)? 41. How (the window/break)? 42. (anybody/ injure) in the
accident?. 43. My brother (bite) by a dog last week. 44. How often (these rooms/clean)? 45. Many
foreign movies (show) on television. 46. "Is this an old movie?" "Yes, it (make) in 1949." 47. Tony
(bear) in Rome. Where (you/bear)? 48. The documents (type) by the time you return. 49. The
accident (see) by several people. 50. The books (send) tomorrow. 51. There are a lot of students in
the hall. A new film (show). 52. Maria is happy. She (offer) a good job. Peggy is also very happy. She
(award) a scholarship. 53. Rice (grow) in many countries. 54.1 (tell) to be here at ten o'clock. 55.
"(you/send) an invitation to the wedding?" "No." 56. Dinner (serve) at six. 57. A test (give) in the
next room right now. 58. You (send) a bill at the end of the month. 59. Fred is pleased. He (pay) five
hundred dollars in consulting fees. 60. Don't water the plants. They just (water). 61. The news
(announce) tomorrow. 62. The fanner's wagon (pull) by two horses. 63. That play (write) by
Shakespeare. 64.1 think Ann (invite) to the party tomorrow. 65. A new idea (suggest) by Shirley. She

is very proud of it. 66. The librarian said that the book (return) to the library some days ago. 67. By
this time tomorrow, the announcement (make). 68. (that course/teach) by Prof. Jackson? I know that
it (not/teach) by Prof. Adams. 69. There is a nasty smell coming from the sitting-room. The floor
(paint) there. 70.1 (interview) by the assistant manager. I was very excited during the interview, but I
got the job. 71. America (discover) by Christopher Columbus.
II. Change the sentences from active to passive. Include the "by-phrase " only if necessary.
1. Bob Smith built that house. That house was built by Bob
Smith.
2. Someone built this house in 1904. This house was built in 1904. (by someone = unnecessary)
3. People grow rice in India. 4. People speak Spanish in Venezuela.
146
5. Do people speak Spanish in Peru? 6. Alexander Graham Bell invented the telephone. 7. When did
someone invent the wheel? 8. People sell hammers at a hardware store. 9. People use hammers to
pound nails. 10. The president has cancelled the meeting. 11. Someone has cancelled the soccer
game. 12. Someone will list my name in the new telephone directory. 13. Someone serves beer and
wine at that restaurant. 14. Something confused me in class yesterday. 15. Something embarrassed
me yesterday. 16. Someone has changed the name of this street from Bay Avenue to Martin Luther
King Way. 17. Someone filmed many of the Tarzan movies in the rain forest in Puerto Rico. 18. My
uncle will meet you at the airport. 19. Lightning didn't cause the fire. 20. Mr Snow hasn't taught that
course since 1990. 21. The best chess player will win the match. 22. A special committee is going to
settle the dispute. 23. Did the army surround the enemy? 24. The Persians invented windmills around
1 500 years ago. 25. No one will collect the garbage tomorrow. 26. People spell "writing" with one
"t". 27. People spell "written" with two "t's." 28. The University of Minnesota has accepted me. 29.
People held the 1988 Summer Olympics in Seoul, Korea. 30. No one delivers the mail on holidays.
31. My grandmother made that table. 32. Did my directions confuse you? 33. A maid will clean our
hotel room. 34. A doctor has examined the sick child. 35. The police arrested James Swan. 36. The
news will amaze you. 37. The news will shock Steve. 38. Did Johnny break the window? 39. They
are fixing my car today. 40. Look! Someone is feeding the seals. 41. People didn't build Rome in a
day. 42. Someone cut down that tree last week. 43. Sally made that pie. 44. Someone is considering
Jack for that job. 45. Three continents surround the Mediterranean Sea. 46. Where do they file that
information? 47. Before we arrived, someone had chained the dog to the fence in the backyard. 48.
Did the noise from the neighbour's apartment annoy you last night? 49. Do they make those tractors
in this country, or do they import them?. 50. They will not provide pencils at the test, so please bring
your own. 51. Someone has offered Mike the opportunity to study abroad. 52. When I was living in
Kuwait, my neighbour taught me Arabic. 53. Someone awarded Jason a medal for distinguished
service in the military. 54. The real estate office will send you a copy of the sales contract. 55.
Someone handed me a telegram when I opened the door. 56. People gave Mr
147

Finch a gold watch upon his retirement from the company. 57. Someone was making the coffee when I
walked into the kitchen.
58. Translators have translated that book into many languages.
59. Jim's daughter drew that picture. My son drew this picture.
60. The judges will judge the applicants on the basis of their originality. 61. Is Professor Rivers teaching
that course this semester? 62. The mail carrier had already delivered the mail by the time I left for school
this morning. 63. Someone established this school in 1900. 64. The police caught the bank robber. 65. Someone discovered gold in California in 1848.66. There is a party tomorrow night. Someone has invited
you to go to that party. 67. People used candles for light in the seventeenth century. 68. Someone had
already sold the chair by the time you returned to the store. 69. They will tell you the result tomorrow. 70.
We pay for your return ticket. 71. Nobody told me that George was ill. 72. His colleagues gave him a
present when he retired. 73. We will send you your examination results as soon as they are ready. 74.
They didn't ask me my name. 75. They don't pay Jim very much. 76. They didn't offer Ann the job. 77.
Somebody stole my bag in the shop. 78. The police have arrested three men. 79. The bill includes service.
80. They cancelled all flights because of the fog. 81. Somebody accused me of stealing the money. 82.
They are building a new ring-road round the city. 83.1 didn't realise that someone was recording our
conversation. 84. They have changed the date of the meeting. 85. Brian told me that someone had
attacked and robbed him in the street. 86. They promised Robert an interview for the job. 87. They

showed Sarah the photographs. 88. Normally, they pay me salary every month. 89.1 think that they have
sent us the wrong tickets. 90. I hope that someone will give Sally the message. 91. They didn't ask me for
my address. 92.1 thought that someone had told you about the meeting. 93. First we send you a letter
inviting you to an interview. 94. Has anyone answered your question? 95. Somebody found your keys on
top of the photocopier. 96. A scientist discovered penicillin in 1928.97. They didn't look after the children
carefully. 98. He hasn't slept in this bed. 99. They threw him out. 100. Burglars broke into the house. 101.
They took down the notice. 102. People often take him for his brother. 103. This college is already full.
We are turning away students the whole time. 104. The crowd shouted him down. 105. We called in the
police. 106. You are to leave this here. Someone will
148
call for it later on. 107. They sent for the doctor immediately. 108. People always laugh at him. 109. He is
a good specialist. Everybody speaks highly of him. 110. The students always listen attentively to this
lecturer. 111. Everybody insisted on his arrival. 112. We didn't hear of her for some time. 113. Nobody
paid any attention to his behaviour. 114. I hope they will approve of my work. 115. They always read to
her because she has poor sight. 116. The children took great care of the dog. 117. They never refer to this
book. 118. The milkman brings the milk to my door but the postman leaves the letters in the hall. 119.
People steal things from supermarkets every day; someone stole twenty bottles of whisky from this one
last week. 120. Normally men sweep this street every day, but nobody swept it last week. 121. The
postman clears this box three times a day. He last cleared it at 2.30. 122. Women clean this office in the
evening after the staff have left; they clean the upstairs offices between seven and eight in the morning.
123. We never saw him in the dining-room. A maid took all his meals up to him. 124. Someone left this
purse in a classroom yesterday; the cleaner found it. 125. We build well over 1,000 new houses a year.
Last year we built 1,500. 126. We serve hot meals till 10.30, and guests can order coffee and sandwiches
up to 11.30. 127. Passengers leave all sorts of things in buses. The conductors collect them and send them
to the Lost Property Office. 128. An ambulance took the sick man to hospital. 129. The hall porter
polishes the knockers of all the flats every day. Well, he hasn't polished mine for a week. 130. They are
repairing my piano at the moment. 131. They invited Jack but they didn't invite Tom. 132. The guests ate
all the sandwiches and drank all the beer. They left nothing. 133. Has someone posted my parcel? 134.
Why did no one inform me of the change of plan? 135. I'm afraid we have sold all our copies but we have
ordered more. 136. They haven't stamped the letter. 137. They didn't pay me for the work; they expected
me to do it for nothing. 138. She didn't introduce me to her mother. 139. Theythrew away the rubbish.
140. A Japanese firm makes these television sets. 141. An earthquake destroyed the town. 142. We ask
tenants not to play their radios loudly after midnight. 143. They brought the children up in Italy. 144.
They have taken down the For Sale notice, so I suppose they have sold the house. 145. We have warned
you. 146. A lorry knocked him down. 147. They returned
149

the keys to me; someone had picked them up in the street. 148. They have tried other people's schemes.
Why have they never tried my scheme? 149. We use this room only on special occasions. 150. They are
pulling down the old theatre. 151. Why didn't they mend the roof before it fell in? 152. The burglars had
cut a big hole in the steel door. 153. The organizers will exhibit the paintings till the end of the month.
154. Who wrote it? 155. He expected us to offer himajob. 156. They showed her the easiest way to do it.
157.Lightning struck the old oak. 158. The lawyer gave him the details of his uncle's will. 159. Students
are doing a lot of work. 160. They will wear evening dress. 161. People used the house as a hospital
during the war. 162. People are poisoning millions of fish in the North Sea.
163. They suddenly realised that someone was following them.
164. They have recently made redundant a lot of people in our town. 165. Someone had given her the
wrong number. 166. Someone will announce the winners of the competition next week. 167. They usually
mark the papers in July. 168. When we got to the airport, we heard that they had cancelled all the flights.
169. When are they going to finish the new ring road? 170. People must not leave bicycles in the hall.
171. Members may keep the books for three weeks. After that they must return them. 172. You should
open the wine about three hours before you use it. 173. You must not hammer nails into the walls without
permission. 174. No one can do anything unless someone gives us more information. 175. You can't wash
this dress; you must dry-clean it. 176. Passengers shouldn't throw away their tickets as inspectors may
check these during the journey. 177. You must keep dogs on leads in the garden. 178. Visitors must leave
umbrellas in the cloakroom. 179. We can't repair your clock. 180. We have to pick the fruit very early in
the morning; otherwise we can't get it to the market in time. 181. The police shouldn't allow people to
park there. 182. You mustn't move this man; he is too ill. You'll have to leave him here. 183. We had to

give the books back; they did not allow us to take them home. 184. You shouldn't leave these documents
on the desk. You should lock them up. 185. You will have to finish this work by Friday. 186. Good news!
They may offer me a job soon. 187. People cannot control the weather. 188. Someone ought to repair this
broken window. 189. People can pick tomatoes before they are completely ripe. 190. You shouldn't put
bananas in the freezer. 191. Jack has a right to know. You ought to tell him the
150

news immediately. 192. Don't worry. We can repair your watch very easily.
III. Use active or passive, in any appropriate tense, for the verbs in brackets.
1. A valuable painting (steal) from the Central Art Gallery late last night. The thieves (enter) the gallery
through a small upstairs window. 2. Walt Disney (creat) the cartoon character Mickey Mouse. 3. This
problem (discuss) at the last meeting. 4. In 1964 Martin Luther King (win) the Nobel Prize. In 1968 he
(assassinate) in Memphis, Tennessee. 5. The president (arrive) in Rome yesterday afternoon. Later he
(interview) on Italian TV, 6. Teachers (give) a new pay rise by the government. The news 1 (announce)
earlier today. 7. These photos (take) by my sister. 8. The I game (win/probably) by the other team
tomorrow. They're a lot better than we are. 9. There was a terrible accident on a busy downtown street
yesterday. Dozens of people (see) it, including my friend, who (interview) by the police. 10. In my
country, certain prices (control) by the government, such as the prices of medical supplies. However,
other prices (determine) by how much people are willing to pay for a product. 11. Yesterday the wind
(blow) my hat off my head. I had to chase it down the street. I (want, not) to lose it because it's my
favourite hat and it (cost) a lot. 12. Right now Alex is in the hospital. He (treat) for a bad burn on his hand
and arm. 13. Yesterday a purse-snatcher (catch) by a dog. While the thief (chase) by the police, he Gump)
over a fence into someone's yard, where he met a dog. The dog (keep) the thief from escaping. 14. The
first fish (appear) on the earth about 500 million years ago. Up to now, over 20,000 kinds offish (name)
and (describe) by scientists. New species (discover) every year, so the total increases continually. 15. The
morning paper (read) by over 200,000 people every day. 16. Last night my favourite program (interrupt)
by a special news bulletin. 17. That's not my coat. It (belong) to Louise. 18. Our mail (deliver) before
noon every day. 19. The "b" in "comb" (pronounce, not). It is silent. 20. A bad accident (happen) on
Highway 95 last night. 21. When I (arrive) at the airport yesterday, I (meet) by my cousin and a couple of
her friends. 22. Yesterday I (hear) about Margaret's divorce. I (surprise) by the news. Janice (shock). 23. A
new house
151

(build) next to ours next year. 24. Radium (discover) by Marie and Pierre Curie in 1898. 25. When
(your bike, steal)? Two days ago. 26. A: (you, pay) your electric bill yet? B: No, I haven't, but I'd
better pay it today. If I don't, my electricity (shut off) by the power company. 27. A: Did you hear
about the accident? B: No. What (happen)? 28. The Eiffel Tower (be) in Paris, France. It (visit) by
millions of people every year. It (design) by Alexander Eiffel (1832-1923). It (erect) in 1889 for the
Paris exposition. Since that time, it (be) the most famous landmark in Paris. Today it (recognize) by
people throughout the world. 29.1 don't have my car today. It's in the garage. It (repair) right now. 30.
Kate didn't have her car last week because it was in the garage. While it (repair), she took the bus to
work. 31. I'm sorry, but the computer job is no longer available. A new computer programmer (hire,
already). 32. What products (manufacture) in your country? 33. The examination papers are scored
by machine. The students (tell) their results next week. 34. The organizers (exhibit) the paintings till
the end of the month. 35. The teacher (assist) by two graduate students during the exam yesterday.
36. A: Where (buy, you) that beautiful necklace? B: I (buy, not) it. It (give) to me for my birthday,
(like, you) it? 37. Soon after I (apply) for a job with the United Nations two years ago, I (hire). 38.
Yesterday we went to look for an apartment. I really liked it, but by the time we got there, it (rent,
already). 39. There's going to be a story in the local newspaper about my neighbour, Mrs Morris.
Tomorrow she (interview) by one of the local reporters about her doll collection. Over the years, she
(collect) more than 400 dolls all over the world. 40. Ali and Mustafa (complain) to the landlord many
times since they moved into their present apartment, but to date nothing (do) about the leak in the
roof and the broken window in the bedroom. 41. The darks' living room (redecorate) in blue and
white. They want it to look nice for their daughter's wedding reception. 42. The old clock wasn't
ticking because it (wind, not). Someone forgot to do it. 43. The news of the victory (broadcast)
throughout the country over the radio and television. Everyone (hear) about it almost as soon as it
(happen). 44. Only coffee and dessert (serve) at the reception yesterday. 45. Kim wants very badly to
make the Olympic team next year. She (train) hard for the last two years. 46. Mark is a genius. By the

time he (graduate), he (offer) jobs by a dozen computer companies. 47. When


152

I (finish) my work, I'm going to take a walk. 48. After the test papers (return) to the students in class
tomorrow, the students (give) their next assignment. 49. The Olympic Games (begin) in 776 B.C. in
Olympia, a small town in Greece. At that time, only Greeks (allow) to compete in them. 50. "Miss
Jones, please type those letters before noon." "They (already, type). They're on your desk." 51. "Can't
we do something about the situation?" "Something (do) right now." 52. "Has the committee made its
decision yet?" "Not yet. They (still, consider) the proposal." 53. Something funny (happen) in class
yesterday. 54.1 (agree) with you on that subject. 55. Let's go ahead and do it now. Nothing
(accomplish) by waiting. 56. "When can I have my car back?" "I think it (finish) late this afternoon."
IV. Supply the stative passive of the given verbs. Use the Simple Present or the Simple Past.
1. It is hot in this room because the window (close). 2. Yesterday it was hot in this room because the
window (close). 3. Sarah is wearing a blouse. It (make) of cotton. 4. The door to this room (shut).
5.We can leave now because class (finish). 6. The lights in this room (turn on). 7. This room (crowd,
not). 8. We can't go any farther. The car (stick) in the mud. 9. We couldn't go any farther. The car
(stick) in the mud. 10. My room is very neat right now. The bed (make), the floor (sweep), and the
dishes (wash). 11. We are ready to sit down and eat dinner. The table (set), the meat and rice (do),
and the candles (light). 12. Where's my wallet? It (go)! Did you take it? 13. Hmmm. My dress (tear).
I wonder how that happened. 14. Don't look in the hall closet. Your birthday present (hide) there. 15.
Excuse me, sir. Could you give me some directions? I (lose). 16. That's hard work, I (exhaust). I need
to rest for a while. 17. The children (excite) about going to the circus. They're looking forward to
seeing the elephants, the clowns, and the acrobats. 18. George (dress) in his best suit today because
he has an important interview this afternoon. 19. Lousie is probably sleeping. The lights in her room
(turn off). 20. Carolyn and Joe were married to each other for five years, but now they (divorce). 21.
You told me one thfhg and John told me another. I don't know what to think. I (confuse). 22.1 love
my wife. I (marry) to a wonderful woman. 23. I thought I
153

had left my book on this desk, but it isn't here. It (go). I wonder where it is. 24. We can't eat this fruit. It
(spoil). We'll have to throw it away. 25. Vietnam (locate) in Southeast Asia. 26. A: "The TV set doesn't
work." B: "Are you sure? (it/plug in)?" 27.1 (accustom) to living here. 28.1 (satisfy) with the progress I
have made. 29. I (not acquaint) with that man. Do you know him? 30. Mark Twain (know) for his stories
about life on the Mississippi. 31. My car (equip) with air conditioning and a sun roof.
V. Translate from Russian into English.
1. . . 2. .
. 3. .
, . 4. . 5.
. . 6. , :
. 7. ?
. . 8.
. . 9. ? . 10.
. 11. , .
12. . 13. . 14.
. 15. ? 16.
? 17. ,
. 18. ,
. 19. . 20. . 21.
? 10 . 22.
. 23. ,
. 24. , . 25.
, ? 26. , ,
. 27. ? . 28.
? 29.
154

. 30. . . 31. 32.


. 33. . 34.
, , . 35.

. 36. ,
.

Fluency
Listen, read and practise.

I Need Some Information


A: Hello?
B: Oh, hello. I need some information. What currency is used
in Japan? A: Where? B: In Japan.
A: I'm not sure. Isn't it the yen? B: Oh, yes. And do they drive on the left or the right? A: I think the
left, but I'm not sure. B: Oh. Well, is English spoken much there? A: I really have no idea. B: Uh?
Well, what about credit cards? Are American Express
cards used there? A: How would I know? B: Well, you're a travel agent, aren't you? A: What? A
travel agent? This is Linda's Hair Saloon. B: Oh, sorry, wrong number.
A. Study and practise the conversation.
B. Complete these sentences using the passive and suitable verbs below.
eat grow make up manufacture speak teach wear
1. Both cars and computers... in Korea. 2. English... in many schools in Russia. 3. A great deal of cotton...
in Egypt. 4. Frogs
155

and snails... in France. 5. Canada... of ten provinces and two territories. 6. Kimonos... sometimes... in
Japan. 7. French... not widely...in Great Britain.
Now use the verbs above and write sentences like these about your country. Use the passive. Then
compare with a partner.
Recycling
Nick: Jenny, listen to this. Over 8 million tons of paper are used in Britain every year, but only some of it
is recycled. One ton of rubbish is thrown away every year by the average British family of four like
us!
Jenny: I know. Only a little waste glass is recycled. Plastic isn't recycled at all. And last year over 7
billion drink cans were thrown away.
A. Use the present passive of the verb in brackets.
1. 70 billion cups of tea (drink) in Britain every year. 2. A billion litres of fruit juice (buy) by the British
every year. 3.20 million litres of milk (drink) every day. 4. 9 million chickens and turkeys (kill) every
week. 5. Not everybody eats meat. Meat (not eat) by three per cent of British people. 6. 3,500 litres of
water (use) by the average British family every week. 7. In Britain over 15 million newspapers (read)
every day. 8. Over 30 million television sets (own) by British families. 9. Every day enough rubbish
(produce) to fill Trafalgar Square up to the top of Nelson's Column!
B. Nick is doing a project on rainforests. He has made notes. Put his notes into sentences like this'
eg rainforests find along the equator Rainforests are found along the equator.
1. thousands of square kilometres of rainforest destroy every year 2. 6,000 trees cut down
every hour 3. wood sell to many countries 4. wood make into furniture 5. rainforests burn
downby farmers 6. animalskillby the fires 7. houses destroy by the fires 8. many kinds of
animals and plants lose when the rainforests disappear 9. some medicines make from
rainforest plants 10. weather change by the destruction of the rainforests
156
Isn't This Country Incredible!
Victor: What a nice camera!
Roberto: Thanks. It's Japanese.
Victor: Isn't this country incredible? It seems like everything
is imported.
Roberto: Yeah, TVs, stereos, and cameras are often made in Japan. You can get running shoes from
Korea. Clothes are made in Hong Kong and Taiwan. Watches are imported from France and Switzerland.
Victor: Even fruit and vegetables are imported from Mexico
and Chile during the winter.
Roberto: Yes. And a lot of cars are imported, too. I think Americans are fascinated by foreign products.
Victor: Well, sometimes they're designed better. And sometimes they're a lot cheaper, too.
Roberto: Say, have you got the time? I want to take some pictures before class tonight. Victor: It's 3:00.

Roberto: Oh, I'd better go. It's getting late. Victor: Yeah. I'd better go, too. I haven't done my homework
yet.
A. Correct the statements that are wrong. Say "That's right" or "That's wrong."
1. Americans often buy foreign cameras, TVs, stereos, and cars.
2. Koreans sometimes buy American running shoes.
3. American clothes sometimes come from Hong Kong and Taiwan.
4. Americans never import watches from Europe.
5. Americans import onions and potatoes from Mexico.
6. Other countries often make cheaper cars, stereos, and clothes than the United States.
1'. Roberto thinks he should go so he'll have enough time to
take some pictures before class.
8. Victor thinks he should go so he can take a shower before , class.
157
Finding a Job
If you have left school and haven't got a job, don't despair. Jobs are advertised in the local papers
under "Situations Vacant". Go to your local Job Centre or Employment Office. If they haven't got a
suitable job for you, at least good advice is given there. Also, remember to read notices. Job
vacancies are posted up on notice boards outside firms and factories. Local jobs are displayed on
cards in shop windows and at post offices. When you have found a job that interests you, make an
appointment for an interview. Sometimes, an interview is arranged by telephone, but often a written
application is required. Application forms are provided for this purpose by the firms. Sometimes, the
applicant is tested at the interview. Don't be nervous, do your best.
Don't feel that you have to take the first job that is offered to you. Go to the Careers Office and ask
about the Youth Training Scheme. Many on-the-job courses and schemes are organized by the Youth
Training Scheme and they pay you during the training.
A. How can you find a job in your country?
They where surprised
Jewellery and coins were stolen last night from the home of Mr and Mrs G. Sinclair of Clark Street,
Bristol. At about 1.30 a.m., a young man was seen in the Sinclairs' garden by a neighbour. The police
were informed immediately by the neighbour's wife. Ten minutes later, the man was caught as he was
leaving the garden and was taken to the police station for questioning. His pockets were searched.
Rings and gold coins worth over 3000 were found. When the man was questioned about the theft,
he said, "It was easy. A window was open and the safe wasn't locked."
The jewellery and coins were returned to the Sinclairs the next morning. A policeman said, "They
were surprised. They hadn't noticed the theft."
A. Do you know a story about a theft?
'Where was this Taken?
Olga: You know, we've never seen the pictures you took of New York.
Roberto: No? Didn't I show them to you after I got back?
Victor: No.
Roberto: Well, I have them with me.... This is the Empire State Building. It's probably the most
famous building in New York. It was built in less than two years. It was begun in 1929 and finished
in 1931.
Susan: Isn't that incredible?
Roberto: This is the United Nations.
Olga: It was built sometime after World War I ended, wasn't it?
Victor: After World War II.
Olga: I mean World War II. Where was this taken?
Roberto: From the top of the World Trade Center. Did you know the Statue of Liberty was designed
by a Frenchman?
Victor: Uh-huh. Bartholdi. It was given to the United States by France on the 100th birthday of U.S.
independence.
Susan: You know a lot about history.
Victor: History was my favourite subject in school after music, that is!
I
Note: center . = centre

A. Correct these statements.


1. Roberto hasn't been to New York. 2. The Empire State Building isn't very famous. 3. The Empire
State Building was built in less than a year. 4. The UN was built after World War I. 5. The Statue of
Liberty was given to the United States by England.
B. Bring to class a picture of your favourite building, painting, or sculpture or a copy of your favourite
book. Work with a group. Your classmates will ask you questions about your picture or book.
What's this called? Where was it done?
158

When was it done? Who was it done by?


159

Youth Hit by Van


At 5.05 p.m. on Saturday 19 July, there was an accident at the junction of Euston Road and St. Pancras
Road when a boy of 16 was knocked off his bicycle by a delivery van. Luckily, he was not seriously
injured. Patrick Kay, the 1 6-year-old boy, was taken to St. Pancras Hospital where he was treated for
shock and a broken arm. The accident was witnessed by several people, and it was reported minutes later
by the driver of the van, Mr Ralph Ripley, 45, of Wimbledon. Both the youth and the driver of the van
were questioned afterwards by the police, who took the names and addresses of three witnesses.
A. Have you ever witnessed an accident? What was it like?
An interview
Joe Burns is a famous racing-driver. He is being interviewed on a sports programme.
Reporter: You've had a very dangerous life, haven't you, Joe? I mean, you've almost been killed several
times, haven't you?
Joe:
Yes. I suppose that's right.
Reporter: When was your worst accident?
Joe:
d say last year. It was during the British Grand Prix.
I smashed into a wall. The car was completely ruined and my left leg was broken. Luckily, nobody was
killed.
Reporter: Is that the only time you've been... er...close to death?
Joe: No. Once, during the Mexican Grand Prix, two cars in front of me had a bad accident. One of them
ran into the other. I swerved to avoid them and hit a fence My car was badly damaged but luckily I wasn't
even hurt.
Reporter: You must enjoy danger. I mean, you wouldn't be a racing-driver if you didn't, would you?
Joe:
I don't know about that. I had a very frightening experience quite recently. I was frightened to death! I thought I was going to be killed at any moment.
160
Reporter: Really? When was that? During your last race? Joe:
No. It was on my way to this studio. I
had to drive
through London during the lunch hour. A. Questions
1. What has almost happened to Joe several times? 2. When was his worst accident? Describe it 3. What
happened during the Mexican Grand Prix? 4. What did Joe think was going to happen to him very
recently? 5. When did his last experience take place?
B. Discuss your personal experiences using the present perfect passive and the past simple passive of the
verbs in the phrases below.
eg A: Have you ever been stopped by the police? B: No, I haven't but my brother has. A: Really? Why? B:
He was stopped for speeding on the motorway.
1. stop by the police 2. interview on television 3. give a surprise party 4. fine for parking 5. search by
customs 6. ask to give a speech 7. involve in a road accident
Let Me Quiz You
A: Have you studied for the test tomorrow?
B: Yes, I have.
A: OK. Let me quiz you on the Panama Canal.
B: All right. Go ahead.
A: Who was the canal built by?
B: It was started by the French and completed by the Americans.
A: Right! And when was it completed?
B: It was completed in 1911.
A: No! It was completed in 1914.

B: Oh, that's right.


A. Complete the phrases in column A with suitable information in column B.

a) The novel 1984


b) The pyramids

...was designed by Bartholdi. ...was written by George Orwell.


161

c) The Statue of Liberty


. . . were built by the ancient Egyptians.
d) The mural in the Sistine ... was written by Margaret Mit-Chapel in Vatican City
chel.
e) The novel Gone With
... was painted by Michelangelo.
the Wind
B. Now change these active sentences into passive sentences with by.
a) Leonardo da Vinci painted the Mono Lisa.
b) Marie Curie discovered radium.
c) Mildred and Patty Hill wrote the song "Happy Birthday to You."
d) Mark Twain wrote the American novel Huckleberry Finn.
e) Thomas Edison invented the phonograph and the light bulb.
C. Think of six questions about famous buildings, paintings, boob, or musical compositions.
eg Who was Starry Night painted by? Who was War and Peace written by? Who was Carmen
composed by?
Take turns asking your questions. Who got the most correct answers?
A very exciting
In January Martha was hired by the Fernwood Company as a secretary. In March she was sent to
school by the company to study statistics and accounting. In April she was given her first raise. Just
two months later, she was promoted to the position of supervisor of her department. In August she
was chosen "Employee of the Month." In October she was given another raise. In November she was
invited to apply for a position in the company's overseas office in England. And in December she was
given the new job and was flown to London to begin work.
Martha certainly has had a very exciting year. She can't believe all the wonderful things that have
happened to her since she was hired just twelve months ago.
A. Ask and answer questions on the text.
B. Speak about your career history.
162

Can I help y?
Mrs Jones: Is this Joe's Auto Repair Shop?
Man:
Yes, it is. Can I help you?
Mrs Jones: Yes, please. This is Mrs Jones. I'm calling about
my car. Has it been repaired yet? Man:
Not yet. It's being repaired right now.
Mrs Jones: I see. Tell me, when can I pick it up? Man:
Come by at four o'clock. I'm sure it'll
be ready by
then.
A. Respond to the following.
eg Has the lamp been fixed? No, it is still being fixed.
1. Have the floors been painted? 2. Have the things been packed? 3. Has the table been laid? 4. Have
the dogs been fed? 5. Has the letter been typed? Has the radio-set been repaired? 7. Has the furniture
been removed?
Make up your own sentences using this model.

A burglary
Tom: The newsagent's has been broken into. About 850 has been taken.
Nick: Has the thief been found?
Tom: No, not yet. The theft was only discovered an hour ago. There's a room at the back of the shop
where the money is kept in a safe. This morning the cleaner noticed that the window had been
broken, so she told the owner. A few people have been questioned by the police, but nobody knows
much. An officer said that any information will be welcomed.

Nick: Will there be a reward?


A. Make up short dialogues using the words prompted. Prompt: dust/the furniture
Has the furniture been dusted yet?
Not yet.
163
1. hang up/the picture 2. cut/the grass 3. fix/the brakes 4. mend/ the shoes 5. type/the documents 6.
photo-copy/the letters 7. find/ the book 8. clean/the room 9. iron/the suit
B. When the pupils went back to school after the summer holidays, a lot of things had been changed.
eg New desks (buy).
New desks had been bought.
1. A lot of trees (plant). 2. New lights (put in). 3. The classrooms (paint). 4. A tennis court (build). 5.
The fence (take down). 6. Five new classrooms (add). 7. New equipment (buy) for the chemistry lab.
8. Showers (install) in the changing rooms. 9. New blackboards (put up) in the classrooms. 10. The
whole school (modernize).
She Only Wanted a Haircut
Alan: Have you always been interested in photography?
Carla: Oh, yes! I was given a camera for my eighth birthday.
Alan: So you became a photographer immediately after school, I imagine.
Carla: Oh, no. I did lots of different things.
Alan: What kind of things?
Carla: Well, I went to college and studied design. Oh, and once I was given a job at a hairdresser's.
Alan: How long did you do that for?
Carla:Not long. I was sacked after three weeks.
Alan: Sacked? Why?
Carla:! dyed a lady's hair green.
Alan: What was wrong with that?
Carla: She only wanted a haircut.
A. Study and practise the conversation.
Qoing by fube
Laura usually leaves the office at about five o'clock, but last Monday she left at half past five. She
wanted to get home by 6.30 and she ran to the bus stop but she couldn't get on a bus. There
164
were too many people and not enough buses. Laura was desperate to get home so she decided to go
by tube.
In the station she went to one of the automatic ticket machines but she didn't have enough change, so
she had to join the queue at the ticket window. She bought her ticket and ran to the escalator. Laura
went to the platform and waited for the tube. It arrived and the crowd moved forward. Laura was
pushed into the train. It was almost full but she was given a seat by a man with a moustache. Laura
thanked him and sat down. She started to read her newspaper. In the tunnel the train stopped
suddenly and Laura was thrown to the floor together with the man with the moustache. Somebody
screamed. The lights went out. It was quarter past six on a cold wet December evening.
A. Ask and answer questions on the text. Retell the text.
Fishermen Found Safe and Sound
Three Taiwanese fishermen were rescued yesterday from a small uninhabited island in the South
Pacific. The men had been lost for more than three months.
They had left Taiwan in a small fishing boat and planned to be gone for only a week. But on the fifth
day they ran into a typhoon, and it badly damaged their boat. Fortunately, none of the men was hurt.
After the storm passed, however, they found that the engine wouldn't start. So their boat just drifted
at sea for a month. During this time, the fishermen caught fish to eat and drank rainwater to stay
alive.
Finally, the boat drifted toward a small island. When it got close enough, the men jumped overboard
and swam to the shore. On the island, they found fresh fruit and vegetables to eat, and they continued
to live off any fish they could catch.
The fishermen lived on the island for another two months before they were rescued by a passing ship.

Although the three men had lost a lot of weight, they were still in fairly good health after their long
ordeal. Their families were very happy to hear that the men had been found "safe and sound" and that
they would soon be home.
A. Ask and answer questions on the text. Retell the text.
165

An Earthquake
An earthquake was reported in San Francisco at 7:18 this evening. Most of the damage was felt in the
downtown area. Electric lines were cut but telephone service was not interrupted in most areas. It
appears that no damage was done to the new earthquake-proof buildings, but, unfortunately, windows
were shattered in some of the older buildings and the famous old clock in Union Square was
destroyed. The clock, which is 100 years old, was popular with tourists. No injuries were reported so
the Red Cross was not called to help. Also, no damage was reported in the suburbs.
A. Choose the correct answer.
1. The earthquake was reported
a. at night.
b. during the day.
2. Electric lines
a. were cut.
b. weren't cut.
3. Telephone service in most areas
a. was interrupted.
b. wasn't interrupted.
4. Windows were shattered in some of the
a. old buildings.
b. new buildings.
5. The old clock
a. was almost destroyed.
b. was destroyed.
6. How many injuries were reported?
a. No injuries were reported.
b, A lot of injuries were reported.
B. Put the verbs in brackets into the past simple passive. Retell the text.
Did you know that the greatest explosion in the world (cause) by a volcano? Krakatoa, an island in
Indonesia, erupted in 1883. More than half the island (destroy). The explosion (hear) in India and
Australia. Rocks (throw) more than 55 kilometres high into the air. Surprisingly, only a few people
(kill), but a huge wave, 35 metres high, (create) by the explosion. Several small islands
166
(cover) by the wave. 163 villages (destroy) and 36,000 people (drown). Dust (carry) all round the
world, and the weather everywhere (affect) for many years afterwards.
Computers:
Now and in the Future
A computer is an electronic device. It makes calculations and processes information. Complicated
problems can be solved very quickly. Millions of pieces of information can be processed in seconds.
Nowadys, computers are used for many different purposes. Businesses use their computers not only
to bill their customers, but also to send information to customers and to communicate with other
businesses. In industry, many complicated machines are controlled by computers. Machines that
produce chemicals, steel, and hundreds of other products are connected to computers. In
transportation, airplanes, ships, and even spacecraft are guided by computers. In science, complicated
problems and scientific data are almost always analyzed by computers. Even earthquakes and
hurricanes can be predicted by computers. In education, computers are used as teaching machines. In
the home, people are buying computers to help them manage their households more efficiently.
People can shop, make travel arrangements, and pay their bills using computers right in their own
homes.
In the future, computers will be even more widely used in our offices, our homes, and our cars.
Developments are being made every day that allow computers to solve more and more complex

problems. It has been said by many experts that someday computers will be able to "think" creatively
like human beings. For example, someday computers may be able to understand human language and
to respond to it. In the near future, sophisticated forms of art and music may also be created by
computers. Indeed, some forms of "computer art" and "computer music" have already been
produced.
Note: someday = some day (-, )
A. ASK and answer questions on the text.
B. Speak about the use of computers.
167

Dr Lin, the author of "Computers: Now and in the Future", is talking to his wife.
Dr Lin: I have such a busy day today I don't know when I'll be home.
Mrs Lin: Oh, that's right. You have to speak at the High School of Science and Technology today.
Dr Lin: That will be finished by three o'clock. But then I have to go to the office and prepare my
notes for my speech at the Computer Society's annual dinner tonight.
Mrs Lin: Well, at least your magazine article has already been written and submitted to your editor. It
was due today, wasn't it?
Dr Lin: Yes, at least that's done. In fact, it should be published sometime next month.
Mrs Lin: Do you think you will be given time to eat tonight or will you have to spend the entire
evening answering questions?
Dr Lin: I might be asked to speak as soon as everyone sits down for dinner. In that case, I guess I'll
be pretty hungry when I get home.
Mrs Lin: Do you have any idea what time you'll be finished?
Dr Lin: None.
Mrs Lin: Well, I'll have something ready for you to eat when you get here. What about
transportation?
Dr Lin: That's already been taken care of. The Computer Society is sending a car for me. It's picking
me up at the office at six and will bring me home after the meeting.
Note: sometime = some time (-)
A. Ask and answer questions on the text.
B. Give a brief account of the conversation.
C. Roleplay the conversation.
168

UNIT 10 TOPIC: CITY. SIGHTSEEING


Listen, read and practise.
A glimpse of London
London is the capital of Great Britain. It is situated on both sides of the Thames and stretches for
nearly 30 miles from east to west and for nearly 30 miles from north to south. London is one of the
largest cities in the world. Its population is more than eight million.
London is a very old city. It is more than 20 centuries old. The history of London goes back to
Roman times. Traditionally London is divided into several parts: the City, Westminster, the West End
and the East End. They are very different from each other.
The heart of London is the City its commercial and business centre. The Stock Exchange, the
Royal Exchange, and the Bank of England are all there. The centre of the country's judicial system
the Old Bailey is also in the City. Few people live in the City, but over a million come to work
here.
Two famous historic buildings are located in the City the Tower of London and St Paul's
Cathedral. The Tower of London was built in the 11 -th century. It was used as a fortress, a royal
residence and a prison. Now it is a museum of armour and also the place where Crown Jewels are
kept.
A twenty minutes' walk from the Tower will take you to another historic building St Paul's
Cathedral. It was built in the 17th century by the famous architect Sir Christopher Wren. Wellington,
Nelson and other great men of England are buried in the Cathedral.
Westminster is the centre of government and justice. Here we can see the Houses of Parliament with
the famous clock "Big Ben" on one of the towers. All government offices are in Whitehall. The
official residence of the Queen is Buckingham Palace. The residence of the Prime Minister is at 10

Downing Street.
Opposite the Houses of Parliament stands Westminster Abbey. From Norman times British monarchs
have been crowned here and since the 13th century they have been buried here. Many
169
other famous people are also buried in Westminster Abbey including statesmen, musicians and
writers.
The West End is the name given to the area of Central London north from The Mall to Oxford Street.
It includes Trafalgar Square, the main shopping areas of Oxford Street, Regent Street and Bond
Street, and the entertainment centres of Soho, Piccadilly Circus, Leicester Square and Shaftesbury
Avenue. Its name is associated with glamour and bright lights.
Trafalgar Square was built early in the last century to commemorate the Battle of Trafalgar. Admiral
lord Nelson's statue stands on top of a column in the middle of Trafalgar Square. The square makes a
good place for people to meet coaches pick up parties of visitors, marchers unite for protest
meetings, and at Christmas time carol singers gather round a huge Christmas tree which is sent to
Britain from Norway every year. Behind Nelson's Column is the National Gallery, an art gallery in
which you can find many old masters. Not far from the National Gallery is the British Museum. It
contains a priceless collection of different things (ancient manuscripts, coins, sculptures, etc.) The
British Museum is famous for its library one of the richest in the world.
Most of London's big department stores are in Oxford Street and Regent Street. Piccadilly Circus is
the centre of nightlife in the West End. To the north of Piccadilly Circus is Soho, which has been the
foreign quarter of London since the 17th century. Now it has restaurants offering food from a variety
of different countries, as well as "adult" entertainment.
London is famous for its live theatre, and there are over thirty theatres within a square mile.
Naturally there is a great variety of shows to choose from: opera, musicals, drama and so on. If you
want to know what is on in London, the best place to look is in a newspaper.
The East End is an industrial district of London. It is especially famous as the centre of the clothing
industry. The Port of London is also in the East End.
A. Questions
1. What is the population of London? 2. What is the City?
3. When was the Tower of London built? What was it used for?
4. When was St Paul's Cathedral built? 5. What famous men are
170

buried in the Cathedral? 6. In what district of London are most of the Government buildings located?
7. What is Big Ben? 8. What famous building stands opposite the Houses of Parliament? 9. In whose
memory was the monument in the middle of Trafalgar Square set up? 10. What kind of museum is
the British Museum?
11. Where are most of London's big department stores located?
12. In what part of London is the Port located?
B. Speak about London, the capital of Great Britain.
C. Have you ever been to London? What did you do? Did you like the city?
'Washington
Washington, D.C. (District of Columbia) is the capital of the United States. It became the capital on
December I, 1880. It was named after George Washington, the first president, and Christopher
Columbus (America was discovered by Columbus in 1492).
Spring is the best season in Washington, and it is the most popular with tourists. In the spring you can
see the flowers on hundreds of cherry trees. The trees were given to the United States in 1912. They
were a gift of friendship from Japan.
Washington has something for everyone historic monuments, interesting museums, beautiful
parks, and excellent hotels and restaurants. Some of the most important and most interesting sights
are:
The Jefferson Memorial. This monument is dedicated to the third president, Thomas Jefferson. It
was designed by John Russel, and it was dedicated in 1943. Inside there is a statue of Jefferson by
sculptor Rudolf Evans.
The Lincoln Memorial. This beautiful monument is dedicated to Abraham Lincoln, the sixteenth
president of the United States. It is made of marble, and it was built in 1922. In the great hall I there

is a huge statue by Daniel Chester French.


The National Gallery of Art. The National Gallery contains '. one of the world's best collections of
European and American > painting and sculpture. The newest building, the East Building, ', is made
of pink marble and glass. It was designed by I.M. Pei, and it was opened in 1978.
171

The Washington Monument. The Washington Monument was completed in 1884. It is dedicated to
the first president, George Washington, and it is 555 feet high. You can take an elevator to the top or
you can climb the 898 steps!
The White House. The White House is the official home of the president. It was designed by James
Hoban. The first building was burned by the British in the War of 1 8 1 2, but it was rebuilt in 1818.
It was also first painted white at that time.
A. Questions
1. Who was Washington, D.C. named after? 2 Where did the cherry trees come from? 3. How tall is
the Washington Monument? 4. When was the White House painted white? 5. Who is the Jefferson
Memorial dedicated to? 6. Who designed it? 7. What is the Lincoln Memorial made of? 8. Who
designed the statue of Lincoln? 9. What does the National Gallery of Art contain? 1 0. What is the
East Building made of?
B. Speak about the most interesting sights in Washington.
C. Have you ever been to Washington? What do you think of it? Answer your friends' questions
about the city.
New Yourk
Everyone knows something about New York the Statue of Liberty, the skyscrapers, the beautiful
shops on Fifth Avenue and the many theatres on Broadway. This is America's cultural capital, and her
biggest city, with a population of nearly eight million. In the summer it is hot, hot, and in the winter it
can be very cold, but there are hundreds of things to do and see all the year round.
There are five "boroughs" in New York: Brooklyn, the Bronx, Manhattan, Queens and Richmond.
Only one of them, the Bronks, is not an island.
Manhattan, the smallest island in New York, is the real centre of the city. When people say "New
York City" they usually mean Manhattan. Most of the interesting shops, buildings and museums are
here, and Manhattan is the scene of New York's night life.
In 1605 the first Europeans came to Manhattan from Holland. They bought the island from the
Native Americans for a few glass necklaces, worth about $26 today.
172

Only 1,500,000 people live in Manhattan, but five million people work here every day. Many live in
the suburbs and come to work on the subway.
Wall Street in Manhattan is the financial heart of the USA and the most important banking centre in
the world. It is a street of "skyscrapers", those incredible, high buildings which Americans invented,
and built faster and higher than anyone else. Perhaps the two most spectacular skyscrapers in New
York are the two towers of the New York World Trade Center. When the sun sets, their 110 floors
shine like pure gold.
Like every big city, New York has its own traffic system. Traffic jams can be terrible, and it's usually
quickest to go by subway. The New York subway is easy to use and quite cheap. Take a look at the
map. The subway goes to almost every corner of Manhattan. But be careful. It's better not to go by
subway late at night.
You see more, of course, if you go by bus. New York buses are also easy to use. The "Shoppers'
Shuttle" (Monday to Friday) and the "Culture Loops" (Saturdays and Sundays) stop at some of the
best known stores and tourist places. You can get on and off as many times as you like in one day
with only one ticket.
There are more than 30,000 taxis in New York. They are easy to see, because they are bright yellow
and carry large TAXI signs. Taxis do not go outside the city but they will go to the airports. People
give the taxi driver a "tip" of 15 % extra.
If you really have to drive in New York, remember that nearly all the east-west streets and most of
the north-south streets are one way only. This can be difficult for the visitor who does not know his
way. Try to get a map that shows the direction of the traffic, and good luck!
A. Questions

1. What do many people know about New York? 2. What is the population of New York? 3. What is
the weather like? 4. What are the five "boroughs" in New York? 5. Which of them is not an island? 6.
What is the real centre of the city? 7. Who was the first to come to Manhattan? When? 8. How many
people live in Manhattan? 9. How many people work there? 10. What street is the financial heart of
the USA? 11. What are the two most spectacular skyscrapers in New York? 12. What is the New
York traffic system like? 13. What colour are the taxis in New York?
173

B. Speak about New York.


C. Has anyone in your group visited New York? Answer your friends' questions about New York.
Madrid
Madrid is the capital of Spain, and is located right in the centre of the country. It's also the largest city
in Spain, with over three million residents.
Madrid is a centre for government and finance, and is an important manufacturing centre for the
automotive and aircraft industries. In addition, it's one of the major publishing centres for the
Spanish-speaking world.
The people of Madrid are called Madrilenos. Many Madrilenos work from 10 a.m. to 2 p.m. Then, at
two o'clock, many stores and offices close. The custom started so that people could take an afternoon
nap or siesta. Those who take a siesta go back to work again from five to eight o'clock. However,
recently, many businesses have stopped closing for siesta; instead, they follow the semanta inglesa,
or English week, and stay open from nine to five o'clock. Nevertheless, many people still work late,
until eight in the evening. Like many people throughout Spain, Madrilenos eat dinner late, usually
between 10p.m. and midnight, and theatres and cinemas begin performances late. The local style is to
keep late hours, especially in the summer. During the hot months of July and August, the temperature
is often over a hundred degrees Fahrenheit, or thirty-eight degrees Celsius. But Madrilenos have a
variety of ways to stay cool. For example, they stroll up and down the streets or sit and talk at
outdoor cafes; they can also go to discos that have an outdoor swimming pool.
Madrid has many attractions. Soccer is the most popular sport in Madrid, and the city has two major
soccer teams. In addition, the largest bullring in Spain is located in Madrid. It's called Las Ventas,
and it's the place where all novice bullfighters get their start. And, of course, there are world-famous
art museums, such as the Prado Museum, which is the home of masterworks by artists such as El
Greco and Goya.
A. Do you remember what the speaker says on each of these topics?
174
population
industry
life-style
weather
entertainment
B. Speak about Madrid, the capital of Spain.
C. Choose an interesting city or place to give a talk on. Speak about the cost of living, employment,
housing, industry, location, population, size, weather, etc. Be ready to answer any questions about the
place you are talking about.
Mr Brown in Edinburgh
Mr Brown was in Edinburgh on business for his bank. He had caught a train from King's Cross
Station in London at ten o'clock that morning and now he had arrived in Edinburgh. It was five
o'clock in the evening. He had enjoyed a comfortable journey and had had a good lunch on the train.
He had booked a room at the Queen's Hotel a few days before, so when he got out of the train at
Waverley Station, he took a taxi straight to the hotel.
When he got to the hotel he signed the book, the clerk told him the number of his room and the porter
gave him his key. He went up to the third floor in the lift and the lift-boy showed him to his room. It
was a comfortable room with a good bed. That night Mr Brown slept well until the maid brought him
some tea at seven-thirty next morning.
Mr Brown had not been in Edinburgh for many years, and he was looking forward to seeing the city
again. So when he had finished breakfast he decided to go for a walk before keeping his first
appointment at 11 o'clock. He came out from his hotel into Princess Street, one of the widest and

most beautiful streets in the world. It has fine shops on one side and gardens on the other, with
Edinburgh Castle high on its Rock and Arthur's Seat beyond. The Scots are very proud of their
capital city. As Mr Brown walked along, he remembered some of the exciting events that had
happened here and some of the great men who had walked along these same streets the things
they had done, and the books they had written. He was surprised when he looked at his watch and
saw that it was almost eleven.
His first appointment was with an old friend John Macdonald, the manager of the Edinburgh branch
of his bank. Mr Macdonald
175
spent some time showing him round the city. During the three days he was there, Mr Brown saw
most of the places of interest. He visited St Giles' Cathedral and the royal palace which is called
Holyroodhouse; he walked along the narrow streets of Old Edinburgh and up to the grey castle. He
found, too, that Edinburgh does not live only in the past. New Edinburgh has modem houses and
wide streets. His friend told him that every year in September a Music and Drama Festival is held, to
which people come from all over the world; new plays can be seen and new music can be heard, and
visitors can meet people from other countries and talk about the things that interest them.
When at the end of his visit, he sat in the train which was carrying him south to London he made up
his mind that he must come back soon to spend a holiday in this city in which the past comes so close
to the present.
A. Ask and answer questions on the text.
B. Take turns asking each other about an interesting city or place you have visited. Use these questions or
other questions of your own.
What's an interesting city or place you have visited? How big is it? What's the weather like there? Is
there much unemployment? And what about industry? What's the transportation like? Is there any
pollution there? What's the cost of living like? What kind of housing do people have? Are rents
expensive? What can you do there? Are there many tourist attractions? What's good to buy there?
What's the nightlife like? What else do you like about it?
C. Write about your trip to an interesting city or place.
Small Towns and big Cities
Today, people all over the world are moving out of small towns in the country to go and live in big,
noisy cities. They are moving from the peaceful hills, mountains, fields, rivers and streams of the
countryside to the busy world of streets, buildings, traffic and crowds. This movement from rural
areas to urban areas has been going on for over two hundred years.
In many countries, the main reason people come to live in towns and cities is work. After one or two
large factories or
176

businesses have been built in or near a city, people come to find work, and soon an industrial area
begins to grow. There is usually a residential area nearby, where the factory workers can live. The
families of these workers need schools, hospitals and stores, so more people come to live in the area
to provide these services and so a city grows.
In every major city in the world, there is a business district where the big companies have their main
offices. In the United States, this is usually in the downtown area of the city. It is here that you can
see the huge skyscrapers containing many floors of offices. The people who work here often travel a
long way to work each day. Many of them live in the suburbs of the city, far away from the industrial
and business areas. Some suburbs are very pleasant, with nice houses and big yards. There are
usually parks for children to play in and large department stores in shopping malls where you can
buy all you need.
But what is the future of the big cities? Will they continue to get bigger and bigger? Maybe not.
Some major cities have actually become smaller in the last ten years, and it is quite possible that one
day we will see people moving out of the major cities and back into smaller towns.
A. Decide whether these statements are true or false according to the passage.
1. Many people from small towns go to live in big cities.
2. Urban areas contain mainly hills, mountains, rivers and streams.
3. Many people go to live in urban areas to find work.
4. Factories are built inside residential areas.

5. Business districts are usually in the downtown area of the city.


6. Workers often live in skyscrapers in the suburbs.
7. The suburbs of a city usually contain more trees and parks than the downtown areas.
8. The movement from country to city will definitely continue in the future.
B. 1. Do you live in a rural area, a town, or a big city? 2. Where would you like to live? Why?
177

Living in the City


Living in a city has both advantages and disadvantages. On the plus side, it is often easier to find
work, and there is usually a choice of public transport, so you don't need to own a car. Also, there are
a lot of interesting things to do and places to see. For example, you can eat in good restaurants, visit
museums, and go to the theatre and to concerts. What is more, when you want to relax, you can feed
the ducks or just sit on a park bench and read a book. All in all, city life is full of bustle and variety
and you need never feel bored.
However, for every plus there is a minus. For one thing, you might have a job, but unless it is very
well-paid, you will not be able to afford many of the things that there are to do, because living in a
city is often very expensive. It is particularly difficult to find good, cheap accommodation. What is
more, public transport is sometimes crowded and dirty, particularly in the rush hour, and even the
parks can become very crowded, especially on Sundays when it seems that every city-dweller is
looking for some open space and green grass. Last of all, despite all the crowds, it is still possible to
feel very lonely in a city. In conclusion, I think that city life can be particularly appealing to young
people, who like the excitement of the city and don't mind the noise and pollution. However, many
people, when they get older, and particularly when they have young children, often prefer the peace
and fresh air of the countryside.
A. Ask and answer questions on the text.
B. Give the synonymous words from the text to the following:
in spite of
pros and cons
another point is that
one advantage is that all things considered
for instance to sum up
in my opinion
one disadvantage is that especially
moreover
finally
C. 1. Do you live and/or work in a city? Is it very big? How many advantages and disadvantages of
city life can you think of?
Write them down.
2. Write about the pros and cons of living in the country.
178

3. Discussion: Advantages and disadvantages of living in a big city and in the country.
4. Write a few lines about your hometown

Conversation Practice Listen, read and practise.

1.
My hometown.
Woman: So tell me about your hometown, Joyce.
Joyce: Well, it's a real small town...
Woman: Really? What's it like there?
Joyce: Oh, I think it's a very boring place.
Woman: Why?
Joyce: Well, there's nothing exciting to do. No good restaurants. No nightlife of any kind. I really get
bored there.
Woman: Oh, that's too bad.
Joyce: Yeah, but lots of people love it there because it's so pretty.
Woman: Yeah?
Joyce: Uh-huh. It has lovely scenery lots of mountains, rivers, lakes, trees...
Woman: Well, I don't know, Joyce, it sounds like a nice place!
Joyce: Well, yeah, if you like to go hiking in the summer and skiing in the winter. But, you know, I'm
not the outdoor type! I'm a real city person!

2.
Woman: Do you come from a big city, Lou?
Lou:
Oh, yes, I do. It's pretty big.
Woman: What's it like there?
Lou:
Oh, it's a really great place! It has some fantastic art museums, and wonderful theatres, and
terrific restaurants of all kinds... like Greek, Russian, French, Thai, Japanese...
Woman: Ah... really? And how are the prices? Is it expensive?
Lou:
Yeah, yeah, I guess so. Food costs a lot... both in the supermarket and in restaurants. And
apartments!
179

They're so hard to find... and the rents are pretty high. Woman: Yeah, I guess it's expensive
everywhere these days.
3.
Man: Hey, Nick. Are you going home for the holidays?
Nick: No way!
Man: Oh, why not?
Nick: I don't like my hometown. Too many people, too many buildings, too many factories. It's big
and it's ugly! IH-" ke places that are small and quiet. Like here!
Man: Is your hometown as bad as that?
Nick: Yes, it's pretty bad. It doesn't even have any good restaurants.
Man: No, c'mon, Nick! No interesting theatres or nightlife?
Nick: No, not really.
Man: It sounds like a terrible place.
Nick: Yeah, it really is.
A. What do they say? Write Yes or No.
Interesting Big Expensive Beautiful 1.Joyce 2. Lou 3.Nick
B. Talk about your hometown. Ask questions like these and other questions of your own.
What's your city or hometown like? Is it an interesting place? Is it safe? What's shopping like there?
Is it expensive? Is the transportation good? Does it have good restaurants? What are the things you
like most about your hometown? What are the things you don't like about it?
C. Have a conversation about your hometown.
4.

Linda: Whereabouts in Canada are you from?


Steve: I'm from Toronto.
Linda: I've never been there. What's it like?
Steve: It's a great city! It has good museums and wonderful
180
restaurants. And the nightlife is exciting, too. Linda: Really? Is it expensive there? Steve: Well, it's
not bad, but apartments are fairly expensive. Linda: Toronto sounds like a nice place. I've heard it has
a
good subway.
Steve: Oh, yeah. It's excellent. And the buses are good, too. Linda: And what about shopping? Steve:
There are some great shopping centres and department
stores. Do you know the Euton Centre? Linda: The Euton Centre? No. What's that? Steve: Huh! It's
one of the biggest shopping centres in the
world. It has everything, and the prices are pretty good,
too.
Linda: Well, I hope some day I'll get a chance to go there. Steve: I hope so, too. If you ever go, I'll
show you around the
city...
Linda: You will? Great! Thanks! Steve: OK.
A. Questions
1. Where is Steve from? 2. What does Steve think of Toronto? 3. What does Steve say about the
transportation and shopping in Toronto?
B. What places of interest would you show your foreign guest if she/he came to your hometown?

C. Situation: Your friend from London has come to your hometown. At the moment you are showing
him/her around the town. You are a good guide, you know your hometown very well.
5.
Andy: Whereabouts are you from, Carla?
Carla: I'm from Santa Fe, New Mexico.
Andy: Oh? What's it like there?
Carla: Well, it's a beautiful little tourist town, and the climate's great. Actually, it's a centre for
American Indian culture, and there are also lots of artists there. Georgia O'Keeffe, the famous
painter, used to live there.
Andy: Really? It sounds like an interesting place! I'd like to go there sometime.
181

Carla: Yeah, you'd enjoy it, Andy. And whereabouts in England are you from, Andy?
Andy: I'm from Bath.
Carla: Really? Where's that?
Andy: It's near Bristol. It takes about an hour and a half to get there by train from London.
Carla: You know, I've always wondered why it's called "Bath". How did you get that name?
Andy: Because of its famous hot springs. Throughout history, people have gone there to bathethat's
why it's called
Bath. Carla: Ah! Is it an old city, then?
Andy: Oh, yes. In fact, it's an old Roman city, with lots of lovely old stone buildings.
Carla: Andy, it sounds really interesting! I'd love to visit Bath some day.
Andy: Well, just let me know when you plan to come and my family and I'll take care of you.
Carla: Really? Thanks! And I'd do the same for you if you ever visit my hometown of Santa Fe.
Andy: OK, then, that's a deal!
A. Questions
1. Where is Carla from? 2. What's it like there? 3. Where is Andy from? 4. Where is Bath? 5. How
did it get that name? 6. Is Bath a new or an old city?
B. Take turns talking about your favourite city. Talk about it like this and answer any questions other
students may have.
My favourite city in North America is Santa Fe. It's in New Mexico. It's an old city with lots of
interesting Spanish and Indian buildings. It's fairly small, and it's really beautiful...
'What's Mexico like?
David: Can you tell me a little about Mexico? Maria: Yes, sure. What would you like to know?
David: Well, when's the best time to visit? Maria: Mmm, you should go in the winter or spring. The
weather is nice then. It's not very hot.
182

David: Really? And does Mexico have good beaches?


Maria: Yes, the beaches are excellent.
David: Oh, good! And what places should I see?
Maria: Well, you should go to Mexico City. And you shouldn't
miss the Mayan ruins. They are very interesting. David: Great! I can't wait to go there.
A. Questions
1. When is the best time to visit Mexico? Why? 2. What are the beaches like? 3. What is worth
seeing?

Tell Me about Brazil


Man: I'm thinking of going to Brazil next year, Maria.
Maria: Oh, great! I'm sure you'll have a good time.
Man: What places do tourists visit in Brazil?
Maria: Well, a lot of people go to Rio for Carnival. And nowadays, lots of people are visiting the
Amazon to take river trips.
Man: Oh, really? That sounds interesting. And when's a good time to visit?
Maria: Well, I like Rio in the spring or fall because it's not too hot then.
Man: And what other cities are worth visiting in Brazil?
Maria: Well, I'd suggest Brasilia first.
Man: OK.

Maria: It's been the capital city of Brazil since nineteen sixty...
Man: Uh-huh.
Maria: It's not very big, but very, very modern. The architecture is very interesting. Most of the
buildings were designed by Niemeier, a famous Brazilian architect.
Man: It sounds really interesting.
Maria: Yeah, it really is... and then there's Sao Paulo.
Man: Oh? Tell me about that.
Maria: It's the biggest city in Brazil and an important commercial centre. So lots of people go there
on business... and there are not too many tourists.
Man: Oh! That's good!
Maria: It is! The restaurants are excellent great food and nightlife in Sao Paulo is out of this
world!
183
Man: Sao Paulo really sounds great! You know, actually, I'd be very interested in seeing an old city, too.
Uhm... where would you suggest?
Maria: Mmm... I think you'd enjoy Salvador in Bahia. It's on the northeast coast of Brazil and it's Brazil's
oldest city.
Man: Oh-huh.
Maria: It has a lot of beautiful old Portuguese architecture, and it's also the centre of African culture in
Brazil.
Man: Really?
Maria: And the food! My gosh, it's so good! Spicy, but delicious!
Man: Oh, I love spicy food. It sounds really interesting. I can't wait to go there! Do you know a good
travel agent?
A. Ask and answer questions on the text.
B. A visitor wants information about your country. What places do tourists like to visit? Why? Roleplay a
conversation like the one above.
Execellent Suggestions
Alex: You've been to Paris, haven't you?
Brian: Yes. As a matter of fact, I used to live in Paris.
Alex: Well, I'm planning to visit there soon. I was wondering if you could recommend some things to do.
Brian: Sure. You should definitely go to Notre Dame Cathedral. You also ought to see the Palace of
Versailles. And you must visit the Louvre.
Alex: Those sound like excellent suggestions. Can you recommend any good places to eat?
Brian: Yes. Make it a point to eat at "Maxim's". And if you go there, I suggest that you order the duck. It's
delicious.
Alex: That sounds good.
Brian: Oh, and one more thing. Be sure to have someone take your picture in front of the Eiffel Tower.
Alex: I'll do that.
Brian: Is there anything else I can tell you about?
Alex: I don't think so. You've been very helpful. Thanks a lot.
Brian: Send me a postcard, will you?
Alex: Okay.
184

A. Ask and answer questions.


B. Give a brief account of the conversation.
C. Roleplay the conversation.
D. Situation: Your friend has come to your hometown. /she wants to go sightseeing. You are telling
your friend what is worth Seeing.
Going Places
Mike is planning to visit London. He is asking a Londoner for advice.
Mike: So, Mary, where are you from?
Mary: Well, I'm from Holland, originally... but now I live in
London. Mike: Oh, really? You know, I'm planning to go to London
on vacation some time next year. What time of the year
is best for sightseeing? Mary: Well... you should go either in spring or in autumn. You

see the weather is quite nice and warm then... Mike: Ah! Mary: In winter, it's just too cold and wet and in
summer there
are too many tourists.
Mike: I see. And what do you think I should see in the city? Mary: Well, you must go to the theatre. Mike:
Of course!
Mary: There are lots of West End shows... Mike: Mm hmm. Mary: You know, musicals... drama...
Mike: Sounds great! What about other cultural events? Mary: Well, there's dance... ballet, modern dance,
lots of international companies... Mike: Brilliant! Mary: and opera... and some very good London
orchestras...
and often international ones, too. Mike: Uh-huh. What museums should I see? Mary: Well, you ought to
see the British Museum a^d the
National Gallery. Mike: Yes.
185
: And then there's the Tate, if you like modern art. Mike: Definitely!.
Mary: They're all wonderful! And you must sample the restaurants!
Mike: Of course! Mary: Londoners love eating all different kinds of food... Greek...
Chinese... Indonesian... Thai... Mike: Can't wait!
Mary: ...and some of them are really cheap! Mike: Good.
Mary: And then, of course, you should see the usual sight. seeing attractions... The Tower of
London... StPaul's Cathedral... Big Ben... Mike: ...and Oxford Street? Mary: Well, Oxford Street isn't
very exciting these days. Soho
is much more interesting...
Mike: But is it true that... I mean, everyone says Soho is dangerous...
Mary: I don't think so, really. Mike: No?
Mary: It's not nearly as bad as you see on TV and in films. But all the same you shouldn't carry too
much money on you, or walk around by yourself very late at night anywhere ... just like in any other
big city. Make: That makes sense! Thanks for the advice, Mary. I'm sure I'll have a great time.
. Questions
1. What time of the year is best for sightseeing in London? Why?
2. What is worth seeing in London?
B. Has anyone in your group visited an interesting country or city? Find out more about it. Start like
this and ask questions like the ones below.
A: I visited Spain last summer. B: Did you enjoy it?
What's the best time of the year to visit? What's the weather like then?
186
What should tourists see and do there? What's the food like? What's the shopping like? What things
should people buy? What else should visitors do there?
C. Situation: You have returned from a foreign country. Your friend is going to that country in a
week. /she is asking you about the things to see and do there.
D. What are the most popular cities and places in your country for foreign visitors? What are the
three places you would most like to visit in the world?
E. Bring to class the pictures of a city you visited. Tell your classmates about the city.
F. How many capital cities have you been to? Which do you like the most/the least? Why?
G. What are the problems facing the capital cities that you know? What is being done about these
problems?
//. Think of a place you have visited recently or which you would like to visit soon. Imagine you are there
now. Write a postcard to your friend. Be sure to cover all these points:
a) Say where you are and describe something you have seen or done.
b) What are your impressions of this place?
c) What do you like or dislike about it?
d) What are you looking forward to doing?
e) Think of a few words to write at the end.

Listening
A Quiet life
When Mr Brown retired, he bought a small cottage in a seaside village. The cottage was built in

fifteen eighty eight, but was in very good condition. Mr Brown was looking forward to a quiet life,
but in the summer holidays he got a shock. Hundreds of tourists came to the seaside village. Mr
Brown's cottage was the most
187
interesting building in the village and many of the tourists came to see it. From morning till night there
were tourists outside the cottage. They kept looking through the windows and many of them even went
into Mr Brown's garden. This was too much for Mr Brown. He decided to drive the unwelcome visitors
away, so he put a notice in the window. The notice said: "If you want to satisfy your curiosity, come in
and look round. Price: ten pence." Mr Brown was sure that the visitors would stop coming but he was
wrong. The number of the visitors increased and Mr Brown spent every day showing them round the
cottage. "I came here to retire, not to work as a guide," he complained. In the end, he sold the cottage and
bought a small modern house. It is an uninteresting little place and no one wants to see it. But it is
certainly quiet and peaceful.
A. Questions
1. When was Mr Brown's cottage built? 2. Why had Mr Brown bought it? 3. Where was the cottage? 4.
Why didn't Mr Brown like living there? 5. How did Mr Brown try to stop the visitors from coming? 6.
What did Mr Brown do with the cottage? 7. What did he buy? 8. Why is he pleased with his small
modern house?

Scottish Humour
A Scottish gentleman was spending his holidays in Vienna. The town was very beautiful and his guide
was a very beautiful young lady too. She was his guide in the town and in the country. "I will have the
best memories of her," he thought. Before he left he decided to give her some present to thank her for her
kindness. He wanted to be sure that the present was something that she'd like. And he asked her what
present she'd like best of all. "You know very well," she said, "that I like to look beautiful and to put on
beautiful things. Give me something for my neck, for my fingers or for my ears." Next morning the
Scottish gentleman appeared with a present. A diamond ring? A golden bracelet? No, it was a piece of
soap.
A. Questions
1. Where was the Scottish gentleman spending his holidays? 2. Who was his guide? 3. Did he like her? 4.
What did he decide to do to thank her for her kindness? 5. What present did the girl want to have? 6.
What did the Scottish gentleman give her?
188

The Mayor's Order


Long ago, when there were no street lamps in towns and cities, the mayor of a town ordered the people
not to go out without lanterns. The next night he met a man in a street and said to him, "Do you know my
order?" "Yes, I do," answered the man. "But you have no lantern," said the mayor. "Yes, I have," said the
man. "But there is no candle in your lantern," said the mayor. "The order said nothing about candles,"
answered the man.
The next day the people of the town learnt a new order. The order said that people must put candles in
their lanterns. In the evening the mayor met the same man. "Where is your lantern?" he asked. "Here it
is," said the man and showed his lantern to the mayor. "But there is no candle in if," cried the mayor.
"There is," said the man and showed the candle. "But you didn't light your candle," cried the angry mayor.
"The order did not say that we must light the candles."
So the mayor gave a new order. It said that the people must light candles in their lanterns.

Reading
London
London has been a capital city for nearly a thousand years, and many of its ancient buildings still stand.
The most famous of these are the Tower of London, Westminster Abbey and St Paul's Cathedral, but most
visitors also want to see the Houses of Parliament, Buckingham Palace (the Queen's London home) and
the many magnificent museums.
Once, London was a small Roman town on the north bank of the Thames, but slowly it grew into one of
the world's major cities with more than eight million people. Fewer people live in the centre now, but the
suburbs are still growing.
Places now in the heart of London, like Westminster, once stood in the middle of green fields. Many small
villages, like Hampstead, Chelsea and Mayfair, became part of London, but they still keep some of their
old atmosphere. Different areas of London seem like different cities. The West End is a rich man's world
of shops, offices and theatres. The old port area is now

189
called "Docklands". The great ships have gone, and the area is changing very fast. There are huge
new office buildings and thousands of new flats and houses.
Other parts of London are changing, too. Some of the poorer areas have become fashionable, and
people with more money are
moving into them.
A hundred years ago, the river was crowded with ships, leaving for Java and Japan, New Zealand and
New York, but now people travel by air, and London's main airport, Heathrow, is one of the
busiest in the world.
Like all big cities, London has streets and concrete buildings, but it also has many big parks, full of
trees, flowers and grass. These parks are both in the centre of the city and further out. It is the central
parks which are the most famous.
St James's Park was first opened 450 years ago. It is very close to Buckingham Palace, and to the
government offices in Whitehall. St James's Park is one often royal parks in and around London
which are owned by the Crown but are open to the public free of charge. It is very attractive, with a
long, narrow lake, which is occupied by ducks and other water birds.
Each park has its own character. Hyde Park, for example, was originally a hunting forest and is still
popular with horseriders. Now it's famous for the Serpentine the lake, and for Speakers' Corner,
where you can listen to people giving their views on a variety of topics to anyone who will listen.
Kensington Gardens is next to Hyde Park, and it is very popular with both the old and the young. On
warmer days there are always people at the Round Pond, where they come to sail their model
boats.
Regent's Park, which was originally a hunting park, is now the home of London Zoo, and an open air
theatre which delights summer audiences with performances of Shakespeare's plays.
Many people live outside the centre of London in the suburbs, and they travel to work in the shops
and offices by train, bus or underground. The trains are full and expensive and the roads are
crowded with cars, but every day a million people make the journey. Some people come from far out
of London, even from the coast, and spend up to four hours travelling every day.
Most people work from 9 a.m. to 5 p.m. From 8 until 10 every morning, and 4.30 to 6.30 every
evening, the trains are crowded
190

with people, and after the morning "rush hour" the shoppers come. By day the whole of London is
busy. At night, the offices are quiet and empty, but the West End stays alive, because this is where
Londoners come to enjoy themselves. There are two opera houses here, several concert halls and
many theatres, as well as cinemas, and in nearby Soho the pubs, restaurants and nightclubs are busy
half the night.
Many people think that London is all grey, but in fact red is London's favourite colour. The buses are
red, the letter boxes are red and the mail vans are all bright, bright red. London is at its best when
people are celebrating. Then the flags, the soldiers' uniforms, the cheering crowds and the carriages
and horses all sparkle in the sunshine if it's not raining, of course!
London has many large department stores, which sell everything: shoes and shirts, paper and
perfume, footballs and frying pans. The most expensive department store is Harrods in Knightsbridge. You can buy almost anything in Harrods, and you know you're getting the best.
The smartest and most expensive shops are in Knightsbridge, but more people come to Oxford
Street, London's most popular shopping centre. Most of the hundreds of shops sell clothes or shoes.
The street is more than a mile long. There are several big department stores in Oxford Street. The
best known are Selfridges, John Lewis and Marks and Spencer.
Oxford Street has the most shops, but in some ways King's Road in Chelsea is more fun. This is
where fashionable young Londoners buy their clothes in the many small "boutiques".
You can buy what you like in the big shops, but the small markets have a lot to offer too. There are
several big street markets in London, and many small ones. Some markets are open only one day a
week. Go to Portobello Road on Saturday, or to Petticoat Lane on Sunday. Covent Garden market is
open every day. Come here for antiques, old clothes, hand-made jewellery and many other rather
special things.
British restaurants have not always been famous for their good food. Too often, they offered only

fried food and chips with everything. But now, healthy food is in fashion and so is international
cooking.
The British have taken good ideas from all over the world. You can eat Chinese, Indian, French,
Italian and Greek food in
191
any big city, and in London there's a fantastic variety of restaurants.
Most British families only go to restaurants on special occasions, like birthdays, or wedding
anniversaries. The restaurants' best customers are business people, who meet in them to talk business in a
relaxed atmosphere away from the telephone. They can eat what they like because the company pays the
bill! But when a man and a woman want to get to know each other better, they often go out to a restaurant
together. After all, it's easier to talk in a quiet atmosphere, with soft music, wine and good food.
For visitors to London, eating out can be fun. Try Rules in the West End. The traditional menu and decor
are just like they were in Queen Victoria's day, a hundred years ago. Or take a walk round Soho or Covent
Garden where there are dozens of small restaurants.
But if you want that special London feeling, go to the Ritz in Piccadilly for tea any afternoon at about half
past four. Too expensive? Then try England's favourite food fish and chips. Take it away and eat it
where you like in the park, on the bus or while you walk down the street. That's what Londoners do!

Self check
I. First read these rather gloomy comments made by an unhappy town resident.
"Recently they've built a lot of skyscraper blocks here. I think they've made the town look ugly. And
they're going to build more. They're going to demolish an area of terraced houses, and build flats, offices,
a car park and a shopping area. In fact, when I walked past the area yesterday they were demolishing the
first house. They're destroying the town, these council planners. People have sent in hundreds of protests,
but it hasn't had any effect. They've taken their decision, and that's that. They're destroying the quality of
life in the town."
Now, basing your answers on the passage, finish the sentences below, using the passive.
Example
More skyscraper blocks...
192
Answer
More skyscraper blocks are going to be built.
1. A lot of skyscraper blocks... 2. The town... 3. An area of terraced houses... 4. A shopping area... 5.
When I walked past the area... 6. The town... by these council planners. 7. Hundreds of protests... 8. Their
decision... 9. The quality of life in the town...
II. Insert the correct articles (if necessary).
Black Gold
A. For many years Aberdeen has been one of (1) most important towns in (2) Scotland. On (3) northeast coast, it has been important for (4) fishing and for its port for (5) long time. (6) Forestry, (7)
paper-making and (8) textiles are also important, and so is (9) manufacture of (10) whisky.
In some ways it is similar to many other towns. But there is more. It has (11) old and famous
university, one of (12) oldest in (13) Europe (1494), and some of (14) best scenery on (15) British
Isles.
In 1969 Britain produced its first oil from (16) North Sea. Since then Aberdeen has changed.
Between 1969 and 1981 (17) oil and gas industry brought more than 500 new companies into (18)
city. Since (19) start of (20) oil industry (21) harbour has become larger and much busier.
For (22) last fifteen years or more Aberdeen has been (23) international city. You can hear (24)
Americans and (25) Europeans in (26) shops and (27) hotels. (28) number of (29) air passengers has
increased 540 per cent since 1973, and (30) port is (31) biggest in (32) world.
Since 1494 this city of (33) quarter of (34) million people has been (35) educational centre. It is now
also (36) industrial and entertainment centre for (37) north-east Scotland, and more than that, it's (38)
oil capital of (39) Europe.
B. Jim Stewart is returning to Aberdeen after twenty years. His old school friend meets him at (1)
airport.
Jim: Am I in (2) wrong place? This doesn't look like (3) old airport. What's happened?
193
Friend: Eh, you've been away for several years, Jim. Since they

found (4) oil this place hasn't been (5) same. Jim: Ah, but you haven't changed a bit! Friend: I've
got (6) bit less hair and (7) few more inches around
(8) waist. Mary's (9) good cook. Here, let's getyour bags... Jim: That building's new, isn't it?
Friend: Yes, it's one of (10) new oil companies. It's been there
since, oh, I forgot (11) date. Anyway, for quite (12) long
time.
Jim: It's fantastic! Friend: Oh, I remember now. 1971. It's been there since about '71.
It was (13) old cinema before that. Jim: Oh, I remember that cinema. I took Fiona there...

UNIT 11 GRAMMAR: PARTICIPLE


Present participle (as adjective)
Jim: That banging door is getting on my nerves. I haven't slept at all tonight. I might as well get up
and make a cup of tea.
Jean: That's an interesting idea. You could close the door at the same time.
Jim: Oh! What's that flashing light over there? My goodness! It's a police car. What do they want?
Policeman (at the door): Sorry to disturb you, sir, but have you noticed a strong burning smell? I'm
afraid your garage has already burned to the ground!
|USE1| In front of nouns
eg The amazing thing about the whole situation was that they were able to live for so long without water.
|USE2| After be
eg It is exciting.
The news sounds alarming. She looks appealing.
The most common present participles as adjectives are:
amazing
exciting
shocking
amusing
frightening
surprising
confusing
interesting
tiring
embarrassing
pleasing
worrying

Present partici -t (introducing an adjectival phrase)


Forester: Do you see those pine trees standing to the right of us?
195
The whitish-looking ones with no leaves. Tourist: Yes. Why do they look different from all the
others?
Forester: The leaves lying on the ground give us the answer. And the little insects running around all
over the tree trunks will kill off the trees here. Within the next six months you will be standing in a
graveyard containing only a few rotten tree trunks. Tourist: Can't the authorities do anything about it?
[USE] We can use a present participle to introduce an adjectival phrase in order to give extra
information about a noun.
eg The man swimming through the water is my uncle. (= The man who is swimming through the
water is my uncle.) The train arriving on platform four is one hour late. (= The train which is arriving
on platform four is one hour late.)

Present participle (introducing an adverbial phrase)


Shouting loudly and waving his arms, the fat shopkeeper ran down the road. A few feet in front of
him a small, thin man was sprinting away. Laughing loudly, he shouted back to the shopkeeper:
"You'll never catch me. You'll never get your money back." Concentrating on his conversation with
the shopkeeper, the thief had not noticed the small boy playing with his roller skates.
Bending quickly, the boy unstrapped a skate and rolled it in front of the man. The thief put his foot
on to it and fell flat on his back with a bang.
| USE) Showing how, why or when
The present participle (-ing) is used to talk about an action that happens at the same time as another
action, (a simultaneous action)
I walked out of the room smiling to myself. (= When I
walked out of the room I was smiling
to myself.)
196
I had an accident driving to work. (= I had an accident while I was driving to work.)
The present participle as an adverbial modifier may come after the conjunctions while or when:

Jane ate her dinner while sitting in front of the television.


You can also use an -ing phrase to explain the reason why something happens.
Knowing you wanted to go to the concert, I bought a ticket for you. (= because I knew you
wanted to go to the concert)
Not having a car, she finds it difficult to get around. (= because she doesn't have a car)

Perfect participle (introducing an adverbial phrase)


[USE I Showing how, why or when
The perfect participle (having done) is used when one action happens before another action, (a prior
action)
Having found a hotel, they looked for somewhere to have dinner.
Having finished our work, we went home.
You could also say After ing:
After finishing our work, we went home.
If the second action happens immediately after the first, you can use the simple -ing form (doing
instead of having done):
Taking a key out of his pocket, he opened the door. These structures are used mainly in written
English.

Present participle (after verbs of perception)


Jane: One lunchtime Jim and I left the office and went right down to the harbour. It was lovely. We
wat197
ched boats sailing by and listened to the birds
singing.
Sally: Weren't you worried that you'd be late back? Jane: Not at all. We even paddled and felt the
cool w ater
rolling over our feet! It was idyllic. Sally: Very romantic! But what happened? Did you get
back on time? Jane: Not quite, but fortunately nobody noticed us
coming in.
I USE I Perceiving/sensing an action
When we use a present participle after verbs like see, hear, watch, notice and feel we emphasize
experience of part of an action:
They watched the athletes running. (= while they were running)
At work yesterday, I heard someone shouting at Mr Lewis in the next room.
Do you see Mary walking up the street? Isn't that her, the woman in the red dress?
When we want to emphasize the experience of the complete action we use an infinitive without to
after the verb of perception.
I remember it distinctly. At 5:30 yesterday afternoon, I saw Jim walk to his car, open the door, and
get in.

Past participle (as adjective)


Charles: I've said this before, I know, but look at this flat. It really is the last time we have a party
here! There are four smashed glasses and three broken plates and there seem to be bits of uneaten
food everywhere.
David: You're right and look at the rag. It's ruined. There's red wine all over it.
Martin: Come on stop feeling so disgusted. We'd better get on and clean the place up.
I USE 1| In front of nouns
eg There were a lot of excited fans at the stadium. He answered through the locked door.
[USE 21 After be (or some other verbs)
The picture is damaged.
He sounds interested.
The victims remained forgotten.

Past participle (introducing an adjectival phrase)


The town, almost deserted since the battles with the enemy, stood black and half-ruined. Many
houses, hit and destroyed by bombs and gun-fire, were nothing more than piles of stones. There were
still a few people left amongst the buildings. Now, after the soldiers had gone away, they were

beginning to creep out. Shocked by what they saw around, they stood silently.
198
| USE I With or without relative pronoun

We can use a past participle to introduce an adjectival phrase in order to give extra information about
a noun. The phrase may or may not include a relative pronoun:
The town, deserted since the battles, stood black and half ruined. c> The town, which had been
deserted since the battles, stood black and half-ruined.
There were still a few people left amongst the buildings. e> There were still a few people who had
been left amongst the buildings.
Ray, depressed after his unfortunate road accident, decided to go for a holiday.

Have something done


a) We use the structure have something done to talk about something which we arrange for someone
else to do for us.
199
I'm having a garage built at the moment. Compare:
I'm building a garage at the moment. (I'm building the garage myself.)
I'm having a garage built at the moment. (I arranged for someone else to do this for me.)
More examples:
I had my carpet cleaned by a professional carpet cleaner. We didn't do it ourselves.
I usually have my car serviced at a garage in East Street.
b) We can also use have something done when we do not arrange for someone else to do something
for us.
I had my leg broken in a football match.
We had our fence blown down in a storm last week.
We often use have something done in this way when something unpleasant or unexpected happens to
someone.
Note that we can often use get something done instead of have something done, eg I must get this
jacket cleaned.

Practice Participial adjectives


The problem confuses the students.
(a) It is a confusing problem.
The present participle conveys an active meaning. The noun it modifies does something. In (a): The
noun "problem" does something; it "confuses." Thus it is described as a "confusing problem."
The students are confused by the problem.
(b) They are confused students.
The past participle conveys a passive meaning. In (b): The students are confused by something. Thus,
they are described as "confused students."
200

I. Complete the sentences with the present or past participle.


eg The class bores the students. It's a boring class.
eg The students are bored by the class. They are bored students.
1. The game excites the people. It is an... game. 2. The people are excited by the game. They are...
people. 3. The news surprised the man. It was... news. 4. The man was surprised by the news. It was
a ... man. 5. The child was frightened by the strange noise. The ... child sought comfort from her
father. 6. The strange noise frightened the child. It was a... sound. 7. The work exhausted the men. It
was ... work. 8. The men were exhausted. The ... men sat down to rest under the shade of a tree. 9.
The story amuses the children. It is an ... story. 10. The children are amused by the story. They are ...
children. 11. Mike heard some bad news. The bad news depressed him. a) Mike is very sad. In other
words, he is... b) The news made Mike feel sad. The news was... 12. Nancy's rude behaviour
embarrassed her parents, a) Nancy's rude behaviour was... b) Nancy's parents were... 13. The nation's
leader stole money. The scandal shocked the nation, a) It was a ...scandal. b)The... nation soon
replaced the leader. 14. I like to study sea life. The subject of marine biology fascinates me. a) I'm ...
by marine biology, b) Marine biology is a... subject.
II. Choose the correct form (-ing or-ed) of the words in brackets.
1. Don't bother to read that book. It's (boring, bored). 2. The students are (interesting, interested) in

learning more about the subject. 3. Mrs Green doesn't explain things well. The students are
(confusing, confused). 4. Have you heard the latest news? It's really (exciting, excited). 5.1 don't
understand these directions. I'm (confusing, confused). 6. I read an (interesting, interested) article in
the newspaper this morning. 7.1 heard some (surprising, surprised) news on the radio. 8. I'm (boring,
bored). Let's do something. How about going to a movie? 9. Mr Sawyer bores me. I think he is a
(boring, bored) person. 10. Mr Ball fascinates me. I think he is a (fascinating, fascinated) person. 11.
Most young children are (fascinating, fascinated) by animals. 12. Young children think that animals
are (fascinating, fascinated). 13.1 was very (embarrassing, embarrassed) yesterday when I spilled my
drink on the dinner table. 14. That was an (embarrassing, embarrassed) experience. 15.1 read a
(shocking, shocked) report
201
yesterday on the number of children who die from starvation in the world every day. I was really
(shocking, shocked). 16. The children went to a circus. For them, the circus was (exciting, excited). The
(exciting, excited) children jumped up and down.
III. Complete the sentences with the present or past participle of the verbs in brackets.
1. The (steal) car was found in the woods. 2. Success in one's work is a (satisfy) experience. 3. The tiger
was a (terrify) sight for the villagers. 4. The (terrify) villagers ran for their lives. 5.1 found myself in an
(embarrass) situation last night. 6. A kid accidentally threw a ball at one of the school windows. Someone
needs to repair the (break) window. 7. A (damage) earthquake occurred recently. 8. People are still in the
process of repairing the many (damage) buildings and streets. 9. I elbowed my way through the (crowd)
room. 10. No one lives in that (desert) house except a few ghosts. 11. The thief tried to open the (lock)
cabinet. 12. The (injure) woman was put into an ambulance. 13.1 bought some (freeze) vegetables at the
supermarket. 14. The (expect) event did not occur. 15. A (grow) child needs a (balance) diet. 16. There is
an old saying: Let (sleep) dogs lie. 17. At present, the (lead) candidate in the senatorial race is Henry
Moore. 18. Any (think) person knows that smoking is a destructive habit. 19.1 still have five more
(require) courses to take. 20. (Pollute) water is not safe for drinking. 21.1 don't have any furniture of my
own. Do you know where I can rent a (furnish) apartment? 22. No one may attend the lecture except
(invite) guests. 23. The (suggest) remedy for the common cold is to rest and to drink plenty of fluids. 24.
Because we have a (write) agreement, our landlord won't be able to raise our rent for two years. 25. (Experience) travellers pack lightly. They carry little more than necessities.
IV. Change the adjective clauses to adjective phrases.
eg Do you know the woman who is coming toward us?
Do you know the woman coming toward us? eg I come from a city that is located in the southern part of
the
country.
I come from a city located in the southern part of the
country.
1. The man who is talking to John is from Korea. 2. The ideas which are presented in that book are
interesting. 3. Anyone who wants to come with us is welcome. 4. The people who are waiting for the bus
in the rain are getting wet. 5. The children who attend that school receive a good education. 6. The
scientists who are researching the causes of cancer are making progress. 7. The fence which surrounds
our house is made of wood. 8. They live in a house that was built in 1890. 9. We have an apartment which
overlooks the park. 10. Did you get the message which concerned the special meeting? 11. Be sure to
follow the instructions that are given at the top of the page. 12. The conclusion which is presented in that
book states that most of the automobiles which are produced by American industry have some defect. 13.
The photographs which were published in the newspaper were extraordinary. 14. There is almost no end
to the problems that face a head of state. 15. The psychologists who study the nature of sleep have made
important discoveries. 16. The experiment which was conducted at the University of Chicago was
successful. 17. David Keller, who is a young poet who is known for his sensitive interpretations of human
relationships, has just published another volume of poems. 18. Any student who doesn't want to go on the
trip should inform the office. 19. He read "The Old Man and the Sea", a novel which was written by
Ernest Hemingway. 20. My uncle Elias, who is a restaurant owner, often buys fish and shellfish from
boats that are docked at the local pier. Customers come from miles around to dine on a seafood feast that
is considered to be the best in all of the northeastern United States. 21. The children attended a special
movie program that consisted of cartoons that featured Donald Duck and Mickey Mouse.
V. Complete the newspaper story about an earthquake in a city called Kitamo. Put in either an -ing form
or an -ed form. Use these verbs: break, burn, cry, damage, fall, frighten, injure, smoke. (You have to

use one of the verbs twice.)


There was an earthquake in the Kitamo region at ten o'clock yesterday morning. It lasted about a minute.
Many buildings collapsed.... people ran into the streets. Many were injured by... bricks and stones. After
the earthquake, buildings in many parts
202
203
of the city caught fire. The heat was so great that firemen could not get near many of the ... buildings.
Hundreds of people have died. The hospital is still standing, but there aren't enough beds for all the ...
people. Things look very bad in Kitamo now. There are hundreds of badly ... houses, and those that
caught fire are now just ... ruins. The streets are covered with ... glass, and ... trees block the way.
Everywhere there is the sound of... children.

Present participle and perfect participle (introducing an adverbial phrase)


I. Join the sentences using an -ing clause, as in the example.
eg I was sitting in the park. I was writing a letter. I was sitting in the park writing a letter.
1. The woman was driving along. She was listening to her car radio. 2. I arrived at the examination
hall. I was feeling very nervous. 3. He came into the room. He was carrying a suitcase.
4. They were walking down the street. They were holding hands.
5. She was sitting in an armchair. She was reading a book. 6. Jill was lying on the bed. She was
crying. 7.1 got home. I was feeling very tired. 8. The old man was walking along the street. He was
talking to himself.
II. In these sentences one thing happens during another.
eg Jim was playing tennis. He hurt his arm. Jim hurt his arm playing tennis.
1. Ann was watching television. She fell asleep. 2. The man slipped. He was getting off the bus. 3.
The boy was crossing the road. He was knocked over. 4. He fell off a ladder. He was changing a light
bulb. 5. Dick burnt himself. He was cooking his dinner. 6. He broke a cup. He was doing the
washing-up. 7. He ran out of petrol. He was driving to work. 8. She lost her keys. She was getting out
of her car.
III. This time make sentences beginning Having...
eg We finished our work. We went home. Having finished our work, we went home.
204
1. We bought our tickets. Then we went into the theatre. 2. They had dinner. Then they continued on
their journey. 3. She did all her shopping. Then she went for a cup of coffee. 4. I finished the washing
up, then I sat down and watched TV. 5. He typed the letters, then he put them all in envelopes. 6. I
did all the housework, then I went out for a walk. 7. He got out of bed, then he had a shower. 8. She
locked all the doors, then she went to bed.
IV. Rephrase the sentences using an -ing clause, as in the examples.
eg Because she didn't want to miss the train, she ran all the way to the station.
Not wanting to miss the train, she ran all the way to the station, eg Because I had just eaten, I wasn't
hungry. Having just eaten, I wasn't hungry.
1. Because she is a little deaf, she wears hearing-aid. 2. Because I don't like classical music, I didn't
go to the concert. 3. Because she is rich, she can afford expensive holidays. 4. Because I had finished
the book, I decided to take it back to the library. 5. Because they had gone to bed so late the night
before, they felt quite tired the next day. 6. Because he had failed the exam the first time, he decided
to take it again. 7. Because I didn't know his address, I couldn't contact him.
V. A reporter has made some notes about afire on a passenger aircraft. Combine eachpair of sentences.
Use the -ed form, -ing form or perfect-ing form.
eg The plane was delayed by technical problems. It took off one
hour late.
Delayed by technical problems, the plane took off one
hour late, eg The passengers saw smoke. They became alarmed.
Seeing smoke, the passengers became alarmed, eg The pilot had travelled only a short distance from
Heathrow. He decided to turn back.
Having travelled only a short distance from Heathrow, the
pilot decided to turn back.
205

1. The airport fire service was warned by air traffic control. It prepared to fight a fire. 2. The passengers
believed the aircraft was going to crash. Some of them shouted in panic. 3. The pilot brought the plane
down safely. Then he felt very relieved. 4. Everyone was worried by the risk of fire. They hurried to get
out. 5. The firemen used chemicals. They soon put out the fire. 6. Most of the passengers had had enough
excitement for one day. They put off their journey.
VI. Complete the story in the Mudford Gazette about a girl who paints pictures. Put each verb in brackets
into the -ing form or -ed form.
13-year-old Annabel Waites of Mudford has won first prize in a national art competition. Her (win)
picture is a painting of Mudford Hill.
I talked to Annabel at her home in Embury Road. At the moment she has a (break) arm, which she got
(play) netball. Fortunately it's her left arm, so she can still paint. Annabel usually listens to music while
(paint). And she always paints (stand) up because she feels more comfortable that way. "I often feel very
tired after (finish) a picture," she told me. "It takes a lot out of me."
Annabel was working on a half-(fmish) picture of horses in a field. And on the wall was a beautifully
(draw) portrait of her dog Beezer. (Be) an animal lover, Annabel often paints pictures of animals. On
another wall I noticed a picture of a lawn (cover) with (fall) leaves. (Encourage) by her success, Annabel
hopes to make painting her career, although she knows it will not be easy. But (help) by her art teacher,
Mrs Emma Goodenough of Portway School, she has developed an individual style.
Annabel has many other hobbies, and she often goes (skate) with her friends.
VII. Join each of the following pairs of sentences, using either a present participle eg knowing, a past
participle eg known, or a perfect participle eg having known.
He got off his horse. He began searching for something on the ground.
Getting off his horse, he began searching...
I had seen photographs of the place. I had no desire to go there.
206
Having seen photographs of the place, I had no desire... The speaker refused to continue. He was
infuriated by the interruptions. Infuriated by the interruptions, the speaker refused...
1. I knew that he was poor. I offered to pay his fare. 2. We barricaded the windows. We assembled in the
hall. 3. She became tired of my complaints about the programme. She turned it off. 4. He found no one at
home. He left the house in a bad temper. 5. She hoped to find the will. She searched everywhere. 6. He
realized that he had missed the last train. He began to walk. 7. He was exhausted by his work. He threw
himself on his bed. 8. He had spent all his money. He decided to go home and ask his father for a job. 9.
He escaped from prison. He looked for a place where he could get food. 10. She didn't want to hear the
story again. She had heard it all before. 11. She entered the room. She found them smoking. 12.1 turned
on the light. I was astonished at what I saw.
13. We visited the museum. We decided to have lunch in the park.
14. He offered to show us the way home. He thought we were lost.
15. She asked me to help her. She realized that she couldn't move it alone. 16. He fed the dog. He sat
down to his own dinner. 17.1 have looked through the fashion magazines. I realize that my clothes are
hopelessly out of date. 18. We were soaked to the skin. We eventually reached the station. 19. One day
you will be sitting by the fire. You will remember this day. 20. I didn't like to sit down. I knew there were
ants in the grass. 21. She believed that she could trust him absolutely. She gave him a blank cheque. 22.1
had heard that the caves were dangerous. I didn't like to go any further without a light.
I. Respond to the following using spend + time + -ing.
eg A: Do you ever work in the garden?
B: Yes. I spent all yesterday afternoon working in thegar-den.
Do you ever...
1. tidy up?
2. wash the coffee cups?
3. remove the empty bottles?
4. sweep up the broken glass?
5. empty the ashtrays?
6. clean your flat?
7. beat the carpets?
8. make the beds?
9. replace the broken bulbs?

10. apologize to the landlord?


11. tune the piano?
12. shake the mats?
13. take the dog for a walk?
14. pay your bills?
15. type?
16. write letters?
II. Complete the following.
eg We had a lot of fun... games at the picnic. We had a lot of fun playing games at the picnic.
1.1 have trouble ... Mrs Maxwell when she speaks. She talks too fast. 2.1 spent five hours... my
homework last night. 3. Martha is standing at the corner ... for the bus. 4. Michael is sitting in class ...
notes. 5. Mrs Anderson is a commuter. Every work day, she spends almost two hours ... to and from
work. 6. It was a beautiful spring day. Dorothy was lying under a tree ... to the birds sing. 7. We
wasted our money ... to that movie. It was very boring. 8. Joe spent all day ... ready to leave on
vacation. 9. Ted is an indecisive person. He has a hard time ... up his mind about anything. 10. I
wondered what the children were doing while I was gone. When I got home, I found them ... TV. 11.
When Mr Brown walked into the kitchen, he caught the children ... some
209
candy even though he'd told them not to spoil their dinners. 12. A: My friend is going to Germany
next month, but he doesn't speak German. What do you suppose he will have difficulty...? B: Well, he
might have trouble... 13. A: Did you enjoy your trip to New York City? B: Very much. We had a
good time... 14. A: This is your first semester at this school. Have you had any problems? B: Not
really, but sometimes I have a hard time... 15. A: What did you do yesterday? B: I spent almost all
day...
III. Make sentences from the given combinations.
eg have a difficult time + understand
I have a difficult time understanding the teacher's explanations in calculus.
1. have trouble + remember 2. stand (place) + wait 3. have a hard time + learn 4. sit (place) + think
5. have a good time + play 6. lie (place) + dream 7. have difficulty + find 8. have fun + sing and
dance 9. find (someone) + study 10. spend (time) + chat 11. waste (money) + try 12. catch (someone)
+ take
Present participle (after verbs of perception)
I. In each of these situations you and a friend saw, heard or smelt something. This is what you said at the
time:
1. Look! There's Ann! She's waiting for a bus. 2. Look! There's Sue! She's playing tennis. 3. Look!
There's Tom! He's having a meal in that restaurant. 4. Listen! That's Bill. He's playing the guitar. 5.1
can smell something! The dinner's burning! 6. Look! There's Dave! He's talking to Charles. 7. Listen!
Jack is snoring. 8. Listen! The dog is barking. 9. Look! Kate is dancing.
Later you tell someone what you saw, heard or smelt. eg We saw Ann waiting for d bus.
II. Answer these questions beginning in the way shown.
eg "Does Tom ever dance?" "I've never seen him dance (or dancing)!" eg "How do you know I came
late?" "I heard you come in late."
1. "Does Ann ever smoke?" "I've never seen..." 2. "How do
210
you know the man took the money?" "I saw..." 3. "Did Jack lock the door?" "Yes, I heard..." 4. "Did
the bell ring?" "I'm not sure. I didn't hear..." 5. "Does Tom ever swear (= use bad language)?" "I've
never heard..." 6. "How do you know Ann can play the piano?" "I've heard..." 7. "Did Bill kick the
dog?" "Yes, I saw..." 8. "Did the boy fall into the water?" "I didn't see..."
III. Complete these sentences. Use one of the following verbs in the correct form.
ran explode
burn
slam sit open
tell
crawl
cry
happen climb
1. Can you smell something...? 2. I saw the accident... 3. We listened to the old man... his story from
beginning to end. 4. Listen! Can you hear a child...? 5. We watched the two men ... across the
garden,... a window and... through it into the house. 6. Everybody heard the bomb... It was a
tremendous noise. 7. Oh! I can feel something... up my leg! It must be an insect. 8.1 heard someone...

the door in the middle of the night. It woke me up. 9. We couldn't find Tom at first. In the end we
found him ... in the garden.
Have something done
I. In this exercise you have to answer the questions in the way shown.
eg "Did Ann make that dress herself?" "No, she had it made."
1. "Did you cut your hair yourself?" "No, I..." 2. "Did they paint the house themselves?" "No, they..."
3. "Did Jim cut down that tree himself?" "No,..." 4. "Did Sue repair the car herself?" ! "No,..." 5.
"Did you tune the piano yourself?" "No,..."
III. This time you have to complete the sentences. Use the words Jfn brackets.
eg We (the house/paint) at the moment.
We are having the house painted at the moment, eg (you/your hair/cut) last week?
Did you have your hair cut last week?
211

1. Your hair is too long. I think you should (it/cut). 2. How often (you/your car/service)? 3. The
engine in Tom's car couldn't be repaired, so he had to (a new engine/fit) 4. (you/your newspaper
(deliver) or do you go to the shop to buy it? 5. A: What are those workmen doing in your garden? B:
Oh, I (a swimming pool/ build.). 6. Is it true that many years ago he (his portrait/paint) by a famous
artist? 7. Are you going to (these shoes/repair) or shall I throw them away? 8. I must (my glasses/
mend). They keep falling off. 9. Where do you (your hair/do)?
III. Something unpleasant happened to each of these people last week. Make sentences using "have
something done ".
eg Kate (her wallet/steal) from her bag while she was out shopping.
Kate had her wallet stolen from her bag while she was out shopping.
1. Peter (his flat/burgle) while he was out at work. 2. Mr and Mrs Woods (the roof of their
house/damage) in a storm. 3. Lynne (the radio/ steal) from her car. 4. My brother (his nose/break) in a
football match. 5. Fred (his hat/blow off) in the wind.

Self check
I. Supply an appropriate form for each verb in brackets.
1. Edward stood on the beach (look) out over the ocean. 2. Why don't you let him (make) up his
mind? 3. Jean sat on a park bench (watch) the ducks (swim) in the pond. 4. Sara is going to spend
next year (study) at a university in Japan. 5. The sad expression on his face made me (feel) sorry for
him. 6.1 didn't know how to get to Harry's house, so I had him (draw) a map for me. 7. The little boy
had a lot of trouble (convince) anyone that he had seen a mermaid. 8. The teacher had the class
(open) their books to page 185. 9. It was a hot day and the work was hard. I could feel sweat (trickle)
down my back. 10.1 had the brakes of my car (repair) at Morgan's Garage. 11.1 got my roommate
(help) me (prepare) for my final exam in physics. 12. The soldier spent an hour (polish) his boots. 13.
To please my daughter, I had her old bicycle (paint) bright red. 14. Many people think Mr Peel will
win the election.
212
He has a good chance of (elect). 15. Mr Flynn is good at (tell) the difference between diamonds and
cut glass. 16. I found a penny (lie) on the sidewalk. 17.1 was tired, so I just watched them (play)
volleyball instead of (join) them. 18. You can lead a horse to water, but you can't make him (drink).
19.1 finally told him (be) quiet for a minute and (listen) to what I had to say. 20. You shouldn't let
children (play) with matches. 21. Mary Beth suggested (go) on a picnic. 22.1 was terribly
disappointed (discover) that he had lied to me. 23. I admit (be) a little nervous about the job
interview. I don't know what (expect). 24. We sat in his kitchen (sip) very hot, strong tea and (eat)
cheese. 25. When Shelley needed a passport photo, she had her picture (take) by a professional
photographer. 26. If you hear any news, I want (tell) immediately. 27. He's at an awkward age. He's
old enough (have) adult problems but too young (know) how (handle) them. 28. There's a great
difference between (be) a freshman and (be) a senior. 29. My English is very good, but sometimes I
have trouble (understand) lectures at school. 3() Let's (have) Ron and Maureen (join) us for dinner
tonight, okay? 31.1 have finally collected enough information (begin) writing my thesis.
32. I don't see how she can possibly avoid (fail) the course.
33. Emily stopped her car (let) a black cat (ran) across the street.
34. He's a terrific soccer player! Did you see him (make) that last goal? 35. We spent the entire class

period (talk) about the revolution. 36. The number of apartment houses (build) for the population of
our city is rapidly growing. 37. What is the number of apartment houses (build) in the past few
years? 38. She smiled (remember) the joke. 39. Isabel expected (admit) to the university, but she
wasn't. 40. When Franko went to the barber shop (get) his hair (cut), he had his beard (trim), too. 41.
(Enter) the hall you will see a staircase (lead) to the basement. 42. I hope you will write soon,
(explain) your intention. 43. My children enjoy (allow) to stay up late when there's something special
on TV. 44. We are looking forward to (take) on a tour of Athens by our Greek friends. 45. (See) so
little of the country, I'm afraid I cannot give exhaustive answers to all your questions. 46. (Know)
how fond he is of good music, I brought him a few records. 47. (Know) him from school, I have
never heard anyone (speak) badly of him. 48. John admitted (surprise) by the unexpected birthday
party last night. We had a lot of fun (plan) it. 49. Now I remember your (ask) me to bring sandwiches
to the picnic. Your complaints about my (forget) things seem justified.
213

I'm sorry. 50 I wasn't tired enough (sleep) last night. For a long time, I just lay in bed (think) about
my career and my future. 51. Art smelled something (burn). When he ran into the kitchen, he saw fire
(come) out of the oven and panicked. 52. After I decided (have) a garage (build) next to the house, I
hired a carpenter (do) the work. 53. Jeff applied to medical school many months ago. Now he's so
concerned about (accept) into medical school that he's having a difficult time (concentrate) on the
courses he's taking this term. 54. My son is playing in his first piano concert this evening. I'm looking
forwardto (hear) him (play), but I know he's worried about (forget) the right notes and (make) a fool
of himself. I told him (relax) and (enjoy) himself. 55. There's not much point (waste) a lot of time
and energy on that project. It's likely (fail) no matter what we do. Spend your time (do) something
more worthwhile. 56. (Ask) what he thought of the innovation, the engineer said he approved of it.
57. (Arrive) at the gallery, he paid his entrance fee, picked up a catalogue and entered. 58. Our house
needs (clean). The floors need (sweep). The dishes need (wash). The furniture needs (dust). However,
I think I'll read a book. (Read) is a lot more interesting than (do) housework. 59. He accepted the cut
in salary without complaint because he was afraid (complain). He was afraid of (lose) his job. 60.
Next time we go (house-hunt), remember (ask) the agent for clear directions. I wasted hours (look)
for the last house. 61. Tom: Let's (go) for a swim. Ann: I'm not particularly keen on (swim). What
about (go) for a drive instead? 62. After (spend) two days (argue) about where to go for their
holidays, they decided (not go) anywhere. 63. He is talking about (give) up his job and (go) (live) in
the country. 64. I was just about (leave) the office when the phone rang. It was my wife; she wanted
me (call) at the butcher's on my way home. 65. He said, "I'm terribly sorry to (keep) you (wait) " I
said, "It doesn't matter at all," but he went on (apologize) for nearly five minutes! 66. (Promise)
assistance they felt more assured. 67. My father thinks I'm not capable of (earn) my own living, but I
mean (show) him that he is wrong. 68. Tom: I can't get my car (start) on cold mornings. Jack: Have
you tried (fill) the radiator with hot water? That sometimes helps. 69. We stopped once (buy) petrol
and then we stopped again (ask) someone the way. 70. When I caught them (cheat) me, I stopped
(buy) petrol there and started (deal) with your garage instead. 71. The people
214

(wait) for the doctor have been sitting here for a long time. 72. Do you feel like (dine) out or would
you rather (have) dinner at home? I'd like (go) out. I always enjoy (have) dinner in a restaurant.
73. Your hair needs (cut). You'd better (have) it done tomorrow. 74.1 tried (convince) him that I was
perfectly capable of (manage) on my own, but he insisted on (help) me. 75.1 always try (come) in
quietly but they always hear me (go) upstairs. It's impossible (climb) an old wooden staircase without
(make) a noise. 76. (Go) down the steps she suddenly stopped as she remembered that she had left
the gas (burn) 77. He knows the language better than a foreigner usually does, (live) in France for a
long time. 78. If you want the milkman (leave) you milk in the morning, remember (put) a milk
bottle outside your door. 79. Mr Shaw is very busy (write) his memoirs. He is far too busy (receive)
callers, so you'd better just (go) away. 80. Would you like me (turn) down the radio a bit? No, it's
all right. I'm used to (work) with the radio on. 81. Would your children mind (keep) quiet fora
moment? I'm trying (fill) in a form. It's no use (ask) children (keep) quiet. They can't help (make)
a noise. 82. Let's (go) (fish) today. There's a nice wind. What about (come) with us, Ann? No,
thanks. I'm very willing (cut) sandwiches for you but I've no intention of (waste) the afternoon (sit)
in a boat (watch) you two (fish). 83. After (spend) a week in the cottage, he decided that he didn't

really enjoy (live) in the country and began (think) of an excuse for (sell) the cottage and (return) to
London. 84. Vegetables (grow) in hot-houses are not so rich in colour and taste as vegetables (grow)
in natural surroundings. 85. She stayed (lock) in her room, (refuse) to come downstairs. 86. He had a
good practical knowledge of the language, (work) as an interpreter for many years. 87. She never did
a thing without (ask) somebody's advice.
II. Translate from Russian into English.
Participles as adjectives and adjectival phrases
1. , , . 2.
. 3. , . 4.
. 5. ,
215

, . 6.
. 7. . 8.
.
9. , , .
10. , , .
11. , , 6 . 12.
, , , . 13. ,
, . 14. , . 15. ,
. 16. , . 17
, . 18. ,
. 19. , ,
6 . 20. ,
. 21. . 22. , ,
, . 23. , , . 24. ,
, . 25. , ,
. 26. , ,
. 27. , , .
28. , , .
29. , , . 30. ,
, . 31. ,
. 32. , , . 33.
,
34. , , .
35. , , . 36. ,
, . 37. , ,
.
Participles introducing adverbial phrases
1 , .
2 , - . 3. ,
. 4. , . 5.
, . 6. ,
. 7. , , . 8.
, . 9. , , . 10. ,
. 11. ,
, . 12. , ,
, . 13. , , . 14.
, . 15. . 16. ,
. 17. , . 18.
, . 19. ,
, . 20. ,
. 21. , . 22. ,
. 23. , . 24. ,
. 25. , , . 26. ,
. 27. , . 28. ,
, . 29. , .
30. . 31. , .
32. , .

Participle after verbs of perception


1- , . 2. , . 3.
, . 4. , - .

216
217
5. , . 6. , . 7.
, . 8. ,
. 9. , . 10. ,
, . 11. , -
.
Have something done
1. ? 2. . 3.
, . 4. ,
. 5. . 6. ? .
? 100 . 7. ,
. 8. ? 9. ? 10. , ,
? 11. ? 12. . 13.
, . 14. .

Fluency Listen, read and practise.


ghosts

It was Friday 13 January 1985. The Samsons had just moved into an old house in Borley in Essex.
The house, built about two hundred years earlier, had once belonged to a man called Boyson. Some
people in the village said the house was haunted. They said that Boyson's daughter Mary had fallen in
love with Harold, a blacksmith from the village. Knowing that her father would not allow them to marry,
Mary had planned to run away with Harold. But her father, having overheard their plans, locked Mary in
her room and shot Harold. When Mary found out, she hanged herself. Her father, realizing that he had
done something terrible, died of a broken heart.
One night, John Samson was lying in bed reading. Suddenly he heard a strange moaning noise, like a man
crying. Seconds
later, the cigarette he was smoking went out and the room turned cold. Again he thought he heard
someone crying and moving about. Having searched all the rooms, he decided it must have been the
wind. Being very tired, he fell asleep, with a lighted cigarette in his hand... He dreamt that he could hear
someone knocking loudly and that he could smell something burning. But it wasn't a dream. The bedroom
curtains were on fire! Samson ran out of the house.
Fifty people from the village gathered outside, watching the burning house. A policeman thought he saw a
young woman trapped in an upstairs room, knocking at the window, but there was nobody in the house.
Several people saw two figures wearing dark clothes walking through the flames. An old man with a
beard stood crying at the door...
No bodies were found in the ruins. No one was surprised.
A. Ask and answer questions on the text.
B. Retell the text. Use the participial constructions.
C. Say the sentences using a participle instead of a relative clause.
eg The story which has been told in Borley for over a hundred years is true. The story told in Borley for
over a hundred years is true.
1. The old house which had been built two hundred years earlier had once belonged to Boyson. 2. John
Samson heard the noise of a man who was crying. 3. The woman who was seen at the window was the
ghost of Mary Boyson. 4. The strange moaning noise which had been heard by John Samson on the night
of the fire was Boyson's ghost crying. 5. The two figures who were wearing dark clothes were the ghosts
of Mary Boyson and Harold. 6. The old man who was standing at the door crying was the ghost of Mary's
father.
E. Make one sentence using a participle, without changing the meaning.
eg The ghosts appeared and disappeared. They left no trace. The ghosts appeared and disappeared,
leaving no trace.
1. The Samsons arrived in Borley. They knew nothing about I the ghosts. 2. Mr Samson ran out of the
burning house. He shouted
218
219

loudly. 3. Some neighbours came. They were carrying buckets. 4. The villagers gathered. They
watched the fire. 5. Three firemen arrived. They brought fire equipment. 6. A young woman was
standing at the window. She was knocking at the window. 7. An old man was standing in the door.
He was crying. 8. The Samsons moved to London. They left behind the ruined house.
Not a Cold Mine
Dreams of finding lost treasure came true recently. A new machine called "The Revealer" has been
invented and has been used to detect gold which has been buried in the ground. The machine was
used in a cave near the sea-shore where it is said pirates used to hide gold. The pirates would
often bury gold in the cave and then fail to collect it. Armed with the new machine, a search party
went into the cave hoping to find buried treasure. The leader of the party was examining the soil near
the entrance to the cave when the machine showed that there was gold under the ground. Very
excited, the party dug a hole two feet deep. They finally found a small gold coin which was almost
worthless. The party then searched the whole cave thoroughly but did not find anything except an
empty tin trunk. In spite of this many people are confident that "The Revealer" may reveal something
of value fairly soon.
A. Questions
1. Is "The Revealer" a new machine or an old machine? 2. What is it used for? 3. Where was this
machine used recently? 4. Did the search party find any gold? 5. Do many people believe that the
machine may reveal something of value soon or not?
B. Complete the sentences from the text
1. Dreams of finding... treasure almost came true recently. 2. A new machine... "The Revealer" has
been invented. 3.... with the new machine, a search party went into the cave ... to find ... treasure.
4. ... , the party dug a hole two feet deep.
C. Study and practise the text.
D. Complete using "used to" or "would" where possible.
220

When I was young I ... have a lot more free time than I do now. I... live near my work and ... always
get home early. I... do a bit of gardening or go for a long walk. Now I never have time for anything
like that.
A. Dangerous Place
Paula had always wanted to go to New York and now she had the chance at last. She was a journalist,
and her newspaper was sending her there to do a series of articles on the city. But before she left her
home in London, several friends warned her to be careful and not to go out alone at night in New
York. "It's a dangerous place. People get robbed or even killed in broad daylight!" they told her.
But when she got there, the only thing she was afraid of was exhaustion. It was such an exciting city
that she never got any sleep. It took her two weeks to do the articles and she had to interview a lot of
people but she enjoyed every minute of it. She completely forgot all her friends' warnings until the
day she went back to London. It all began in a bar.
She was having lunch there when she suddenly felt someone watching her. She looked up and
noticed a man sitting at a table opposite her. He was staring at her, but looked away. She noticed that
he had a scar on his cheek. He was about 30 and had short, curly hair. Paula was not worried at all.
She had to go to an airline office to re-book her flight home. She wanted an afternoon flight instead
of a morning one, as originally planned. On her way there, she stopped to look at something in a
shop-window. To her surprise she saw the man follow her. She could see his reflection in the glass.
He had stopped just behind her. Suddenly she felt afraid. She walked on. Then she stopped and
looked behind her again. But this time she could not see him. Just then she noticed she had come to
the airline office. She went in and after she had finished her business, decided to phone a friend from
a telephone booth there. She was carrying a small, portable but very expensive tape-recorder. It was
in a black case in which she kept her money and passport as well. But the booth was so small that she
had to leave the case outside. When she came out, it had disappeared. Then she saw the red-haired
man hurrying out of the office. He had the case in his hand. She shouted but it was too late.
221
A Questions
1. Why did Paula go to New York? 2. What did her friends warn her about before she left London? 3.
What made Paula forget her friends' warnings? 4. What did Paula notice while she was having lunch?

5. What surprised Paula? 6. Why did she have to go to the airline office? 7. What happened while
Paula was phoning her friend?
B. Complete the sentences from the text.
1. She was having lunch there when she suddenly felt someone... 3. She looked up and noticed a
man... 3. To her surprise, she saw the man... 4. Then she saw the red-haired man...
C. Study and practise the text.
D. Complete the sentences with the words in the list. Use both possible forms.
wal burn sing laugh call play ring shake snore win
k
1. It was a thrill to see my brother... the chess tournament last year. 2. Uncle Jake is in his bedroom
right now. I can hear him... 3. When I glanced out of the window I saw Jack ... toward my house. 4.
When I heard the principal of the school... my name at the graduation ceremony, I walked to the front
of the auditorium to receive my diploma. 5. Last night while I was trying to fall asleep, I could hear
the people in the next apartment... and...
6. When I walked past the park, I saw some children... baseball.
7. Polly was working in the garden, so she didn't hear the phone...
8. There was an earthquake in my hometown last year. It was just a small one, but I could feel the
ground... 9. Do you smell something...?
E. Complete the sentences by using an appropriate form of get and the past participles of the verbs in the
list.
break
hire
hurt lose pack worry tear
1.1 had a terrible day. First the heel of my shoe broke off, then my dress got torn in the elevator door.
I'm glad the day is over!
2. Oh! Look at that beautiful vase on the floor. How did it...?
3. A: You're late. What happened?
B: We... We took the wrong exit from the highway, and it took a long time to figure out where we
were.
4. A: I really need a job.
B: Why don't you apply for a job at the fast-food restaurant? They're looking for help. I'm sure
you'll...
5. A: Did Susan ... when she fell down the stairs?
: Not badly. Just a few bumps and bruises. She'll be fine.
6. A: You're here! I... about you. What happened that made
you so late. B: I couldn't start my car. The battery was dead.

Lucky !
Keiko: Hey, you look different. Did you get your hair cut? Sandra: Yeah. It's a little short, isn't it?
Keiko: No, I think it looks great! Where did you get it cut? Sandra: At Short Cuts on Third Street.
They usually do a nice
job and they're reasonable. Keiko: That's good to know. Speaking of reasonable, do you
know where there's a good shoe repair shop? I have
to get some shoes repaired.
Sandra: There's a little shoe repair shop on Fourth Street. Keiko: You mean the place next to the
bookstore? Sandra: Yeah, that's the one. I know they're good and they're
fast, but they might be a little expensive. Keiko: Well, if they are good, I guess they're worth it. Anyway, time to get back to work. Doing anything for
lunch? Sandra: Yeah. I've got a dentist's appointment. I've got to have
a tooth filled. Keiko: Lucky you! Sandra: Yeah, really! And my car isn't working today either.
Something's wrong with the brakes so I have to get
them fixed, too.
. Complete the sentences from the text. 1. Did you ... your hair...? 2. Where did you ... it...? 3.1 have
to ... some shoes ... 4. I've got to ... a tooth ... 5. ... so I have to ... them ... too.
B. Study and practise the conversation.
I'll help you.
(Mrs W=Mrs Williams; Mr W=Mr Williams)

Mrs W: Can you take me into town on Saturday morning, darling? I want to have my hair done. Mr W: Yes, I can. I've got to go there anyway. I'm going to
have my car serviced. Mrs W: Good. If we leave early, I can have my hair dyed. And
you can pick me up at the hairdresser's when the car
is ready. Mr W: All right. I'll have the car washed by the time. And
when we return home I'll paint the garage doors
maybe you could help me. Mrs W: We only had the garage repainted a few months ago;
surely it isn't necessary yet.
Mr W: I'm afraid so. The paint is peeling off already. Mrs W: All right. I'll help you.
A. Complete the sentences from the text
1 . 1 want... 2. I'm going... 3. 1 can... 4. I'll ... by the time. 5. We only ... a few months ago.
B. Study and practise the conversation.
C. What kinds of things can you have done at these places?
1 . shoe repair shop 2. barbershop (beauty saloon) 3. tailor's workshop 4. dry cleaner's 5. garage 6.
camera shop 7. optometrist 8. watch repair shop
Prompts
shoes/repaired hair/cut clothes/made trousers/pressed
pictures/developed brakes/fixed eyes/checked watch/repaired
224
On Christmas Eve
One afternoon just before Christmas an old gentleman was walking through the city centre. The gaily
illuminated shops were packed with good things and crowded with cheerful shoppers. Suddenly in
the middle of the crowd he noticed a dirty little boy sitting on the pavement, weeping bitterly. When
the kind old man asked him why he was crying, the little boy told him that he had lost a ten penny
coin that his uncle had given him. Thrusting his hand into his pocket, the old man pulled out a
handful of coins. He picked out a shiny, new ten penny coin and handed it to the child. "Thank you
very much," said the little boy, and, drying his eyes, he cheered up at once. An hour or so later the old
man was making his way back home by the same route. To his astonishment he saw the same dirty
little boy in precisely the same spot, crying just as bitterly as before. He went up to the boy and asked
him if he had lost the ten pence he had given him as well. The little boy told him that actually he had
not lost the second coin, but he still could not find his first ten pence. "If I could find my own ten
pence," he said tearfully, "I'd have twenty pence now."
A. Study and practise the text.
A Meeting in the Park.
Cliff and Celia met by chance one sunny morning. They were sitting side by side on a bench in the
park. She was reading, and he was just sitting in the sunshine, enjoying doing nothing. There was a
rather cross-looking elderly lady sitting on the other side of her. Cliff liked the look of Celia right
from the start. He tried hard to get into conversation with her, but she was not very encouraging.
"Isn't it a lovely day?" he said.
"It is, yes."
"Hardly a cloud in the sky."
"No."
"It's nice to have some decent weather for a change, isn't it?" Celia did not reply to this at all. She
turned over a page of her book, and went on reading.
"What are you reading?" Cliff was determined to keep the conversation going.
225

"Madame Bovary."
"What's it like?"
"They say it is rather good," Celia said, without looking up from her book.
"I don't know much about French literature," Cliff said.
Celia closed her book and stood up. "I don't either," she said. "That's why I'm trying to read some.
Well, good bye."
Cliff was sorry to see her go, but he could not think of a way of preventing her. He watched her
walking away across the grass. Suddenly he noticed a white cardigan lying on the bench beside him.
It must be hers. He picked it up and ran after her.

"You forgot this," he said, holding out the cardigan.


"You left it on the seat."
She looked at it in surprise. "It isn't mine," she said,
"What are you doing with my cardigan?" a furious voice behind them said.
Cliff turned. It was the cross-looking elderly lady. She looked even crosser now.
"I'm terribly sorry," he said. "I thought..."
"You'll end up in prison if you're not careful," the lady snapped.
"Running off with clothes that don't belong to you."
She snatched the cardigan and walked away, muttering to herself. Celia was smiling. "You looked
terribly guilty," she said.
"Have you got time for a cup of coffee?" Cliff said.
"I think so."
A. Questions
1. Where did Cliff and Celia meet? 2. Where were they sitting? 3. What was the weather like? 4.
Where was the elderly lady? 5. What did Cliff try hard to do? 6. Did he succeed? 7. How did Cliff
feel when he saw Celia go? 8. What did he do to stop her? 9. Why was Celia surprised? 10. Who did
the cardigan belong to? 11. Where did the elderly lady say Cliff might find himself? 12. How did the
story end?
B. Study and practise the text. Observe the use of the verbals.
C. Make up sentences using these models:
There is a man waiting outside.
There were fifteen people living in that house.
226

She was sitting in the park enjoying the fine weather.


They watched her crossing the road.
I heard him singing in the bath.
I saw him leave.
He stood smiling.
She sat reading.
He went away singing to himself.
Cliff saw a pretty girl sitting on a bench.
Smoking in bed is risky.
There was no way of avoiding the accident.
He stopped for a moment and then went on reading.
He left without saying good-bye.
He was determined to win.
We were surprised to find the door locked.
D. Note: We never use adverbial phrases of place after forget. We often use them after leave: She
forgot her book. She left it at home. He often forgets things. Yesterday he left his umbrella on the
bus.

UNIT 12 TOPIC: SPORTS


Listen, read and practise.
Sports and Pastimes
Athletic sports include running, boxing, rowing, jumping, diving, swimming, weightlifting, puttingthe-shot, skating, wrestling, etc. To become proficient in these sports one must practise constantly.
They are encouraged in schools, universities and clubs all over the world.
Other popular outdoor sports (field sports) are hunting, shooting, fishing, horse-racing, motor racing
and mountain climbing (mountaineering).
The most popular outdoor games are football, cricket, hockey and tennis. Indoor games include
billiards, card games, chess, draughts.
England is the home of sport. Many of the games now played all over the world originated in Britain.
We have a proverb, "All work and no play makes Jack a dull boy." We do not think that play is more
important than work; we think that Jack will do his work better if he plays as well, so he is
encouraged to do both. Most people in England are engaged in sedentary occupations; they would

feel that life was hardly worth living if they were unable in the evenings, or at the weekends, to
pursue their favourite sport.
What is a sportsman? He is one who is interested in sport. But that is only one meaning of the word.
Even if a person is not interested in any sport, and has no opportunity or inclination to play any
game, he may be called a sportsman if he has something called the "sporting spirit." This "sporting
spirit" is something that the playing of games develops in people, though a person may have it who
plays no games. It is the ability to endure hard knocks without getting angry or seeking revenge; the
ability to smile in times of danger and hardship, the ability to win without boasting afterwards, and to
lose without complaining. A sportsman forgets himself in his loyalty to his own side; he refuses to be
disheartened when the game is going against him; he goes on fighting when the battle seems already
lost.
228

Some people hate playing if there is no crowd to applaud them, some play only to win prizes, others
are unwilling to play against stronger opponents for fear of defeat. Such people are not sportsmen in
the best sense of the word, but if they go on playing they may become sportsmen in time. We should
all try to become "good losers," to accept our disappointments cheerfully. Everyone has
disappointments at some time or other; sportsmen smile when they occur and refuse to be
disheartened by them.
Fishing is practised by thousands of people of moderate means. Some of the fishing streams and
rivers are reserved, others are open to the public. It requires great skill and much practice to "land" a
heavy fish with a light rod. Fishing is a very quiet and peaceful occupation and is an excellent
pastime for those who dislike noise and crowds. Horse racing is practised in many countries of the
world. The horses are specially trained and are ridden by professional "jockeys."
The sport of mountain climbing appeals to many adventurous people. As there are few high
mountains in Britain, many people go to Switzerland, which is the centre of European mountaineering. Every year there are fatal accidents, but every year finds bold young men and women
arriving in Switzerland ready to risk their lives among the high mountain peaks. An expedition was
organized some years ago to India to climb Mount Everest, one of the highest mountains in the
world. After many weeks of travel a small party came within sight of the summit, and two young
men left the camp in a supreme effort to conquer the mountain. They were last seen fairly near the
top, going slowly, cutting holes in the ice for their feet. A storm came on and hid them from the view
of their friends, who because of intense cold and lack of food had to retire. The two men were never
seen again and nobody knows what happened to them. Everest was finally conquered in 1953 by a
British expedition, no trace of their bodies was found.
The most popular game in the world is certainly football. A team is composed of a goalkeeper, two
backs, three half-backs and five forwards. This is the game that is played in nearly all countries.
There is another game called rugby football, so called because it originated at Rugby, a well-known
English school. In this game the players may carry the ball. There is also an American kind of
football, different again from the other two. Hockey is fairly popular
229
in England and some other countries. Tennis, played with stringec1 rackets on a marked-out court, is an
international game.
A. Questions
1. What do athletic sports include? 2. What are popular outdoor sports? 3. What are popular outdoor and
indoor games? 4. Are English people fond of sports? 5. What does one of the English proverbs say? 6.
What is the "sporting spirit"? 7. Who can be called a sportsman in the best sense of the word? 8. Are
fishing and horse-racing popular pastimes? 9. What sport appeals to many adventurous people? 10. How
was Everest conquered? 11. What is the most popular game in the world?
B. Study and practise the text.
C. Special Difficulties
I. Use one instead of you.
Note: We can use "one" instead of "you" to mean people in general, including you and me.
eg You can easily lose your way in Rome. = One can easily lose one's way in Rome.
"You" is informal, "one" is more formal.
The moment you get into the mountains, you are on your own. You have to rely on yourself for

everything. This means you have to carry all your own food, though, of course, you can get pure drinking
water from mountain streams. You won't see any local people for days at a time, so you can't get help if
you are lost. You have to do your best to find sheltered places to spend the night.
II. Complete according to the model.
eg To be fit...
To be fit one (you) must go in for sports.
1. To win the first prize... 2. To become a student... 3. To be healthy... 4. To master a foreign language... 5.
To achieve this result... 6. To break the world record...
230

III. Put the verbs in brackets into the present simple passive, the past simple passive, the present perfect
passive or the future passive.
Do you know how often the Olympic Games (hold)? They (hold) every four years. The first Olympic
Games (hold) at Olympia, in ancient Greece, nearly 3,000 years ago. The tradition (continue) from 776
BC to AD 393. Even wars (postpone), so that everyone could travel safely to the Games. The Games
(ban) in 394.
In 1890 the modern Games (found) by a Frenchman called Baron de Coubertin in Athens.
Originally, the Games (set up) for amateurs. Amateurs are people who (not pay) to play the sport whereas
professionals (pay). Since 1984 some professional athletes, such as football players, (allow) to take part.
Before the Games begin, the Olympic torch (light) at Olympus by a mirror reflecting the sun. Then it
(carry) by runners to the city where the Games (hold). Sometimes by the time the last runner enters the
stadium, the torch (carry) half-way round the world. Do you know where the next Olympic Games
(hold)?
Note: AD anno Domini . BC Before Christ
IV. Complete the sentences with by or with.
1. These photos were taken ... a very cheap camera. 2. These photos were taken... my sister. 3. My desk
was covered... paper. 4. The garage was painted... a friend of mine. 5. The garage was painted... anew
kind of paint. 6. The cake was made... dried fruit. 7. The cake was made ... my aunt.
V. Now you have to make sentences with hardly. Use the words in brackets.
eg George and I have only met once, (know/each other) We hardly know each other.
1. I'm very tired this morning, (slept/last night)I... night. 2. You're speaking very quietly, (can/hear) I can
... you. 3. I met Keith a few days ago. I hadn't seen him for a long time. He looks very different now.
(recognized) I... 4. They were really shocked when they heard the news, (could/speak). They...
231
VI. Choose the right word in each sentence.
1. Farm workers have to work very... during the harvest, (hard/ hardly)
2. Farm workers earn... enough money to pay their bills, (hard/ hardly)
3.1 tried... to remember his name but I couldn't, (hard/hardly) 4.1 enjoyed driving this morning. There
was ... any traffic.
(hard/hardly) 5.1 hate this town. There's... anything to do and... anywhere
to go. (hard/hardly) 6. ... anyone passed, (hard/hardly)
VII. Change the adjective clauses to adjective phrases.
1. Only a few of the movies that are shown at the Gray Theatre are suitable for children. Only a few of the
movies shown at the Gray Theatre are suitable for children.
2. Jasmine, which is a viny plant with white flowers, grows only in warm places. Jasmine, a viny plant
with white flowers, grows only in warm places.
3. The couple who live in the house next door are both college professors.The couple living in the house
next door are both college professors.
4. A throne is the chair which is occupied by a queen, king, or other rules. 5. We visited Belgrade, which
is the capital of "Yugoslavia 6. Antarctica is covered by a huge cap that contains 70 percent of the earth's
fresh water. 7. Astronomy, which is the study of planets and stars, is one of the world's oldest sciences. 8.
Two out of three people who are struck by lightning survive. 9. Simon Bolivar, who was a great South
American general, led the fight for independence in the early 19th century. 10. hi hot weather, many
people enjoy lemonade, which is a drink that is made of lemon juice, water, and sugar. 11.1 was
awakened by the sound of laughter which came from the room which was next door to mine at the motel.
12. Two-thirds of those who are arrested for car theft are under twenty years of age. 13. When we walked
past the theatre, there were a lot of people who were waiting in a long line outside the box office. 14. The
opinions that were (are) expressed by the critics greatly differ. 15. At the national park, there is a path that

leads to a spectacular waterfall. 16. My favourite place in the world is a small city that is located on the
southern coast of
232

Brazil. 17. The sunlight which is coming through the window wakes me up early every morning.
VIII. Make sentences with either in spite of or because of, like this.
eg They went out. The weather was bad.
In spite of the bad weather, they went out. eg They didn't go out. The weather was bad.
They didn't go out because of the bad weather.
1. His work was good. He didn't get a promotion. 2. His work was good. He got a promotion. 3.
Everybody admires hum. He has talent. 4. Nobody admires him. He has talent. 5. The \veather was
wonderful. She stayed inside. 6. The price w^s low. Everybody bought it. 7. The price was low. Nobody
bought it.
IX. You like your job. You are telling someone this. You say things like: "I like my job because of... " or "I
like my job in spite of "
1. The hours are long. 2. The people are pleasant. 3. "Jne pay is low. 4. The work is interesting.
Think of more things you might say!
X. Transform using gerunds.
eg She left. She did not pay. She left without paying.
1. She came in. She did not knock. 2. He walked five miles. He did not stop. 3. He spoke for ten minutes.
He did not p^use. 4.1 lay for five hours. I did not go to sleep. 5. He left. FJe didn't answer my questions.
Sport in Britain
The British are a sporting nation. Like everyone else they love football in fact, they invented it. Most
British towns and cities have a-football team. Every year, each team plays in the Football Association
competition. The two best teams play in the Cup final at \Vembley Stadium in London. Some fans pay up
to 250 for a ticket for the Cup Final. It is one of the biggest sporting events of the y^ar.
Tennis is another popular game in Britain. Every su^nmer June, the biggest international tennis
tournament takes place at
233

Wimbledon, a suburb of London. There are strawberries and cream for sale, and everyone hopes the
rain will stay away.
The British play many sports that are unknown in most other countries, for example: cricket, squash
and netball.
Cricket is a typically British sport which foreigners have difficulty in understanding. The game looks
slow, but it can be exciting if you understand what's going on. There are two teams of eleven players:
one man (the "bowler") throws the ball, and the "batsman" hits it with his bat.
Cricket is a very long game. Matches last from one to five days. Squash is another British invention.
It is a form of tennis. There are two players and they use rackets similar to tennis rackets and a small,
black rubber ball. They play indoors. It is a very fast and tiring sport!
Netball is similar to basketball. There are seven players (usually girls or women) in each team and
the object of the game is the same as in basketball: to throw the ball through a net at the top of a
three-metre post.
Swimming is very popular in Britain and there are many public swimming baths.
Many British people who live near the sea, a lake or a river enjoy sailing. If you are really
enthusiastic, and rich enough to buy your own boat, you can take part in one of the annual sailing
races or "regattas" at Cowes, near Portsmouth, for example, or at Henley on the river Thames.
Golf is becoming increasingly popular. Athletics is growing all the time.
Winter sports such as skiing are generally impossible in Britain (except in Scotland) owing to the
unsuitable climate, but more and more people spend winter holidays on the Continent in order to take
part in them.
Sport in British schools is compulsory and schoolchildren spend at least one afternoon a week
playing sport. These are some of the sports played in most British secondary schools. In winter boys
play football (or "soccer" as it is colloquially called) or rugby* and go cross-country running, while
girls play netball or hockey. Some boys' schools also teach rowing. In summer boys play cricket, do
athletics or go swimming, while girls play rounders (a British version of baseball), do athletics or go
swimming. Tennis is also played in summer in some schools by boys and girls.
234

* Note:
football (coll. soccer) a game in which there are eleven players on each side, using a round ball
which must not be touched with the hands.
rugby (coll. rugger) a form of football in which the players use their hands for carrying the ball
The game is played with fifteen men on each side, and an oval-shaped ball is used.
A. Questions
1. What are the most popular sports in Britain? 2. Why is skiing not popular? 3. What are some of the
sports played in most British secondary schools?
Sport in the USA
Baseball is the most popular summer sport in America. The first American baseball match was in
1839 in New York, but some people think that baseball comes from a much older game called
rounders, played in Europe for many years.
To play baseball, you need two teams of nine players. The "pitcher" throws the ball, and the "batter"
hits it with a bat.
Americans start playing baseball young. There are "leagues" which children of eight can join. The
top players become big stars and earn a lot of money every year.
Americans play tennis, hockey and most other international sports, but they do not play football in
the same way as the rest of the world. American football is a very different game. The players can
run with the ball, touch and push each other. The field looks different, and even the ball is a different
shape. Players wear special clothes for American football, with helmets on their heads, because the
game can be dangerous. Like international football teams, American teams have eleven players.
Basketball is another popular game in America. Only five people play in each team. One American
basketball team, the Harlem Globetrotters, are famous all over the world. These extraordinary
sportsmen, all very tall, have shown the world that sport can be funny as well as exciting.
Americans love winter sports, and ice hockey is a great favourite. This game, the national sport of
Canada, is very fast,
235

and can be dangerous. So if you play ice hockey, remember to wear your helmet!
A. Ask and answer questions on the text. Speak about sport in the USA.
B. What sports are popular in your country? Is sport compulsory in schools? What sports do children
play?
C. Describe the sport activities at your school (university).
Sport Facilities and Athletics
There is a big sports centre near my home. There are football pitches, tennis and basketball courts,
swimming pools, a sports hall with two boxing rings and even a skating rink. There is also a separate
athletics stadium, where 20.000 spectators can watch the track events on the track and the field
events, such as jumping and throwing, in the grass centre. The athletes get ready in modern changing
rooms and the officials time and measure the events with modern equipment. A huge electronic
Scoreboard shows the results.
A. Study and practise the text.
B. Describe any sports centre you visited.
C. Speak about sport in your life.

My Favourite Sport
I love many sports, but best of all skiing. I first skied when I was six years old, and lived in
Canada, and then for many years, in fact decades, I wasn't able to ski again because I was living in
hot places. But since I've been living in England, I've resumed skiing and it's even better than it was.
For me now the place to ski is the Alps, and particularly France. I live in England and the winters are
gloomy, and there's not much sun, so one of the wonderful things about skiing for me is the light and
the brilliant sunshine that you find high, high up in the mountains. A lot of other people like it, too,
and it can be rather crowded, especially around the lifts because you now have mechanical lifts that
take you zooming up, flying up the mountains like a god, whereas in Canada I had to walk up if I
wanted to ski down.
" 236
The equipment you need... skis, and boots, and poles. Many people own their own equipment but I

hire mine in the resort. I do have my own clothes though, and clothes are very important because
skiing is quite a fashion-conscious sport. Also, it's necessary to have clothes that will protect you
because the weather can be very severe. You need a ski-suit, a hat, goggles to protect your eyes,
socks, mittens, and a rucksack is useful to carry around your bits and pieces. Now at this point, I
have to confess that I am not the world's greatest skier. I would say I am a respectable skier, I'm a
safe skier, but that doesn't stop you having a wonderful time. Also, there is the social life that is such
an important part of skiing. You can eat and drink as much as you want because you know you're
burning it all off. And then at the end of the day there's the evening, food and wine with friends and
everybody talking about their excitements during the day. I love it!
A. Study and practise the text.
B. Speak about your favourite sport.
Sports at the Olympics
The first modern Olympic games were held in Athens in 1896. There were nine sports: cycling,
tennis, gymnastics, swimming, track and field, weightlifting, rowing, wrestling and shooting. Sailing
was also to have taken place, but had to be cancelled because of bad weather at sea. At that time, as
today, most people were interested in the track and field events in the main stadium.
In the first Olympics there were no real team sports. Then, slowly, a few team sports joined the
program. Soccer and field hockey were the first team sports introduced into the Olympics in London
in 1908. Then in 1936, at the Berlin Olympics, the Germans brought in handball and the Americans
had basketball accepted as an Olympic sport.
It often happens that the country that introduces a new sport into the Olympics then goes on to win
the gold medals. In 1904, at the Olympics in St. Louis, the Americans introduced boxing and won all
seven events. Five horseback-riding events were introduced into the 1912 Stockholm Olympics, and
Swedish riders won four of them. And in 1964, at the Tokyo Olympics, two sports which are very
popular in Japan were introduced: judo and
237

volleyball. The Japanese won all three gold medals in judo, and also won the first women's volleyball
competition.
Some new sports have recently been added to the Olympics. In Los Angeles, in 1984, baseball was
introduced and windsurfing became an Olympic sport. In Seoul, Korea, in 1968, there was table
tennis for the first time, and tennis returned as an Olympic sport. Unlike tennis, some sports, such as
golf and rugby, have been tried in the Olympics but have never returned.
The Olympic games continue to get bigger and bigger. They also get more and more expensive. Now
many people are asking the questions: Are the Olympics too big? Will the Olympics continue?
Should the Olympics continue?
A Ask and answer questions on the text. Speak about sports at the Olympics.
B. 1. Which sports are you best at? How good are you? How long have you been playing? How often
do you play?
2. Do you support a particular team? Which one? How often do you go to a sports event?, or do you
prefer to watch sports on television?
3. Think of your favourite sport.
4. Which sports do you think are the most dangerous?
5. Do you think the Olympics should continue?
6. Did you watch the last Olympics on TV? Who showed the best results at the Olympic games? Do
you know where the next Olympic games will be held?

Football
I play football for my local team against other sides in the area. Of course the players aren't paid,
we're just amateurs. But anyway we train very hard in the evenings and we're lucky because we can
use the gymnasium of a local school. On the day of the match we arrive early, change and put on
track suits to keep warm. Then the referee, dressed in black, calls the two captains to the centre to
toss a coin to decide who will play in which direction. Not many people come to watch the game. We
usually have a crowd of only one or two hundred. But we enjoy it, whether we win, lose or draw.
A. Study and practise the text.
238

Match
Last Saturday afternoon David Brown and his father went to a football match at the Bishopton
Football Ground. The Browns and many other Bishopton people think that theirs is the best team in
the South of England. There were fifteen thousand people there. They came from far and near
because it was the most important match of the year at Bishopton.
At three o'clock the two teams came on to the field. The Bishopton team (the home team) were
playing in blue and white shirts, the Easthampton City players (the visiting team) were in red and
white shirts.
The referee blew his whistle and the match began. For the first twenty minutes the Bishopton team
were stronger and kept the ball in the Easthampton side of the field. Then, suddenly, an Easthampton
player took the ball up the field and scored the first goal. The crowd shouted loudly. Soon after this,
the referee blew the whistle because it was "half-time".
In the second half of the match the Bishopton team were again the better players. They tried hard,
and after ten minutes they scored their first goal. They scored again after a quarter of an hour; then,
before the last whistle blew, they scored a third goal and so won the match. All the Bishopton people
in the crowd were very pleased, and went home happily to tea.
A. Ask and answer questions on the text. Speak about the football match at the Bishopton Football
Ground.
B. Are you a football fan? Which team do you support? Are they in good shape this season? What
are their chances of winning the cup this year? What was the last football match you saw like?

Conversation Practice Listen, read and practise.


A Champion's Memories
Jane is visiting the home of her new friend, Barbara. She sees something interesting in the living room.
239

Jane:
Oh, what a beautiful statue!
Barbara: Thank you. It's a trophy I won years ago for running.
Jane:
You must have been a good runner.
Barbara: Yes, I was, if I do say so myself. I was champion in the half-mile at the Oregon State Track
Meet for two years.
Jane:
Did you ever lose a race?
Barbara: I lost once or twice. But I usually beat my opponents.
Jane:
It must have felt great to win.
Barbara: You're right about that. Victory is always a good feeling.
Jane:
Do you still run?
Barbara: No, I haven't since I hurt my knee five years ago, but I still keep my old uniform hanging in
the closet. Maybe you'd like to see it.
A. Study and practise the conversation.
B. Did you ever take part in any competitions? Did you ever win?
My favourite game
(I = Interviewer; M = Martin)
I: So Martin, what sports do you play?
M: I play football, volleyball, tennis, and table tennis but volleyball is my favourite game as it's a
team game and you can play it with your friends, and enjoy it as a team.
I: Is it quite a fast game as well?
M: Yeah. It is a fast game and that's another reason why I enjoy it.
I: How exciting...
M: Yes.
I: Where do you play, then?
M: I play at local sports centres more during the winter and sort of play in tournaments around
England. I also, in the summer, play beach volleyball.
I: Is beach volleyball different from the volleyball you play in the centres?
M: Yes, it's a very different game. Instead of six players on a
team, it's only two players.
I: You mentioned you played in tournaments now do you do quite well in the tournaments?
M: Yes, I've played for South West England and we've got through to the semifinals of different

England tournaments, and for Wessex, my other volleyball team, we've actually won a few
tournaments. So yes, I have done quite well.
I: Oh well done! What sort of equipment do you need?
M: Well, first of all you need the ball and the net, and obviously the court... but you may also need
knee pads and your volleyball kit.
I: OK... knee pads because you fall on your knees a lot?
M: Yes... when diving and things like that.
I: Diving?
M: Diving... yeah.
I: It sounds like swimming, that means jumping to catch the ball?
M: Yeah, jumping to get a ball up in the air.
I: Yes, all right. So how often do you play volleyball then Martin?
M: Well during the season, which is about September to June, I play twice a week. One of those is
training, and one of those is a match. And during the summer I play beach volleyball, but that's only
once a week.
A. Ask and answer questions on the text.
B. Speak about Martin's favourite sport.
C. Situation- You and your friend are speaking about your favourite sports and pastimes.
I exercise every day (I = Interviewer; H = Henry)
I: Henry, you do a lot of sports?
H: Yes, I exercise every day.
I: How many sports do you do?
H: Five.
I: And what are they?
H: Swimming, tennis, cycling, yoga and jogging.
240
241

I: Why do you like swimming?


H: Because it's good for the back and it's fun.
I: And cycling? What's cycling good for?
H: The legs. I like it because it's not expensive and I think it's relaxing.
I: You also do yoga.
H: Yes, that's right. Yoga's good for many things, but very good for breathing. It's very good for the
heart, too.
I: And tennis?
H: Yes, I like tennis very much. Tennis is fun, and sometimes it's very exciting. It's very good for the
arms and legs. I like it a lot.
I: When do you go to work?
H: Oh, I work as well, but I have time in the evenings and...
A. Study and practise the conversation.
B. Talk about the sports you like.
C. Talk about the most important sports event at your university or town during the last winter
(summer).
A report from the Olympic Village
Karen Finch in the programme "Sportsworld" with her report from the Olympic village.
Karen: Well, I have two athletes with me in the studio. First
Bo Lundquist. Bo: Hey! Karen: Bo is a cyclist and he's here with the Swedish team.
This is your first Olympics, isn't it, Bo? Bo: Yes, it is.
Karen: And how do you feel about it? Bo: Happy, very happy. Karen: Let's talk about your
training schedule, Bo. I imagine
it's pretty hard.
Bo: Yes, it is. I get up at five... Karen: Five! And do you start training then? Bo: Well, I have a
cup of coffee first. I start training at
about five thirty. You know, it's quite cold then. Karen: Right! I'm sure it is. When do you finish
training, Bo?

Bo: Well, I practise cycling on the track for about two hours. Then I have a short break for breakfast.
After that, I do exercises for another few hours. I suppose I finish at about midday.
Karen: So you're free after twelve. What do you do then?
Bo: You mean, what do I do in my spare time?
Karen: Right.
Bo: Well, we usually go swimming down at the beach in Malibi for the afternoon. That's all. I go to
bed early. I want to win a gold for Sweden.
Karen: Well, I hope you do. Thank you, Bo Lundquist. Next with me in the studio is a British girl.
She's a member of the swimming team. European champion in free style Anne Cole. Hello, Anne.
Anne: Hello.
Karen: Anne, you heard Bo Lundquist talking about his training programme. Tell me about yours.
For example, do you get up so early?
Anne: Well, not quite so early. I get up about six forty-five.
Karen: Do you start your training straightaway, Anne?
Anne: No, not exactly. I have a very light breakfast at seven and try to get to the pool by half past.
Karen: I see. How long do you train for?
Anne: All day.
Karen: You mean you swim all day?
Anne: (laughs) Oh, no! I swim for about four hours have lunch and then do track work and body
strengthening-exercises in the afternoon. I suppose I train until four o'clock in the afternoon.
Karen: That's a long day.
Anne: It's all right.
Karen: What about your free time? What do you do?
Anne: Well, I like to relax when I'm training, so I read a lot and watch a lot of television I like
American TV. I sometimes go dancing at the Olympic Club.
Karen: Dancing?
Anne: Yes, but I go to bed on most nights.
Karen: Thank you, Anne, and good luck to you.
This is Karen Finch at the Olympic Village in Los Angeles.
242
243

A. Ask and answer questions about Bo's and Anne's training schedules.
B. Speak about
i) Bo Lundquist and his training schedule, ii) Anne Cole and her training schedule.
C. Situation: You are interviewing a famous sportsman.
D. Who is your favourite sportsman? What do your know about him/her?
Football

Parti
This afternoon I'm taking my cousin and my uncle to a football match. Simon's never seen a
professional game. Uncle Guy hasn't seen one for years. Today's match is between Arsenal and
Liverpool. Both of these teams are very good this season. They are often one of the best in the first
division. I often go to football matches. I usually go to Highbury to see Arsenal. Their games are
always good. I sometimes go to see Chelsea. Some of their games are good, others are bad. Rugby's
another exciting sport, but I don't usually go to rugby games. The best sport's football.
Part II. The teams
Tim: Look, Simon. The teams are coming onto the field. Have
you ever seen Arsenal? Simon: No, I haven't.
Tim: What about Jane? Has she ever seen a football match? Simon: No, she has never seen one.
She doesn't like football.
Have your parents ever seen a professional game? Tim: No, they haven't seen any professional
games. Simon: Which ones are Arsenal? Tim: They are in red and white. Simon: Who's kicking
off? Tim: Liverpool.
Simon: Are both teams good this season? Tim. Yes.
244

Simon: Which one's better?

Tim: Liverpool are usually better than Arsenal but this year
Arsenal are the best in the division. Simon: Do they ever lose? Tim: Oh, yes. They sometimes lose
but they usually win.
They don't often have a bad day. Simon: Which team do you support? Tim: I've always supported
Arsenal. Simon: Me too. Dad's never liked Arsenal.
A goal
Tim:
Liverpool haven't scored yet... what's wrong?
Mr Hunt: I'm not worried yet. They've only been on the field for half an hour. This is only the first
half.
Tim: Look, there's Moore. He's running up the wing. He's good.
Mr Hunt: No, he isn't; he's bad. He's worse than the other winger.
Tim: He's already scored one goal for Arsenal. Oh look! He's near the penalty area. And there's
Blaire. He's Liverpool's worst defender. He's tackling Moore.
Mr Hunt: That's not Blaire; that's Blake. He's Liverpool's best player.
Tim: Collin's better than Blake. Look! Moore is in the penalty area now. He usually scores... Yes,
look at that... a goal!
Mr Hunt: What's the score now?
Tim:
Arsenal two: Liverpool nil. What a game!
The end of the game
Simon: Who is winning now?
Tim: Arsenal are, three: nil. They've scored another goal.
Simon: Is this the last fifteen minutes?
Tim:
Yes, it is.
Simon: Good. Liverpool can't score four goals in a quarter of
an hour. Mr Hunt: Yes, they can. Look! There's a man running up the
left wing. Now he's got the ball. Simon: Yes, that's Hedge. He plays for Liverpool. He al245

ways scores. Mr Hunt: Yes, you are right. Pass it, Hedge. No, he's trying
for a goal.
Shoot! Shoot! A goal! Simon: No, it isn't. Mr Hunt: Yes it is. What a goal! Simon: And that's the
end of the game. Arsenal have won
again three: nil.
L1 Fans
Ted: What did you think of the game, Bill?
Bill: Dreadful! It was neither exciting nor skilful.
Ted: I agree with you. Of course the weather didn't help. They'd hardly kicked off when it started to
pelt with rain. Our team are useless in the mud, and they were off form anyway.
Bill: Some of our team can't play football in either wet or dry conditions, and I've never seen them in
form. I can't help laughing when I watch old Ford. Every time he gets the ball he either falls over or
passes it to the opposition. I can't make out why they pick him.
Ted: He's too old really. He'd already been playing in the team for about ten years when I became a
supporter and that was eight years ago.
Bill: Evans isn't much better. He's not only too slow, he's scared to tackle as well.
Ted: Yes, he's always afraid of getting injured. Neither Ford nor Evans is up to it. We need two new
defenders and a new forward too.
Bill: But the management is too mean to spend money either
on new players or on improving the ground. Ted: Yes, that's true. The pitch is a disgrace. It isn't flat
and the drains don't work. Every time it rains the pitch is covered with great puddles of water.
Bill: What we need, Ted, is not only new players but a new manager and a new pitch as well. Then
perhaps we could win promotion to the Third division.
A. Ask and answer questions on the text.
246

B. Give a brief account of the text.


C. Situation: You and your friend have just been at the stadium. At the moment you are discussing
the game and the chances of your favourite team.

D. Join these sentences using the words in brackets.


eg Fred doesn't like lemonade. Bill doesn't like lemonade, (neither... nor) Neither Fred nor Bill likes
lemonade.
1. It's very expensive. It's very poor quality, (not only... but as well) 2. He doesn't drink a lot. He
doesn't eat a lot. (neither nor) 3. They would like fruit. They would like ice-cream, (both ... and) 4.
John will give you the book. John will lend you the book, (either... or) 5. She doesn't eat bread. She
doesn't eat potatoes, (neither ... nor) 6. John will help you. Mary will help you. (either ... or) 7. They
understand Chinese. They speak Chinese, (both... and) 8.1 don't know Peter. I don't know John,
(either... or)
C. Speak on your favourite football team.
Listening At last they've won
It was the football match of the year. Bill's team had to win to become the champions. Some people
had queued all night to see the game, much to the surprise of the stadium staff when they arrived in
the morning. Bill was a bit late because of the traffic and arrived about five minutes after the match
had begun. He found his reserved seat, sat down and looked at the electronic Scoreboard. His team
had scored and were leading 1:0. Then, as Bill made himself comfortable, the other team scored. Bill
groaned. Nothing much happened for the next 25 minutes. Bill took out his pipe. Suddenly his team
scored again. Bill jumped up and cheered. He sat down and lit a match but the front of his pipe had
vanished. He had bitten it in half in his excitement. The score remained 2:1 until the end of the game.
As soon as the final whistle blew, thousands of supporters ran onto the pitch. "At last
247

they've won," Bill said to the man next to him. "And they've been playing good football for years
without winning anything."
A. Questions
I. Why was the match so important for Bill's team? 2. Were there many football fans at the stadium?
3. Why was Bill late? 4. What was the score when Bill arrived? 5. What happened when Bill arrived?
6. What did Bill do in his excitement? 7. What was the final score?
B. Write about a football match that impressed you greatly.
We May Get Wet
The telephone rang down in the hall. Ann thought it might be Jack.
She ran down and answered the phone. Jack told her they were going to a football match. She said
nothing and suddenly put down the receiver. She got angry. She wanted to go somewhere nice: what
girl would want to watch football? Jack ought to know better. But then she felt sorry for Jack he
was trying to be kind.
At that moment the bell rang and she ran back to the telephone. "I think we were cut off," said Jack
and she felt very grateful to him. "But do put on proper clothes, because it will very likely rain." She
agreed. But when she dressed she decided not to put on her heavy shoes and thick clothes. She
wanted to look especially nice to please Jack.
When he saw her he didn't seem to notice how nice she was looking. All he said was, "Do you call
that proper clothes?"
They were going to the match by boat. Soon it began to rain. "I'm getting wet," Ann said. "Here you
are. You must wear this," Jack said putting his raincoat round Ann's shoulders. "Certainly not!" she
said and gave the coat back to him.
By the time they got to the football ground Ann was wet through. She was so unhappy that she hardly
saw the match at all. She didn't even know who was playing. At half-time Jack saw she was not
enjoying it, so he took her home. "I've learnt my lesson. You ought never to take a girl to a football
match," Jack thought on his way back.
A. Questions
1. Why did Ann get angry with Jack? 2. Why was she grateful to Jack? 3. What did Jack warn her about?
4. Did Ann follow his advice? 5. What happened some time later? 6. Why was Arm unhappy? 7. What
dicj Jack have to do? 8. What lesson had Jack leamt?

Reading
English Games: Squash
Squash is another of those peculiarly English ball games. It was once confined to Britain and her colonies
and played almost exclusively by members of the upper classes, but it must now be one of the world's

fastest-growing sports, for the number of participants has increased three or fourfold in the last few years,
and new courts are Springing up in almost every comer of the world.
The court consists of a square room in which two players, equipped with rackets similar in shape to tennis
rackets, have to strike a small rubber ball. When a player strikes the ball, it may rebound from any of the
four walls, but it must strike the front wall of the room before it touches the ground. His opponent then
has to hit the ball in his turn. The ball must not bounce on the floor more than once before each player hits
it; if a player fails to return the ball to the front wall or to hit the ball before it bounces twice, he loses the
point.
One advantage of the game is that, since the court is covered, you don't have to rely On the weather.
Moreover you needn't be a great athlete and it isn't necessary to possess exceptional coordination to play
the game competently. At top levels players have to be extremely fit and talented, but the average person
can get good exercise and enjoy himself thoroughly even at his first attempt.
A. Speak about sports and games in your country.
B. Speak about sports in Great Britain.
C. Sum up the specific vocabulary on the topic "Sports and Pastimes. " Name a) the nouns b) the verbs c)
the expressions.
248
249

Tke Perfect Pair Jayne Torvill and Christopher Dean, Champions of ice dancing
The place:
The Olympic ice rink in Helsinki
The event:
World Ice Dance
Championship:
(free dance section)
The people:
Jayne Torvill and Christopher Dean
The crowd stands and shouts with excitement. Flowers fall like showers of rain onto the ice. The
young couple hug and kiss each other as they wait for the judges' marks. And suddenly, there
they are!
What an incredible resultnine marks of 6.0! The maximum
score!
"Unbelievably brilliant!" writes one journalist. "Who can beat them now? They are not just the best,
they are the best ever!"
Where did it all start? Once upon a time Jayne Torvill was a clerk in an insurance office in
Nottingham. Christopher Dean was a trainee policeman. Jayne started skating when she was nine. At
twelve she was the British Junior Pairs champion.
Ice skaters who take their sport seriously must give up their whole lives to their training. They start
practising early, sometimes before 6 o'clock in the morning, and often do not stop until the early
hours of the following morning.
When Jayne and Christopher were young, they didn't do any of the things that ordinary teenagers do.
They didn't go to parties or discos. They didn't even have friends or hobbies outside the world of
skating. "You have to practise all the time," says Jayne
simply.
The families of the young skaters didn't have enough money for the expenses of ice dancing
competitions. Travel, hotel bills, training costumes and skates all amount to a lot of money.
As amateur skaters, Jayne and Christopher could not earn the large sponsorship fees from big
companies, but they desperately wanted to take part in major championships.
To their surprise, Jayne and Christopher received a grant of 14,000 from Nottingham City Council.
With that money they were able to stop work and give their lives to skating. They began to win
medal after medal.
250
Everyone agrees that Jayne and Christopher are two nice people. They are quiet, shy, polite and not
at all spoilt by their success. "Our aim in life is not to own a house and a car and to bring up children.
It is to do something different, to achieve something special."
The crowd of 4,000 who stood and cheered at Helsinki, and the millions of people who watched on
TV think that this is what Jayne and Christopher have already done.
A. Are you fond of figure skating? Who are your favourite figure-skaters? What do you know about
them?

Self check
I. Fill in the blanks with articles if necessary.
In 1988, at (1) age of nineteen, Steffi Graf could finally say, "I am (2) best woman tennis player in
(3) world." In that year she won all (4) Grand tournaments : (5) French Open, Wimbledon, (6) US
Open and Australian Open.
Steffi started young. When she was only four years old her father, Peter, gave her (7) small tennis
racket. They played together in (8) living room, and they used (9) sofa as (10) net. If Steffi could hit
(11) ball back ten times, she got (12) bread stick. If she hit it back twenty-five times, she got (13)
strawberries and (14) ice-cream!
Steffi started winning (15) competitions when she was six. At (16) age often she could play very
well, and her father gave up his job and became her tennis teacher.
Today Steffi is (17) brilliant and confident player (18) true champion, but she still enjoys being at
home with her family, with her mother, Heidi, her brother, Michael (who is two years younger than
she is) and of course, her father, Peter. She also has two dogs, Max and Ben.
When she isn't playing (19) tennis, Steffi likes (20) shopping, (21) playing (22) cards and listening to
(23) music. She can't drive yet but she's already got three cars. She won them as (24) prizes in (25)
competitions. Steffi travels a lot and she speaks very good English.
II. Translate from Russian into English.
251
1. , . .
, .
, , . 2.

. 3. . . 4.
. . 5. . 6.
. 7. .
, . 8.
? , . 9. , , . -
, . 10.
? .
. . 11. .
"" "". ,
"", "". .
.
"". .
.
. 2:1. ,
.

UNIT 13
GRAMMAR: OBJECT CLAUSES. REPORTED SPEECH (REVIEW)
Object clauses
Some verbs are followed by object clauses. An object clause answers the question: What?
I know that he speaks French, (know what?): that he speaks
French is an object clause.
He told me that he had succeeded, (told me about what?):
that he had succeeded is an object clause.
I don't know where he lives, (don't know what?): where he
lives is an object clause.
Object clauses can begin:
a) with a question word
I know where he lives.
b) with if or whether
I don't know whether (if) he is married.

c) with that
I know that the world is round.
Object clauses which begin with a question word
Question
Where does she live? What did he say? When do they arrive?
Object clause
(a) I don't know where she lives.
(b) I couldn't hear what he said.
(c) Do you know when they arrive?
In (a): where she lives is the object of the verb know. Do not use question order in an object clause. In
an object clause, the subject precedes the verb.
Notice: does, did anddo are used in questions but not in object clauses.
253
Question S

V
Who lives there? What happened? Who is at the door?
Object clause
S V
(d) I don't know who lives there.
(e) Please tell me what happened.
(f) I wonder who is at the door.
In (d) the word order is the same in both the question and the object clause because who is the subject
in both.
Question
Object clause
Who is she?
(g) I don't know who she is.
Who are those men?
(h) I don't know who those men are.
Whose house is that? (i) I wonder whose house that is.
In (g):she is the subject of the question, so it is placed in front of the verb be in the object clause.
Object clauses which begin with a question word often come after
a) I'd like to know... I don't know... I'm not sure... I don't understand... I've no idea... I don't
remember... I wonder... He said/asked... etc.
I've no idea where she lives. I wonder why she is absent.
b) Do you know...? Do you understand...? Do you remember...? Could you tell me...? Will you ask
him...? Has he told you...? Did she ask you...? etc.
Do you know what this word means? Could you tell me what time it is?
c) (Please) tell me... (please) ask her...
Please tell me where she lives. Ask her why she doesn't come.
I. Complete the sentences by changing the questions to object clauses.
eg Where did Paul go? I don't know where Paul went.
1. (How old is he?) I don't know... 2. (What was he talking about?) I wonder... 3. (Where do you
live?) Please tell me... 4. (What
254

did he say?) I'd like to know... 5. (When are they coming?) Do you know...? 6. (How much does it
cost?) I can't remember... 7. (Which one does he want?) Let's ask him... 8. (Who is coming to the
party?) I don't know... 9. (Whose pen is this?) Do you know...? 10. (Who is the mayor ofNew York
City?) I don't know... 11. (How old does a person have to be to get a driver's licence.) I need to find
out... 12. (Why didn't Tom come to the party?) I don't know... 13. (How much does it cost to park
here?) Do you know...? 14. (What qualifications do I need?) I want to know... 15. (Where can I
change some money?) Could you tell me...? 16. (What time did he leave?) Do you know...? 17.
(Where does Jack live?) Have you any idea...? 18. (Where is the post office?) Could you tell me...?
19. (Why did Tom leave?) I don't know... 20. (Where is he?) I don't know... 21. (Where did he go?) I
don't know... 22. (Where does he live?) I don't remember... 23. (What did he say?) I didn't hear... 24.
(How much does this book cost?) Could you please tell me...? 25. (What country is Anna from?) Do
you know...? 26. (Why was Kate, absent yesterday?) Do you know...? 27. (How far is it to Chicago?)
I wonder... 28. (When does the semester end?) Can you tell me...? 29. (What is Sue talking about?) I
don't understand... 30. (When is he going to leave?) I wonder... 31. (Where can I buy a good radio?)

Do you know...? 32. (Who is she?) I don't know... 33. (What time is flight 677 supposed to arrive?)
Can you tell me...? 34. (Whose books are those?) Do you know...? 35. (Who did Sue invite?) I don't
know... 36. (Who is that woman?) I wonder... 37. (How long has Ted been living here?) Do you
know...? 38. (What is a clause?) Don't you know...? 39. (Who broke the window?) Do you know...?
40. (Who is in that room?) I don't know... 41. (Where can I catch the bus?) Could you please tell
me...? 42. (Which team has won?) Bill asks... 43. (When are you coming back?) Bill wants to know...
44. (What platform does the train leave from?) He doesn't know... 45. (Why did you say that?) I don't
understand.... 46. (Who am I?) He doesn't know... 47. (Whose car is that?) I've no idea... 48. (How
old are their children?) I can't ever remember... 49. (Whose house is that?) I wonder.. 50. (What
happened?) Tell me... 51. (Who(m) did you see at the party?) Tell me... 52. (Who(m) did Helen talk
to?) Do you know...? 53. (Who lives in that apartment?) Do you know...? 54. (When are they
leaving?) Ask her...
255

V.Make a question from the given sentence. The words in brackets should be the answer to the
question you make. Use a question word (who, what, how, etc.) Then change the question to an
object clause.
1. That man is (Mr Robertson). Question: Who is that man?
Object clause: I want to know who that man is.
2. George lives (in Los Angeles). Question:
Object clause: I want to know...
3. Tom will be here (next week). Question:
Object clause: Please tell me...
4. He is coming (because he wants to visit his friends). Question:
Object clause: Please tell me...
5. He'll be on flight (645, not flight 742). Question:
Object clause: Please tell me...
6. (Jim Hunter) is going to meet him at the airport. Question:
Object clause: I wonder...
7. Jim Hunter is (his roommate). Question:
Object clause: Please tell me...
8. It is (350 miles) to Denver from here. Question:
Object clause: I need to know...
9. Ann bought (a new dictionary). Question:
Object clause: Do you know...?
10. Jack was late to class (because he missed the bus). Question:
Object clause: The teacher wants to know...
11. That is (Ann's) pen. Question:
Object clause: Tom wants to know...
12. Alex saw (Mr Frost) at the meeting. Question:
Object clause: I don't know...
13. (Jack) saw Mrs Frost at the meeting. Question:
Object clause: I don't know...
14. Alice likes (this) book best, (not that one). Question:
Object clause: I want to know...
15. The plane is supposed to land (at 7:14 p.m.). Question:
Object clause: Could you tell me...?
II. Make questions and object clauses.
Student A: Make a question from the given sentence. The words in brackets should be the answer to
your question.
Student B: Keep your book closed. Change Student A's question into an object clause. Begin your
sentence with "(Name of Student A) wants to know..."
1. Fred lives (in an apartment.)
Student A: Where does Fred live?
Student B: (Yoko) wants to know where Fred lives.
2. It's (ten o'clock).

Student A: What time is it?


Student B: (Roberto) wants to know what time it is.
3. Tom wants (a watch) for his birthday.
4. Jane gets to school (by bus).
5. Vacation starts (on June 3rd).
6. Sue left class early (because she didn't feel well).
7. The movie is going to last (two hours and ten minutes).
8. Mary called (Jim).
9. (Mary) called Jim.
10. Alice talked to the teacher about (the test).
11. Alice talked to (the teacher) about the test.
12. (Alice) talked to the teacher about the test.
13. Sue's plane will arrive (at 8:05).
14. (Two) students will be absent from class tomorrow.
15. There are (over 10,000) lakes in Minnesota.
16. It's (twenty-five miles) to Springfield from here.
17. Jane (studied) last night.
256
257
18. We're supposed to buy (this) book, (not that book.)
19. Ann likes (chocolate) ice cream the best.
20. That woman is (Mrs Anderson).
21. (Mrs Anderson) is talking on the telephone.
22. That is (Sam's) notebook.
24. (Jessica's ) car was stolen.
25. Jack's new car is (red).
26. The concert begins (at 7.00).
27. Dick is leaving (on Friday.)
28. Tom likes (swimming).
Object clauses which begin with whether or if
Yes/No Question Will she come?
Does he need help?
Object clause
(a)I don't know whether she will come.
I don't know if she will come. (b)I wonder whether he needs help.
I wonder if he needs help.
(c) I wonder whether or not she will come.
(d) I wonder whether she will come or not.
(e)I wonder if she will come or not.
When ayes/no question is changed to an object clause, whether or if is used to introduce the clause.
(Note: whether is more acceptable in formal English, but if is quite commonly used, especially in
speaking.)
In (c), (d), and (e): notice the patterns when or not is used.
I. Change the questions to object clauses.
1. (Did Steve go to the bank?) I don't know if (whether) Steve went to the bank. 2. (Where did Steve go?)
I don't know where Steve went. 3. (Is Karen at home?) Do you know...? 4. (Where is Karen?) Do you
know...? 5. (How is Pat feeling today?) I wonder... 6. (Is Pat feeling better?) I wonder... 7. (Does the bus
stop here?) Do you know...? 8. (Where does the bus stop?) I wonder... 9. (Why is Elena absent today?)
The teacher wants to know... 10. (Is Elena going to be absent again tomorrow?) I wonder... 11. (Where did
Janet go last night?) Do you know...? 12. (Should I buy that book?)
258
I wonder... 13. (Which book should I buy?) I wonder... 14. (Can Jerry speak French?) I don't know... 15.
(How much does that book cost?) Do you know...? 16. (Is there life on other planets?) jsfo one knows...
17. (Are we going to have a test tomorrow?) Let's ask the teacher... 18. (Is there a Santa Claus?) The little
boy wants to know... 19. (Does sound travel faster than light?) Do you know...? 20. (What's on TV
tonight?) I wonder... 21. (Will it rain tomorrow?) I wonder... 22. (Why is the sky blue?) Annie wants to

know... 23. (Does the store accept credit cards?) Do you know...? 24. (Do insects have ears?) The little
girl wants to know... 25. (When will the next earthquake occur in California?) No one knows... 26. (Do
animals have the same emotions as human beings?) The little boy wants to know... 27. (How do dolphins
communicate with each other?) Do scientists know...? 28. (Can people communicate with dolphins?) I
want to find out... 29. (Have beings from outer space ever visited the earth?) I wonder...? 30. (Is there a
pay phone in this building?) Do you know...? 31. (Does your sister speak French?) I wonder... 32. (Is this
information correct?) Do you know...? 33. (Does this bus go downtown?) Could you please tell me...? 34.
(How long does a butterfly live?) I wonder... 35. (Where is the library?) Could you tell me...? 36. (How
far is it to Florida?) I wonder... 37. (Does she need any help?) I wonder... 38. (When is Flight 62 expected
to arrive?) Could you please tell me...? 39. (What is he doing?) I wonder ... 40. (Who took my
dictionary?) Do you know...? 41. (Will people live on the moon someday?) I wonder... 42. (Has she been
waiting long?) I'd like to know...
II. Imagine you overheard these conversations in a restaurant. In your curiosity, what other information
would you like to know?
"He earns over one hundred thousand pounds a year."
I wonder what his job is.
I wonder what he spends it on.
I'd love to know where he lives.
a. "She's had so many husbands, she forgets their names."
b. "I've never worked a single day in my life."
c. "And then a complete stranger kissed me on both cheeks."
d. "I find it takes me about six weeks to learn a language."
259
III. Write some indirect questions about the following newspape, headlines.
Man wins record amount on football pools.
I wonder what he's going to do with it. We don't know how much he won.
a. Round-the-world yachtsman returns home. I wonder... I'd like to know...
b. President resigns!
I wonder... I can't imagine...
c. Oldest man in the world celebrates birthday. We don know... I wonder....
d. Bank robber escapes from prison. Nobody knows... I wonder...
e. Teachers promised pay rise by government. I wonder... I'd like to know...
Object clauses which begin with that Object Clause
Statement
(Expression of an
idea or fact)
He is a good actor.
The world is round.
(a) I think that he is a good actor. (b)l think he is a good actor, (c) We know (that) the world is round.
In (a): that he is a good actor is an object clause. It is used ^ the object of the verb think.
The word that, when it introduces an object clause, has no meaning in itself. It simply marks the
beginning of the clause Frequently it is omitted, as in (b), especially in speaking. (If used in
speaking, it is unstressed.)
"That clauses" are frequently used as the objects of ver^ < which express mental activity. (See the list
below.)
1. Common verbs followed by "that clauses".
agree, assume, believe, conclude, decide, discover, doul dream, fear, feel, find out, forget, guess, hear,
hope, imagii, know, learn, notice, predict, pretend, prove, read, realize, reca
260
say, tell, regret, remember, say, show, suppose, suspect, tell, think and others.
I hope that you can come to the game. I know that Jack has won the game. Mary realizes that she
should study harder. I dreamed that I was on the top of a mountain. I think that Mr Jones is a good
teacher.
2. Common expressions followed by "that clauses".
be amazed, be afraid, be angry, be ashamed, be aware, be astonished, be certain, be convinced, be
disappointed, be delighted, be furious, be glad, be happy, be impressed, be lucky, be pleased, be proud, be

sad, be sorry, be sure, be surprised, be worried and others.


I was sorry that I hadn't seen the performance. I'm afraid she will miss the tram.
3. "77/ clauses" may come after nouns.
It's a pity that he is going to be late. It's a fact that children like sweets.
I. Complete these sentences with object clauses.
1. He feels angry. It's not surprising (that) he feels angry.
2. She has resigned from her job. It's a shame...
3. You don't tmst me. It's annoying...
4. You are feeling better. I'm glad... 3. She's upset. I'm sorry...
6. He didn't get the contract. He told me...
7. It's a fair price. He believes...
8. You're leaving. He has guessed...
9. She's been a fool. She agrees...
10. She passed the test. She is pleased... 11.1 haven't seen that film. I regret... 12. It's true. I feel...
. Complete the following with your own ideas by using "that clauses."
A. 1. There are several reasons why I'm studying English.
261
One reason is that... Another reason is... A third reason is... 2. I have had three problems since I came
here. One problem is that... Another problem is that... The third problem I have had is that... 3. One
advantage of owning your car is... Another advantage is... 4. One disadvantage, however, of owning your
own car is... 5. There are two reasons why I do not want to go out tonight. The first reason is... The
second reason is...
B. 1. I'm sorry (that)... 2. I'm glad (that)... 3. I'm disappointed (that)... 4. I'm pleased (that)... 5. I'm
surprised (that)... 6. I'm sure (that)... 6. I'm amazed (that)... 7. I'm happy (that)... 8. Yesterday I was
annoyed (that)... 9. I'm afraid (that).. 10. It is surprising (that)... 11. It is true (that)... 12. It is obvious
(that)...
C. I.I doubt that... 2.1 believe that... 3. I've discovered that... 4. Do you realize that...? 5. Do you think
that...? 6. Have you ever noticed that...? 8. I hope that... 9. Last night I dreamed that... 10. Did you know
that...? 11. I suspect that... 12. I guess that... 13. I've heard that... 14. I can prove that...

Fluency Listen, read and practise.


'What's the Time?
A tramp was sleeping on a park bench late at night. A man and a woman were walking past. One of them
tapped him on tht shoulder and asked, "Excuse me! What's the time?" The tramp was very annoyed at
being woken up. "I don't know!" he saic angrily. "I haven't got a watch." And he went back to sleep.
Some time later another man was passing. He woke the tramp up and said, "I'm sorry to bother you, but I
wonder if you couK* tell me what time it is."
Again the tramp said that he didn't know. By now he was ver fed up, so he got a pen and a piece of paper
and wrote I DON'" KNOW WHAT THE TIME IS on it, and went back to sleep.
Half an hour later, a policeman was passing. He read the sigr woke the tramp up and said, "It's 2.30, sir."
262

I'd like to get some information


Rosie has just arrived at the railway station of a strange town. She goes to the tourist office to get some
information.
A = Clerk in the tourist office R = Rosie
A: Good afternoon.
R: Hello. I wonder if you could help me. I've just arrived here, and I'm looking for somewhere to stay.
A: Uh huh.
R: Can you tell me where I can find a cheap hotel?
A: Certainly. There are a few around here, but the nearest and one of the nicest is just around the corner.
It's called the Euro Hotel. Would you like me to phone to see if they have a room?
R: No, that's OK. I'll just wander round there myself. Ah! Another thing. I need to change some travellers'
cheques, but I don't know what time the banks close.
A: They close at 7 o'clock in the evening.
R: Right, thanks. This is a very pretty town, isn't it? It looks terribly old. Have you any idea how old this
town is?
A: Yes, it was founded in the thirteenth century.

R: Really? As old as that? Wow! Well, I'd better get going. Oh, I'm not sure if we're near the centre of
town, because I've only just arrived.
A: Yes, this square out here is just about the centre.
R: Thanks very much. Thanks for your help. I'll go to... oh, sorry I can't remember which hotel you
suggest.
A: The Euro Hotel.
R: The Euro. Thanks a lot. Bye.
A. Here is some more information that Rosie wants. Use the prompts to ask indirect questions.
1. When was the town founded? (Could you tell me...?) 2. What's the population of the town? (Do you
know...?) 3. Where can I change some money? (I'd like to know...) 4. What's the exchange rate today? (Do
you happen to know...?) ?. Is there a dry cleaner's near here? (I wonder...) 6. Where is there a cheap place
to eat? (Have you any idea...?) 7. How long does if take to get to the
263
centre of town from here? (Can you tell me...?) 8. Did it rain here yesterday? (Do you remember...?)
B. In pairs, ask and answer similar indirect questions about the town where you are now.

Poor Rosemary!
Rosemary Smith was robbed about an hour ago while she was walking home from work. She's at the
police station now, and she's having a lot of trouble giving the police information. She knows that a
man robbed her an hour ago, but she simply can't remember any of the details.
She has forgotten how tall the man was. She isn't sure how heavy he was. She can't remember what
colour hair he had. She has no idea what colour eyes he had. She doesn't remember what he was
wearing. She doesn't know what kind of car he was driving. She can't remember what colour the car
was. She has no idea what the license number was. And she doesn't even know how much money
was taken!
Poor Rosemary! The police want to help her, but she can't remember any of the details.
Note: license . = licence
A. You 're a police officer. You 're trying to get information from Rosemary Smith about the robbery.
Using this model, make questions and answers based on the story.
A: Can you tell me* how tall the man was? B: I'm sorry. I've forgotten how tall he was.
* Or. Do you know...?
Could you tell me...? Could you please tell me...? Could you possibly tell me...? Do you have any
idea...? Do you by chance know...?
264

Reported speech
When we want to report what someone said, we can use "direct speech" or "reported speech":
Original statement: Ann: I'm hungry. Direct speech:
Ann said, "I'm hungry."
Reported speech:
Ann said (that) she was hungry. or Ann says (that) she is hungry.
There are three areas of reported speech:
1. Reported statements
He said he would see me tomorrow.
2. Reported commands
He told them to go back to work.
3. Reported questions
He asked me where I lived.

Reported statements
1. If the reporting verb is in the past tense (eg said, told), it is usual for the verb in the reported clause
to move "one tense back".
present
present perfect past
past
past perfect
past (perfect)
eg "I'm going." He said he was going.
"She's passed her exams!" He told me she had passed her
exams.

"My father died when I was six." She said her father had
died when she was six. or She said her father died when
she was six.
The past simple (/ did) can usually stay the same in reported speech, or you can change it to the past
perfect (/ had done}:
did
did or had done
Tom: "I woke up feeling ill and so I stayed in bed."
Tom said (that) he woke (or had woken) up feeling ill so he stayed (or had stayed) in bed.
265
2. If the reporting verb is in the present tense (eg says, asfo), there is no tense change.
"The train will be late." He says the train will be late. "I come from Spain." She says she comes from
Spain.
3. The "one tense back" rule is not absolute. It is not always necessary to change the verb when you
use reported speech. If you are reporting something and you feel that it is still true, you do not need
to change the tense of the verb:
"I hate football." I told him I hate (or hated) football. "Horses are my favourite animals." Sarah said
horses are (or were) her favourite animals.
Notice that even if the words are still true, it is also correct to change the verb into the past.
But you must use a past tense when there is a difference between what was said and what is really
true. Study this example situation:
You met Ann. She said: "Jim is ill." Later that day you see Jim playing tennis and looking well. You
say: "I'm surprised to see you playing tennis, Jim. Ann said that you were ill." (not "that you are ill,"
because he isn't ill)
Absolute tense forms (referring to the present moment) are usually used in spoken English,
especially if the speaker is reporting something immediately or soon after it was said.
Immediate reporting:
A: What did the teacher just say? I didn't hear him. B: He said he wants us to read Chapter Six.
Later reporting:
A: I didn't go to class yesterday. Did Mr Jones make any
assignments? B: Yes. He said he wanted us to read Chapter Six.
4. The "one tense back" rule also applies to reported thoughts and feelings.
266
I thought she was married, but she isn't.
I didn't know he was a teacher. I thought he worked in a
bank.
I forgot you were coming. Never mind. Come in.
I hoped you would ring.
5. Some modal verbs change.
can will may
could
would
might
"She can type well." He told me she could/can type well. "I'll help you." She said she'd help me. "I
may come." She said she might come.
Other modal verbs don't change.
"You should go to bed." He told me I should go to bed. " It might rain." She said it might rain.
Must can stay as must, or it can change to had to. "I must go'" He said he must/had to go.
6. In more formal situations, we can use that after the reporting verb.
He told her (that) he would be home late. She said (that) she didn't know him.
7. There are many reporting verbs.
The commonest reporting verbs both in direct and in indirect (reported) speech are: say, tell, ask.
After tell we normally use a personal object (eg Sarah, me, us) to say who is told. We normally use
say without a personal object.
Compare:

say + something
I said I was going home.
He says he can speak
French.
tell + someone + something I told Sarah I was going home. He tells me he can speak French.
267

If we want to put a personal object with soy, we use to.


I said to Sarah that I was going home, (rarely used) In a few expressions we can use tell without a
personal object:
eg tell a lie, tell a story, tell the time, tell the truth.
Many verbs are more descriptive than say and tell, they indicate the underlying intention of the
speaker.
eg Original statement Speech intention Reported speech "I'm sorry I'm late" an apology
He apologized for
being late. "I won't go."
a refusal
She refused to go.
Here are some reporting verbs often used to report statements: say, tell (conveying information);
promise (promise); explain (explanation); agree (agreement); disagree (disagreement); refuse
(refusal); remark (casual remark); add (additional remark); warn (warning); remind (reminder);
answer, reply (answer); assure (assurance); announce (announcement), deny (denial), recommend
(recommendation), complain (complaint), admit (admission), insist (insistence), offer (offer), boast
(boast), threaten (threat) and others.
Reporting verbs can take various different constructions. They can be followed by:
a clause introduced by that:
say, tell (+pronoun), explain, agree, remind (+ noun/ pronoun), complain, reply, admit, boast, etc. He
said/told me/explained that they had left.
the infinitive with to:
agree, offer, promise, refuse, threaten The child refused to eat any food. He offered to lend me some
money.
a verb in the -ing form:
apologize (+ for), admit, insist (+ ) , accuse (+
somebody + of)
She apologized for telling a lie.
He admitted using my car.
268
a noun or pronoun:
accept, explain, greet, introduce, refuse, thank:
She explained the problem to him.
He introduced her to the other students.
two objects:
offer, refuse, promise
He offered me a lift.
He promised me a pay rise.
8. Pronouns (eg /, me) and possessive adjectives (eg my, your) often change in reported speech.
Compare:
Sue: "I'm on holiday with my friend."
Reported speech: Sue said (that) she was on holiday with
her friend.
9. People use the words like here, now, today to talk about the place where they are speaking and the
time they are speaking. If we report these words in a different place or at a different time, they often
change. For example:
Speaker's words
here
this
now
today

tonight
tomorrow
yesterday
next Monday
last Monday
Reported speech
there
that/the
then
that day
that night
the next day/the following day
the day before/the previous day
the following Monday
the previous Monday
The way these words change depends on the situation. For example, if someone was speaking a week
ago and said "I'll see you tomorrow.", we shall report "He said he would see me the next/the
following day. "But if someone was speaking yesterday, we shall say "He said he would see me
today." If someone was speaking a week ago and said "I'll see you tonight", we shall report "He said
he would see me that night." But if someone said it today, we shall say "He said he would see me
tonight."
269

Reported questions
1. We report yes/no questions with if or whether.
"Is your husband in?" He asked if you were in.
"Has he gone to London'7" He wanted to know whether
you'd gone to London.
2. Reporting w/z-questions we use question words (which, why, where, etc.)
"Which train did he take?" He asked me which train you'd
taken.
"When does he usually get home?" He asked when you
usually got home.
3. The word order in a reported question is the same as in statements (eg you were in, you 'd gone to
London, you 'd taken, you usually got home) and we do not use a question mark (?).
4. Reported questions can be introduced by the following verbs: ask, know, want to know, wonder,
not know

asked me wanted to know wondered didn't know


where the key was.
Sometimes questions are reported by a simple sentence: "What's the time?" He asked me the time.
5. Tenses, adjectives, pronouns, etc. in reported questions change in the same way as in reported
statements.

Reported commands
1. We often report orders, requests, warnings, advice and invitations using the structure verb + object
+ to-infinitive.
Speakerswords "Get out of my room."
Reported speech She told the man to get out of her room.
270

"Could you carry some


bags, Mike?
"Stay away from me."
"You should phone the
police."
"Would you like to have

dinner with us?"


I asked Mike to carry some bags.
He warned them to stay away
from him.
She advised him to phone the
police.
They invited me to have dinner
with them.
2. Notice the negative command. Use not before to.
He told me not to tell anyone.
The police warned people not to go out.
3. We can also report orders with a form of must or be to.
Doctor: Take the pills before meals.
The doctor told me to take the pills before meals. or
The doctor said I must/had to take/was to
take the
pills before meals.
Doctor: You mustn't smoke.
The doctor said I mustn't/was not to smoke.
or
The doctor told me not to smoke. The doctor forbade me to smoke.
3. We can also report orders with gerunds.
"Let's go out." Tony suggested going out.
"We simply must take a taxi." Mrs Lee insisted on taking
a taxi.
4. The reporting verb can be in the passive.
I was told to take the pills before meals. You were asked not to leave the car there.
271

Practice Reported statements


I. Report these words and thoughts using the verb suggested. Use formal sequence of tenses.
1. "I'm going to Paris soon." She said... 2. "It's time to start revising for the exam." The teacher told
the students... 3. "The film will be interesting." I thought... 4. "I can't help you because I have too
much to do." She said... 5. "Ann has bought the tickets." I was told... 6. "It took me three hours to get
here because the roads are flooded." He told me... 7. "I think it's a crazy idea. It won't work." She
said... 8. "Breakfast is served between 7.00 and 9.00." The receptionist explained... 9. " I need to go
to the market before it closes." Janet suddenly remembered... 10. "I'm going to postpone the
examination." Professor Williams announced... 11. "I will come to the party." Jane promised... 12.
"I'm going to move to Ohio." Dick informed me... 13. " You're right." He admitted... 14. "You'll get
into trouble if you are not careful." She warned me... 15. "The film is exciting, I agree." He agreed...
16. "I'm sure you'll win a scholarship." He assured me...
II. Report the following statements. Use the pattern: said that... and that or said that... but that.
1. "My father is a businessman. My mother is an engineer." He said that his father was a businessman
and that his mother was an engineer.
2. "I'm excited about my new job. I've found a nice apartment." I got a letter from my sister
yesterday. She said...
3. "Your Uncle Harry is in hospital. Your Aunt Sally is very worried about him."
The last time my mother wrote to me, she said...
4. "I expect you to be in class every day. Unexcused absences may affect your grades." Our sociology
professor said...
5. "Highway 66 will be closed for two months. Commuters should seek alternate routes." The
newspaper said...
6. "I'm getting good grades, but I have difficulty understanding lectures."
272
My brother is a junior at the state university. In his letter he wrote...
7. "I'll come to the meeting, but I can't stay for more than an hour." Julia told me...
8. "Every obstacle is a stepping stone to success. You should view problems in your life as
opportunities to prove yourself."

My father often told me...


9. "I'm going out now, but I'll be in by niae." He said...
10. "I'm working in a restaurant, and I don't much care for it". She said...
11. "I can't live on my basic salary. I'll have to offer to do overtime." Peter said...
12. "We're waiting for the school bus. It's late again." The children said...
13. "I'm living with my parents at present, but I hope to have a flat of my own soon." She said...
14. "There's been an accident. The road is blocked." The policeman said...
. Yesterday you met a friend of yours, Charlie. Charlie told you a lot of things. Here are some of the
things he said to you:
1. I'm thinking of going to live in Canada. 2. My father is in hospital. 3. Nora and Jim are getting
married next month. 4. I haven't seen Bill for a while. 5. I've been playing tennis a lot recently. 6.
Margaret has had a baby. 7.1 don't know what Fred is doing. 8.1 hardly ever go out these days. 9.1
work 14 hours a day. 10. I'll tell Jim I saw you. 11. You can come and stay with me if you are ever in
London. 12. Tom had an accident last week but he wasn't injured. 13.1 saw Jack at a party a few
months ago and he seemed fine.
Later that day you tell another friend what Charlie said. Use reported speech.
1. Charles said that he was thinking of going to live in Canada.
IV. Report the following utterances.
1. Peter: I've left some books on your table. I think you'll find them useful. You can keep them as
long as you
273

need but I'd like them back when you've finished with them. Mike: Thank you very much. I'll take
great care of them.
2. Mr Jones: I booked a double room on the first floor. Receptionist: I'm afraid we didn't get your
letter, and all the first and second floor rooms have been taken. But we could give you two single
rooms on the third floor.
. Jones: This letter is full of mistakes. Typist: I did it in rather a hurry. I suppose I'd better type
it again.
4. Mr Brown: I don't know why you waste so much time polishing the car.
Mrs Brown: The neighbours all polish their cars, and I don't want our Mini to look like a poor
relation.
5. Nick: You can leave your motorcycle in my garage if you
like. I'll keep an eye on it while you're away. Bob: That's very nice of you to offer me that.
6. Peter: You must leave a note for your mother, otherwise
she'll be terribly worried when you're not in at your usual time. Mike: I'll certainly do that.
7. Dick: I was thinking of going alone.
Mary: You'd better take someone with you. It's safer with two. One can keep watch while the other
sleeps.
8. Jane: I must hurry. My father is always furious if any of
us are late for meals. Helen: My father is not so strict as yours.
9. Paul: I've got a job on an oil-rig. Dan: That'll be very hard work.
V. This is what some people said to Sally today:
The manager of the bank where Sally works: "You'll get a pay rise later in the year."
An optician: "There is nothing wrong with your eyes. You
don't need to wear glasses."
Sally's boyfriend, Peter: "I'd like a big family. I want at
least five children."
Sally's father: "I've done the shopping. I'll be home at
about seven."
Sally's driving instructor: "You drove very well. You're
making good progress."
A man who works in a dry-cleaner's: "Your skirt will be
ready on Saturday."

It is evening now and Sally is telling her mother about her day. Complete what Sally says using
reported speech.
Sally: I went to the dry-cleaner's at lunchtime. The man
there said...
Mother: And what about the optician? What did she say? Sally: Oh, she told me... eyes and that
I... glasses. Mother: Oh, that's good. And what about your driving lesson?
How did that go? Sally: Oh, fine. My instructor told me that... and that I...
progress. Mother: That's very good. And what about Peter? Did you see
him today? Sally: No, but he phoned me at work. He made me laugh.
He said he... and that he... children. Mother: Five! Well, I hope you can afford them. Sally: Oh,
yes. That reminds me. I was speaking to the manager at work and she said that I... Mother: Oh, that's
good. Sally: Yes. Oh, and before I forget. Dad phoned. He said
he... and that he ... seven.
VI. Put one of the following verbs in its correct form into each Sap.
say
tell
explain
speak
talk
reply
I met Mr Brown in the street the other day, and we stopped a4d... for a while. He... me that his wife
had been taken into hospital.
274
275

When I asked him how she was, he... that she was getting better. He wondered why I hadn't been to
the tennis club for a few months, so I... that I'd been very busy lately and just hadn't time. "There's
something you must... me," he said. "How many languages can your son...?" " Four," I... "Why?" "I
know your son has some very funny stories to ... about learning languages and living abroad. We're
having a meeting of the Travellers Club next week, and I'd like him to... at it."
I... I would... to my son about it, and promised to get back in touch. Then we ... goodbye and went
our separate ways.

Reported questions
I. Report these words and thoughts, using the verbs suggested Use the formal sequence offenses.
1. "Where are you going?" He asked me... 2. "Do you want to go out for a meal?" She asked him... 3.
"Why are you late?" they asked their guest. They wondered... 4. "Can I use your phone to make a
local call?" She asked me... 5. "Which countries have you been to?" The customs officer asked me...
6. "Do you know where Angela is living?" He asked me... 7. "What colour are you going to paint the
living room?" She asked them... 8. "Why doesn't she talk to me any more?" I thought to myself. I
wondered why... 9. "Are you planning to enter law school?" I asked Martha... 10. "Can we still get
tickets for the concert?" Fred asked... 11. "How can I help?" Thomas wanted to know... 12. "Where
have you been all afternoon?" Frank asked Elizabeth.. 13.1 asked myself, "Am I doing the right
thing?" I wondered.. 14. "We'll be leaving around 7:00 o'clock in the morning." Our tour guide told
us... 15. "Why didn't you call me?" Nancy wanted to know...
II. Practise using asked if.
Student A: Say the words in the book to Student B. Student B: Don't look at your book. Report Student As
questions. Use asked.
eg Are you married? Student A: Are you married?
276
Student : () asked me if I am married, or. (Ali) asked me if I was married.*
* Immediate reporting, informal: (Ali) asked me if I'm married. Formal sequence of tenses: (Ali)
asked me if I was married.
1. Do you know my cousin? 2. Are you hungry? 3. Can you speak (French)? 4. Did you enjoy your
vacation? 5. Are you going to take another English course? 6. Will you be at home tonight? 7. Have
you ever been in (Mexico)? 8. Can you hear me? 9. Are you listening to me? 10. Do you need any
help? 11. Did you finish your homework? 12. Do you think it's going to rain? 13. Are you going to
go downtown tomorrow? 14. Do you know how to cook? 15. Do you know whether or not (...) is
married? 16. Can you come to my party? 17. Do you have a car? 18. Have you ever been in (Russia)?
19. Did you move into a new apartment? 20. Are you going to call me tonight?
III. Practise using object clauses after asked.
Student A: Say the words in the book to Student B. Student : Don't look at your book. Report Student

A s question. Use asked.


eg Where do you live?
Student A: Where do you live?
Student : (Maria) asked me where I live, or (Maria) asked me where I lived.
1. Where is your apartment? 2. Is your apartment far from here? 3. What do you need? 4. Do you
need a pen? 5. When does the semester end? Does the semester end in (December)? 6. Why is (...)
absent? 7. Is (...) absent? 8. How often do you go downtown? 9. Do you go downtown every week?
IV. Begin your response with "He (She) asked me..."
(To the teacher. Suggest to the students that they practise using the formal sequence of tenses.)
Example: Where is your friend?
Response: He (She) asked me where my friend was.
277

1. What time is it? 2. What is your name? 3. Can you speak Arabic? 4. Have you met my brother? 5.
Where are you living? 6. Will you be here tomorrow? 7. What kind of camera do you have? 8. How
tall are you? 9. What courses are you taking? 10. Do you feel okay? 11. Have you read any good
books lately? 12. How do you like living here? 13. Did you finish your assignment? 14. What are
you doing? 15. Wrhose briefcase is that? 16. May 1 borrow your dictionary? 17. Where will you be
tomorrow around three o'clock? 18. Did you go to class yesterday? 19. What are you going to do
during vacation? 20. What is the capital city of your country? 21. Did you go to a party last night?
22. How many people have you met in the last couple of months? 23. Can I use your pen? 24. Where
should I meet you after class? 25. Do you understand what I am saying? 26. What country are you
from? 27. Is what you said really true? 28. How do you know that it is true? 29. Who do you think
will win the game? 30. Is what you want to talk to me about important? 31. Will you be absent from
class tomorrow? 32. Where will you go? 33. Are you going to take another English course? 34. Did
you walk to school this morning? 35. Can you afford to buy this dictionary? 36. Are you planning to
take a trip? 37. Have you finished your test papei^ 38. Do you want to go to the library? 39. Are you
going to talk u Professor Reed? 40. Will you come to the meeting?
V. A new student, Paul, has come to the college and the studer,, are asking him questions. Imagine that he
reports these questio > later to an English friend.
Bill asked me what country I came from. 1. Bill: "What country do you come from?" 2. Ann: "Ho\v
long have you been here?" 3. Peter: "Are you working as well as studying?" 4. Bill: "Have you got a
work permit?" 5. Ann: "What are you going to study?" 6. Peter: "Have you enrolled for more than
one class?" 7. Bill: "Do you want to buy any second-hand books?" 8. Ann: "Have you seen the
library?" 9. Peter: "Do you play rugby?" 10. Peter: "Will you have time to play regularly' 7" 11. Bill:
"Did you play for your school team?" 12. Ann: "Are you interested in acting?" 13. Ann: "Would you
like to join our Drama Group?" 14. Peter: "What do you think of the canteen coffee?"
278

VI. Mary and Tom, with their son, John, aged 11, have recently come to this area. Mary wants to find
a school for John and asks her neighbour Mrs Smith about the local school.
(a) Later, Mrs Smith reports these questions to her husband: "Is it a mixed school?"
She asked if it was a mixed school.
(b) Alternatively, supply suitable answers to Mary's questions and then imagine that Mary reports the
conversation (her questions and Mrs Smith s answers) to her husband Tom: "Were your boys happy
there?"
" Yes, they were."
I asked if her boys had been happy there and she said that
they had.
1. "How long has it been a mixed school?" 2."Do you like the headmaster?" 3."Is he a scientist or an
arts graduate?" 4. "How many children are there in the school?" 5. "How big are the classes?" 6. "Are
the classes streamed?" 7. "What is the academic standard like?" 8. "Can parents visit the school at
any time?" 9. "Is there a good art department?" 10. "Do they teach music?" 11. "What instruments
can the children learn?" 12. "Is there a school orchestra?" 13. "Do they act plays?" 14."What sort of
plays have they done?" 15. "What games do they play?" 16. "Are there playing fields near the
school?" 17. "Are they taught to swim?" 18. "Can the children get dinner at school?" 19. "Is the food
good?" 20. "Is there a Parent Teacher Association?" 21. "How often does it meet?" 22. "Were your

own boys happy at the school?"


VII. Report the dialogues. Use the formal sequence offenses.
1. Fred: Can we still get tickets to the game? Bob: I've already bought them.
2. Mrs White: Janice, you have to clean up your room and empty the dishwasher before you leave for the game. Janice:
Okay, Mom. I will.
3. Mary: Why do you still smoke?
Nick: I've tried to quit many times, but I just don't seem to be able to.
279

4. Teacher: Bobby, what is the capital of Australia? Bobby: I'm not sure, but I think it's Sydney.
5. Mike: Where will the next chess match take place? Boris: It hasn't been decided yet.
6. Jane: Will we be able to visit the Air and Space Museum
and the Natural History Museum, too? Father: We will ifwe leave the hotel before 10 o'clocktomorrow morning.
7. Kate: I'm very discouraged. I don't think I'll ever speak
English well.
Alan: Your English is getting better every day. In another year, you'll be speaking English with the
greatest ot ease.
8. Mother: It's pouring outside. You'd better take an umbrella Jenny: It'll stop soon. I don't need
one.
9. Alex: What are you doing? Jane: I'm drawing a picture.
10. Jack: I can't go to the game. Tom: Oh? Why not?
Jack: I don't have enough money for a ticket.
11. Jane: Where are you going, Ann?
Ann: I'm on my way to the market. Do you want to come
with me? Jane: I'd like to, but I have to stay at home. I have a lot
of work to do. Ann: Okay. Is there anything you would like me to pick
up for you at the market? Jane: How about a few bananas? And some apples if
they're fresh? Ann: Sure. d be happy to.
12. Kate: Is there anything you especially want to watch on
TV tonight?
Mary: Yes. There's a show at eight that I've been waitinc
to see for a long time. Kate: What is it?
280
Mary: It's a documentary on green sea turtles.
Kate: Why do you want to see that?
Mary: I'm doing a research paper on sea turtles. I think I might be able to get some good information
from the documentary. Why don't you watch it with me?
Kate: No, thanks. I'd rather do my math homework than watch a show on green sea turtles.
VIII. Mrs Ford is talking to Mr Todd, who works for a finance company. She wants a loan. Write in the
questions he asks her.
Mr Todd: Come and sit down, Mrs Ford.
Mrs Ford: Thank you.
Mr Todd: ...
Mrs Ford: Two thousand five hundred pounds.
MR Todd: ...
Mrs Ford: I want to buy r
Mr Todd: I see. Could you give me some personal details?...
Mrs Ford: I'm a computer operator.
Mr Todd: ...?
Mrs Ford: Twelve thousand pounds a year.
Mr Todd: ...?
Mrs Ford: Yes, I am. I've been married for six years.
Mr Todd: ...?
Mrs Ford: Yes, we have two children.
Mr Todd: I see you live in a flat. Is it yours, or...?

Mrs Ford: No, it's ours.


Mr Todd: ...?
Mrs Ford: We've lived there for three years.
Mr Todd: Well, that seems fine. I don't think there'll be any
problems...?
Mrs Ford: I'd like it immediately, if that's possible. Mr Todd: All right. Let's see what we can do.
Mrs Ford: Thank you very much.
I A. Report Mr Todd's questions.
a) First he asked her b) Then he wanted to know c) He needed to know d) She had to tell him e)
Then he asked f) For some reason, he wanted to know g) He asked her h) He needed to know i)
Finally he wondered
281
. Report the conversation. Don't look at the text while reporting.
DC. Using the information in the conversation, complete the sentences in the reported conversation.
Conversation:
"Where are you from?" asked the passenger sitting next to
me on the plane.
"Chicago," I said.
" That's nice. I'm from Mapleton. It's a small town in
northern Michigan."
"Oh yes. I've heard of it," I said. "Michigan is a beautiful
state. I've been there on vacation many times."
"Were you in Michigan on vacation this year?"
"No. I went far away from home this year. I went to India,"
I replied.
"Oh, that's nice. Is it a long drive from Chicago to India?"
she asked me. My mouth fell open. I didn't know how to
respond. Some people certainly need to study geography.
Reported conversation:
The passenger sitting next to me on the plane... me where I... from. I... her I... from Chicago. She... that
she... from Mapleton, a small town in northern Michigan. She wondered if I ... of it, and I told her... I
went on to say that I thought Michigan ... a beautiful state and explained that I ... there on vacations many
times. She... me if I... in Michigan on vacation this year. I replied that I... and... her that I... far away, to
India. Then she asked me if it... a long drive from Chicago to India. My mouth fell open. I didn't know
how to respond. Some people certainly need to study geography.
X. Student A: Ask a question on the given topic whatever comes into your mind. Use a question word
(when, where, hem, why, etc.).
Student B: Answer the question in a complete sentence.
Student C: Report what Student A and Student said.
Eg:
tonight
Rosa: What are you going to do
tonight?
282
Ali:
I'm going to study.
Yung: Rosa asked Ali what he was going to do tonight, and Ali replied that he was going to study.
1. tonight 2. music 3. courses 4. tomorrow 5. book 6. this city 7. population 8. last year 9. television 10.
dinner 11. next year 12. vacation

Reported commands
I. Report the following using the verbs suggested + to-infinitive.
1. "Hurry up." Hetoldme... 2. "Don't leave the door unlocked." She warned them... 3. "Would you like to
come to my party?" He invited her... 4. "Don't be stupid." She told me... 5. "You should stop smoking."
The doctor advised my brother... 6. "Could you change the light bulb for me?" She asked me... 7. "Can I
do the washing-up?" I offered... 8. " Don't touch the wire." He warned me... 9. "Could you speak more
slowly?" He asked her... 10. "Shut the door." She told me... 11. "Don't touch my camera." He told me...
12. "I think you should take another English course." My teacher advised me... 13. "You may use the
phone." Mrs Jacobson permitted me... 14. "Take a deep breath." The doctor told the patient... 15. "Make
an appointment with the dentist." My mother reminded me... 16. "I think you should take a long
vacation." My friend encouraged me... 17. "Would you like to come to our house for dinner?" The Smiths

invited us... 18. "You should see a doctor about the pain in your knee." My friend advised me... 19. "You
must pay a fine of fifty dollars." The judge ordered Mr Jackson... 20. "Don't touch that hot pot." Bill
warned me... 21. "Don't buy a used car." Sue advised me... 22. "Don't play in the street." Mrs Gray
warned the children... 23. "Don't forget to thank Mrs Jones when you are saying goodbye to her." His
mother reminded him... 24. "Do make the coffee a bit stronger. It was terribly weak last night." I begged
her... 25. "Shall I carry your suitcase?" He offered...
26. "Take these letters to the post, will you?" The boss asked me...
27. "You'd better apologize for being late." My mother advised...
28. "Don't shelter under a tree in a thunderstorm." He warned us...
29. "Remember to switch off when you've finished." He reminded his son... 30. "You must see the
exhibition." My friends advised
283

me... 31. "Shall I buy you some cigarettes?" He offered... 32. "Answer this letter for me, will you?
And remember to keep a copy." He asked me... and reminded me...
II. Report the dialogues Use the proper reporting verbs
1. Joe:
Would you like to come to a movie with me? Mary:
Yes.
2. Dr Miller: You should get more exercise. Steve:
I'll try.
3. Mr Ho It: Could, you please open the door for me? Tom:
I'd be happy to.
4. Nancy: Call me around nine. Tom:
Okay.
5. Mr Ward: You may have a cookie and a glass of milk. The children:Thanks, Dad.
6. Prof. Larson: You should take a physics course. Me:
Oh?
7. Jack:
Don't worry about me. His mother: I won't.
8. Sue:
Don't forget to call me. Me:
I won't.
9. The police officer: Put your hands on top of your head! The thief: Who? Me? I didn't do anything.
10. Mrs Peterson: Please, don't slam the door. Her daughter: Okay, Mum.
11. Mike:
Be careful; the steps are very slippery. Me:
Okay.
III. Report the following suggestions.
1. Ann:
What about having a party on Saturday?
2. Mary: Yes, let's. Who shall we invite?
Ann suggested having a party on the next Saturday. Mary agreed and asked who they should invite.
284
3. Ann:
Let's not make a list. Let's just invite everybody.
4. Mary: We don't want to do much cooking, so what about
making it a wine and cheese party?
5. Ann:
Suppose we ask everybody to bring a bottle?
6. Mary: Shall we hire glasses from our local wine shop?
We haven't many left.
7. Ann:
If it's warm, how about having the party in the garden?
8. Mary: Why not have a barbecue?
9. Ann: Why not? We could ask Paul to do the cooking.
10. Mary: Last time we had a barbecue the neighbours complained about the noise. Shall we ask everyone to speak in whispers?
11. Ann:
Suppose we go round to the neighbours and apologize in advance this time?
12. Mary: Why not invite the neighbours? Then the noise won't
matter.
13. Ann: What a clever idea! Shall we start ringing everyone
up tonight?
14. Mary: What about working out how much it will cost first?
IV. Report the following dialogues. Use reporting verbs best suited to the sense of the utterances.
1. Peter: Shall we have dinner somewhere after the theatre? Ann:
Let's. What about going to
that place Jack is always talking about?
2. Ann:
Jack's parents have asked me to supper tomorrow
night. What shall I wear?

Mother: You should wear something warm, dear. It's a terribly cold house.
3. Jack:
I'm broke.
Peter: Shall I lend you some money?
4. Mary: What shall I do with this cracked cup? Mother: You'd better throw it away.
5. Driver: Would you mind getting out of the car? I have to
change a wheel. Me:
Shall I help you?
285
6. Peter: Shall we go for a walk?
Ann:
I like walking, but at the moment my only comfortable walking shoes are being mended.
What about going for a drive instead?
7. Peter: What shall I do with all this foreign money? Mary: Why don't you take it to the bank
and get it changed?
8. Peter: Would you like a cigarette? Me:
No, thanks. I don't smoke.
9. Mrs Fox: Would you like to come with us? There's plenty
of room in the car. Ann:
I'd love to.
10. Ann (on phone): Could you do without me today, Mr Jones?
I've got an awful cold and I think it might be better if I stayed at home.
Mr Jones: You should certainly stay at home, Ann. And you'd better take tomorrow off too if you
aren't better.
11. Peter: I'm not quite ready. Could you wait a few minutes? Jack:
I can't wait long. The train goes at ten.
12. Ann:
Remember to book a table. Bob:
Don't worry. I won't forget.
13. Me:
Do go to a dentist, Tom, before your toothache
gets any worse. Tom:
I'll go to the dentist's tomorrow.
14. Nick: Go on apply for the job. I'm sure you'll be hired. Tom:
I'm not so sure of that.
15. Ann:
Don't lend Harry any money. He never pays his
debts. Dick: I didn't know that.
16. Policeman: Avoid Marble Arch. There's going to be a big
demonstration there. Me:
Okay.
17. Tom: Could I speak to Albert, please? Albert's mother: He's still asleep.
Tom: Then please wake him up. I have news for him.
18. Tom's father: Remember to insure your luggage. Tom: I'll do that.
19. Dick: Could you ring up the taxi rank and order a taxi for
me? Ann: Why don't you go by tube? It's much cheaper.
V. For the following verbs that introduce reported commands, write an appropriate sentence in direct
speech, then report it.
eg warn
"Be careful of strangers and don't go out at night." He warned me to be careful of strangers and not to
go out at night.
a) advise b) remind c) invite d) ask e) tell f) persuade g) urge h) warn
Mixed types
I. Report the following dialogues.
1. Peter: Don't worry about a few mistakes. I make mistakes all
the time
Me: Do you learn from mistakes? Or do youkeep making the same ones?
2. Man: Could I have a look at your paper for a moment? I
just want to see the football results.
Me: I haven't quite finished with it. Could you wait a minute?
Man: I can't wait long. I'm getting off at the next stop.
3. Mike: Hurrah! I've passed the first exam.
Me: Congratulations! And good luck with the second.
4. Us: Many happy returns of the day! Tom: Thanks.
286
287

5. Mother:
You woke everyone up Is at night. You must
try to be quieter tonight. Dick:
I will.
6. Mr Jones: The soup is cold again. Why do I never have
hot soup?
Mrs Jones: Because the kitchen is so far from the dining room.
7. Policeman: Your licence is out of date.
Me:
It is, but I've applied for a new one.
Policeman: Next time apply for a new one before your current one has expired.
8. Me:
I'll have the money for you next week. Shall
I post it for you?
Bob:
Could you keep it in your safe till I can come
and collect it?
9. Peter:
Could I borrow your map again?
Me:
You're always borrowing it. Why don't you
get one of your own?
10. Ann:
Can you hear that noise? What do you think
it is?
Me:
I think it's only rats running up and down inside the wall.
Ann:
I think it's someone trying to get in. You' d better go and see.
11. They:
It's your turn to baby-sit tonight. Ann(indignantly): It can't be! I baby-sat last night!
And the
night before! And I'm only supposed to do two nights a week!
They:
Could you possibly do it just this once? And we
promise not to ask you to do any next week
12. Taxi-driver: This is the best restaurant in town. The only
problem is that they expect guests to wear ties Tourists (indignantly): Then why have you brought us
here'' Taxi-driver: Don't get excited. I keep ties in my car. What
colour would you like? They're all the same
price.
288

13. Me:
Why don't you go and see the film? It may help
you to understand the book. Ann:
But the film's quite different from the book.
14. Me:
Why are you looking so depressed, Jack? Jack (sadly): I've just asked Ann to marry
me and she's refused.
Me:
I think she prefers clean-shaven men. Why
don't you cut your hair and shave off your beard and try again?
15. Father:
Are you ill? Tom:
No.
Father:
Did you sleep well last night?
Tom:
Yes.
Father:
Then why are you sitting when all the others
are working? Go out at once and give them a
hand.
16. Nick:
Let's drive on to the next village and try the
hotel there.
Mary:
But what shall we do if that's full too?
Nick:
We'll just have to sleep in the car. It will be
too late to try anywhere else.
I. Put the following into direct speech, using dialogue form:
Tom: Would you like to come for a drive tomorrow, Ann? Ann: I'd love to etc.
Trip to Stratford
1. Tom invited Ann to come for a drive the following day.
2. Ann accepted with pleasure and asked where he was thinking of going.
3. He said he'd leave it to her.

4. She suggested Stratford...


5. adding that she hadn't been there for ages.
6. Tom agreed and said that they might go on the river if it was a fine day.
7. Ann wondered what was on at the Royal Shakespeare Theatre.
8. Tom said they'd find out when they got there...
289

9. adding that it was usually possible to get seats on the day of the play.
10. He asked Ann if she could be ready by ten.
11. Ann said with regret that she couldn't as she had to type a report first.
12. Tom expressed horror at the idea of working on Saturday...
13. and advised her to change her job.
14. She told him not to be ridiculous and explained that...
15. she had volunteered to type the report in return for a free afternoon the following week.
16. She pointed out that she hadn't known that he was going to ask her out.
17. Tom said he supposed it was all right hut...
18. warned her not to make a habit of volunteering for weekend work.
19. Ann promised not to.
20. Tom said gloomily that he supposed s,he'd be busy all
morning.
21. Ann assured him that she' d be finished by 11.00 and..
22. offered to meet him at the bus stop at Hyde Park Comer
23. Tom said that it wasn't a very good meeting place and that he'd call for her.
24. Ann said that that was very kind of him and that she'd be waiting in the hall.
Hill climb
25. Tom suggested climbing to the top, adding that the view from there was marvellous...
26. but Ann said that they'd been climbing for three hours and that she was too tired to go any further.
27. She suggested that Tom should go on up while she went down and waited there.
28. Tom agreed and handed her the car keys, advising her to wait in the car.
29. He promised to be as quick as he could.
30. Ann said that if he was too long there'd be no lunch left, for she'd have eaten it all.

Fluency
Listen, read and report.
Where do you come from?
Patrick: You said you were American, didn't you? Where do
you come from exactly? Diane : I was born in Boston, but I studied in New York. And
you? Patrick: I was born in Bristol, but I came to London when my
parents bought a small flat here a few years ago. Diane: And do you work in London? Patrick:
Yes, I'm a journalist. Diane: Then you must have lots of free time! Patrick: That's what you think!
Diane: Do you do any sport? Patrick: Yes, I do. In winter I go skiing. In summer I play tennis and go sailing ... we can go together some time, if you like. Diane: Great! I'd love to!
A. This is a reported version of the conversation. Notice that there is no tense change when the reporting
is done in the present.
Patrick asks Diane if she is American and where exactly she comes from. She tells him that she was
born in Boston but studied in New York. Patrick tells her he was born in Bristol, and came to London
when his parents bought a small flat there a few years ago. Diane asks Patrick if he works in London.
He tells her he is a journalist. She assumes he must have lots of free time. When she asks if he does
any sport he says he goes skiing in winter, and in summer he plays tennis and goes sailing. He
suggests they can go sailing together one day, if Diane would like to. She accepts with great
enthusiasm.
B. Study and practise both the conversation and its reported version.
290
291
What's it like?
Karen: Hello, Scott. How did you get on today?
Scott: Oh, not too bad. Hey, Karen, there's a friend of yours in my class.

Karen: Who? Not Steven?


Scott: Yes, that's right! He's a really nice guy.
Karen: Mmm... yes he is. Er... do you want to go to the Tower of London tomorrow?
Scott: Well... I went there last Sunday with Mom and Dad.
Karen: Have you been to Westminster Abbey?
Scott: Yes, I have. I thought it was a bit boring. I'm not really interested in old buildings but my
parents thought it was great!
Karen: Have you been to the Science Museum?
Scott: No, I haven't. What's it like?
Karen: Oh, it's really interesting. There's a fantastic collection of old airplanes.
Scott: OK. Let's go there then.
Karen: Fine. Well, I'll meet you outside Kilburn Underground Station at 10 o'clock.
Scott: Outside the underground at 10 o'clock. See you.
Karen: Bye!
A. Report the conversation, both in the present and in the past.
A Job Interview
Charles had a job interview a few days ago at the United Insurance Company. The interview lasted
almost an hour and Charles had to answer a lot of questions.
First, the interviewer asked Charles where he had gone tc school. Then, she asked if he had had any
special training. She asked where he had worked. She also asked him whether he was willing to
move to another city. She wanted to know if he could work overtime and weekends. She asked him
how his health was She asked him whether he had ever been fired. She wanted to know why he had
had four different jobs in the past year.
And finally, the interviewer asked the most difficult question. She wanted to know why Charles
thought he was more qualified
292
for the position than the other sixty-two people who had applied. Charles had never been asked so
many questions at a job interview before. He doesn't know how well he did, but he tried his best.
A. Questions
1. Where did Charles have an interview? 2. How long did the interview last? 3. What was the first
question? 4. What else did the interviewer want to know? 5. What was the most difficult question?
B. Study and practise the text.

Situation: Charles is applying for a job and he is being interviewed at the United Insurance
Company.
D. Situation: You're applying for a job. Rolepiay a job interview with another student, using the
questions in the illustration as a guide.
1. Where was the interview? 2. How long did it last? 3. What questions did the interviewer ask? 4.
What were your answers'? 5. What was the most difficult question and how did you answer it? 6. Did
you get the job?
E. Report the conversation you 've just heard.
I Won't lie to yu again This is a scene from Jenny's favourite opera "Jericho Street."
Rod: How did you find out about my letter to Caroline?
Liz: Don't mention the letter again.
Rod: Are you still angry with me?
Liz: Yes, and I don't want to discuss it.
Rod: Liz, give me a chance to explain please.
Liz. No, I won't listen to any more of your excuses.
Rod: Please don't be cross. Please...
Liz: If I were you, I'd tell the truth in future.
Rod: I won't lie to you again, I promise.
A. What did they say?
1 . Rod asked Liz... 2. She told him... 3. He wanted to know... 4. She said... and that... 5. He asked
her... 6. She refused... 7. He begged her... 8. She advised him... 9. He promised...
293
B. Roleplay the conversation and then report it.

C. Interview with a star


TV presenter Emma Hall interviewed Don Majors, who plays Rod in "Jericho Street". Here is part of
the interview. What did she ask him?
Take turns to report the questions round the class.
1. Don, when did you play your first TV role? 2. When did you join "Jericho Street?" 3. Do you
enjoy playing the part of Rod Spencer? 4. Is it a difficult part to play? 5. How many fan letters do
you get every week? 6. Has anyone ever written to you to ask you to marry them? 7. Do you think
you will ever marry? 8. Are you similar to Rod in any way? 9. How many episodes of "Jericho
Street" have you made? 10. Are you planning to leave the show? 11. What do you do when fans
recognize you in the street?
D. You answered some questions for a man doing a street survey about soap operas on television. What
were his questions? Write the questions in the survey.
eg He wanted to know if you liked soap operas. Do you like soap operas?
1. He asked whether you watched an American soap opera called "Manhattan". 2. He wanted to know
how long you had been watching it. 3. He asked how many of your friends or family watched it. 4.
He asked why it was your favourite soap opera. 5. He wanted to know if you would continue to
watch it regularly. 6. He asked you who your favourite character was. 7. He asked you if you thought
soap operas should be shown at the weekend. 8. He asked you if you could name four other soap
operas.
E. In the TV studio
Jim Walker, a TV director, is rehearsing a scene from a detective series, called "Inspector Thaw."
Unfortunately, he isn't satisfied with the actors and actresses. What does he tell them to do and not to
do? Say your answers.
eg He told Mavis not to laugh when she hit John, and to hit him harder.
"No, no, no, Mavis. Don't laugh when you hit John. And hit him harder!"
1. "John, don't fall into the camera next time." 2. "Don't point the gun so high, Sally, and make your
hand shake more." 3. "Read the script again, Jake. Your second line was wrong." 4. "Tony, look more
surprised when Jill enters." 5. "Jill, remember that you are supposed to be angry. Don't smile at
Tony!" 6. "And all of you, get it right this time!"
An interview
Barbara is interviewing the Wilsons who have won a lot of money on the football pools.
Barbara: Congratulations on your big win, Mr Wilson.
Frank W: Thank you. It really was a big surprise.
Barbara: How has the money changed your lives?
Frank W. : Oh, completely I'd say.
Mary W: Yes, it really has. We bought so many things. A new car, for example. A pink Chevrolet.
Frank W: And we've employed a chauffeur to drive it for us. I've given up my job I was a taxi
driver for thirty years, so I've had enough of driving.
Barbara: And what else are you going to do with the money?
Frank W: Well, we love the sea and the sun, but we don't see much sun in England. And when it is
hot, we don't see much of the sea, either. Crowded beaches! We hate them! So I'm going to buy a
little island in the Pacific.
Mary W. : Yes, just imagine it! But we shall pay all our unpaid bills first!
1 Imagine you are Barbara. Report what the Wilsons have told you. Don 't look at the text while
reporting. This makes the process of reporting very mechanical.
We sent y the "wrong Person 'Heartsearch", a dating agency, arranged a date for Ruth and sent her
a description of the man. After meeting him, Ruth telephoned the agency the next day.
294
295
Ruth: This is Ruth Talbot here. I'm telephoning about rny date last night.
Woman: Oh yes, did you have a pleasant evening?
Ruth: No, it was a disaster. In fact, I'm rather confused!
Woman: Oh?
Ruth: There are four things, firstly, you said he was twenty-six but he's at least thirty-five.
Woman: Oh?

Ruth: I definitely said in my application form that I wanted to meet someone in their twenties.
Woman: Yes, I remember.
Ruth: Secondly, and this is rather strange, you said he had dark hair and brown eyes but in fact he has
red hair and blue eyes.
Woman: Oh?
Ruth: And thirdly, you said he lived in Oxford but he doesn't. He lives in Bristol! That's too far away
for me.
Woman: I'm sure that can't be right.
Ruth: And fourthly, you said he was interested in music and the theatre but he isn't. He's only
interested in sport! In fact, he was really boring.
Woman: Just a moment. Was his name John Manning?
Ruth: No, it was Neil Carter.
Woman: Ah, that explains it. We sent you the wrong person. I'm so sorry, Miss Talbot!
A. Choose the right answer.
1. Ruth telephoned the agency because
a) the man did not arrive for her date.
b) the man was too young for her.
c) the man did not match the description.
2. The agency
a) had not read Ruth's application carefully.
b) had sent the wrong person by mistake.
c) had forgotten to tell John Menning that he had a date.
B. Report what Ruth said about herself to the agency. She said (that) she was twenty-four.
1. "I'm twenty-four."
2. "I live in a flat in Oxford."
3. "I'm looking for a man in his twenties."
4. "I want to meet someone interesting."
5. "I'm keen on classical music."
6. "I haven't got a car."
C. Roleplay the conversation.
What's the Matter? The police have just stopped Clare just outside Oxford.
Clare: What's the matter? I wasn't driving too fast, was I?
Officer: No, it's all right. Just a few questions, madam, if you don't mind. Where are you going?
Clare: Home. To Oxford.
Officer: And are you the owner of this car?
Clare: Of course I am!
Officer: And where have you come from?
Clare: London.
Officer: Do you work in London, madam?
Clare: Yes, I do.
Officer: When did you last buy petrol?
Clare: This morning on my way to work.
Officer: I see. And how long have you had this car?
Clare: Oh, about a year. What's the problem?
Officer: There's been some trouble on the motorway. A holdup at a service station, actually. A car just
like this one was stolen.
A. Choose the right answer.
\. The police stopped Clare because
a) she was driving too fast.
b) they wanted to check her car.
c) she was driving a stolen car.
2. The police officer wanted to know
a) if she owned the car.
b) how long she had had her driving licence.
c) where she worked in London.

3. The police officer said there had been


296
297

a) an accident on the motorway.


b) a traffic jam.
c) a robbery.
B. Report the questions which the police officer asked Clare.
C. Roleplay the conversation.
I got a Phone call
Josh: I got a phone call from Clare Taylor today, from Work
International.
Eva: What did she want? Josh: Apparently there's a vacancy for a tour-guide in Venezuela. She wants me to go and see her about it. Eva: Venezuela! How long for? Josh: Six months.
Eva: That's a long time. When does the job start? Josh: Well, I haven't decided to take it yet but
the travel company would like me to go at the end of September. Eva: Oh. Josh: Anyway, I asked Clare to get a
few more details.
A. Questions
1 . What did Clare phone Josh about? 2. Is he going to take it? 3. Does Eva sound excited or upset?
B. Look at these lines from the conversation. What do you think were the original requests?
1 . She wants me to go and see her about it. 2. They'd like me to go at the end of September. 3. 1
asked Clare to get a few more details.

I'd like a Room.


John arrived at the hotel and asked for a quiet single room with a bathroom. The receptionist said she
was terribly sorry, but they didn't have any single rooms left that night. All they had was a rather
noisy double room which looked out onto the main road. John asked how much it cost and she said
that because it was so
298
late, he could have it for the same price as a single. John said he would take it for that night but as he
was staying for three days, he wanted to have a quieter room the next day as he was a very light
sleeper. The receptionist checked and said there would in fact be a single room at the back free and
that they would move him into it the next morning.
A. Retell the text, then write a conversation with the words John and the receptionist probably used. You
may want to add words to make the conversation more natural and polite.
Kidnap!
Mr and Mrs Barker were having a quiet day at home. Their 17-year-old daughter was away in
Scotland staying with a friend. At 12 noon, Mr and Mrs Barker got a phone call from the friend
where their daughter was supposed to be staying, saying that she had disappeared. They were just
about to call the police when the phone rang again. A hoarse voice told Mr Barker that his daughter
had been kidnapped and that unless he paid a ransom of 1000, he would never see his daughter alive
again. When Mr Barker asked who the caller was, the voice answered that it was someone he knew
well. The voice then gave him instructions about where and when to hand over the money. He was
warned not to tell the police or to try to have the phone traced. Mr Barker went to the bank and
immediately took the money out of his bank account and left on the next train to Brighton. When he
arrived, he went into the Grand Hotel at five to six and carefully put the brief-case beside a sofa as
arranged. At 6 o'clock precisely, a woman in a scarf and raincoat came up, took the briefcase and
walked quickly away.
At 10 p.m. the same evening, to his great relief, his daughter came back home. She could hardly stop
herself from laughing. Imagine his surprise when she handed him his briefcase containing the 1000.
It turned out that she and her friend had decided to play a practical joke. It was she who had put on a
hoarse voice to phone her father and it was she who had collected the briefcase in Brighton. The joke
had worked out, strangely enough, Mr and Mrs Barker did not enjoy it as much as their daughter did!
A. Questions
299

1. Where was Mr and Mrs Barker's daughter supposed to be? 2. What did the daughter's friend phone

to say? 3. What did the second person phone to say? 4. How much did the person want in ransom
money? 5. Where did Mr Barker have to go with the money? 6. Where did he put the money? 7. At
what time was the briefcase collected? 8. What happened at 10 p.m. the same evening? 9. What did
she give her father? 10. What was her explanation?
B. Study and practise the text.
C. Act-out a telephone conversation between Mr Barker and the kidnapper.
D. Work in groups of three. It is Student s birthday and Student A and have both been invited to 's
party.
Student A
It is getting late. Telephone to say that unfortunately you are still at home (say why). Ask if everyone
has arrived Say what time you expect to arrive. Ask what music you should bring.
Student
You have arrived early to help get the party ready. is busy when the phone rings so you answer it.
Student
You were busy when the phone rang. Find out from who phoned and what the call was about.
The wedding reception
Adam:
Are you on your own?
Beatrice: No, I'm not. I'm with my husband.
Adam:
How do you know John and Moira, then?
Beatrice: I was at university with Moira.
Adam:
Do you like big weddings?
Beatrice: I prefer smaller ones.
Adam:
Where did you meet your husband, then?
Beatrice: Actually, I met him at a wedding.
Adam:
Why aren't you drinking?
Beatrice: Because I'm driving.
300

Adam:
Er... Have you travelled far to get here?
Beatrice: Yes, we have. We flew in from New York yesterday.
Adam:
Hey, why aren't you wearing a hat?
Beatrice: I never wear hats.
Adam:
Where are you staying tonight?
Beatrice: We're at the "Red Lion."
Adam:
Oh. Can you give me a lift there?
Beatrice: Yes, we can. Are you staying at the "Red Lion" too?
Adam:
Yes, I am. Will there be enough room in your car?
Beatrice: Oh, yes, lots. There won't be a problem.
Some time later Beatrice is talking to her husband.
I've just met this really friendly young man. Do you know what he said to me? First he asked me if I
was on my own and of course I said that I wasn't, I was with you. Then he asked me how I knew
John and Moira and I told him I had been at university with Moira. He asked me if I liked big
weddings, and I said no, I preferred smaller ones. Then he asked me where I'd met you, which was a
bit of a funny question, so I told him we'd met at a wedding. He asked me why I wasn't drinking, and
I said that it was because I was driving. He asked me if we'd travelled far to get here, so I explained
that we'd flown in from New York yesterday.
Then he asked something strange. He asked me why I wasn't wearing a hat, so I said I never wore
hats. He then went on to ask me where we were staying tonight, and I told him we were at the "Red
Lion". He asked me if we could give him a lift there, and I said yes. I asked him if he was staying at
the "Red Lion", too, and he said he was. He asked if there would be enough room in our car, and I
told him that there wouldn't be a problem.
A. Study and practise both the conversation and its reported version.
Connie
Connie had an American father and an English mother. She was eighteen and she was over in
England from the USA with a friend. She was visiting her English grandmother who was ninety-one
years old and rather deaf. Fortunately Connie's cousin Julie was there to help.

301

Grandmother: Well, my dear, what have you been doing with yourself?
Connie:
Oh, we've been in London this week. We've seen
a lot of interesting things.
Grandmother: What did you say? Interesting? What's interesting?
Julie:
She said they'd seen a lot of interesting things.
Grandmother: They? Who's they?
Connie:
I have a girl friend with me.
Julie:
She has a girl friend with her.
Grandmother: Have you been to Windsor Castle?
Connie:
Yes, we went to Windsor yesterday.
Grandmother: Speak up. My hearing's not too good.
Julie:
She said they went to Windsor yesterday.
Connie: And we've been to the British Museum. We saw the Egyptian Mummies.
Grandmother: Which museum?
Julie:
The British museum. They saw the Egyptian Mummies.
Connie: Next week we're planning to go to the north of England. We want to visit York and see the
Cathedral. We'll send you a postcard.
Grandmother: A postcard? Where?
Julie:
No, she said they would send you a postcard
from York.
A. Study and practise the conversation.
B. Report these questions.
1. "Where have you been today?" 2. "What do you find specially interesting in London?" 3. "What
have you been doing?" 4. "Where do you intend to go tomorrow?" 5. "What do you like about York?"
6. "What have you seen today?" 7. "What do you dislike about England?" 8. "What souvenirs have
you bought'7" 9. "What do you want to buy for your mother?" 10. "What have you bought for your
father?"
Claude and Anna
Claude and Anna had been to the pictures. Now they were sitting in the bus on their way home.
302
Suddenly Anna said: "Oh, dear."
"What's the matter?" asked Claude. "I've forgotten my key," replied Anna.
Claude looked at his watch. "Never mind. It isn't late. It's only eleven o'clock."
"But my family always go to bed about 10.30." Anna looked terribly worried.
"I know," said Claude. "You can sleep on the sofa in the sitting-room in my home."
They arrived at Claude's home ten minutes later.
Claude's landlady, Mrs Briggs, was still up. She was watching television.
"This is Anna," said Claude, "she's forgotten her key, so she's going to sleep on the sofa if that's OK."
"Very well," said Mrs Briggs. "Has she telephoned her landlady?"
"No, she will be in bed by this time," said Claude.
"All right," Mrs Briggs smiled. "I'll telephone Anna's landlady first thing in the morning."
A. Questions
1 . Where had Claude and Anna been? 2. How did they travel home? 3. What did Anna forget to take
with her? 4. What time did Anna's family usually go to bed? 5. Where did Claude suggest she could
sleep? 6. What was Mrs Briggs doing, when they arrived?
7. Did Mrs Briggs offer to telephone Anna's landlady at once?
8. Why didn't she do this? 9. Did Mrs Briggs allow Anna to spend the night on the sofa? 1 0. When
did she telephone Anna's landlady?
B. Retell the text first in direct and then in indirect speech.
George
George's mother was worried about him. One evening, when her husband came home, she spoke to
him about it.
"Look dear," she said, "You must talk to George. He left school three months ago. He still hasn't got a

job, and he isn't trying to find one. All he does is smoke, eat and play records."
George's father sighed. It had been a very tiring day at the office.
"All right," he said, "I'll talk to him."
303
"George," said George's mother, knocking at George's door, "your father wants to speak to you."
"Oh!"
"Come into the sitting-room, dear."
"Hullo old man," said George's father, when George and his mother joined him in the sitting-room.
"Your father's very worried about you," said George's mother.
"It's time you found a job."
"Yes," replied George without enthusiasm.
George's mother looked at her husband.
"Any ideas?" he asked hopefully.
"Not really," said George.
"What about a job in a bank?" suggested George's mother, "or an insurance company perhaps?"
"I don't want an office job," said George.
George's father nodded sympathetically.
"Well, what do you want to do?" asked George's mother.
"I'd like to travel," said George.
"Do you want a job with a travel firm then?"
"The trouble is," said George, "I don't really want a job at the moment. I'd just like to travel and see a
bit of the world."
George's mother raised her eyes to the ceiling. "I give up," she said.
A. Questions
1. Why was George's mother worried about him? 2. What did she tell her husband to do? 3. Why did
he sigh? 4. What jobs did George's mother suggest he might get? 5. What did George really want to
do?
B. Retell the text first in direct and then in indirect speech.
'Whilee the Auto "Waits (after O. Henry)
The girl in grey came to that quiet corner of the small park. She sat down on a bench and began to
read a book.
Her dress was grey and simple. Her face was very beautiful. She always came there at the same hour
and there was a young man who knew it.
The young man came near. At that moment her book fell on the ground. The young man picked up
the book, returned it to the girl, said a few words about the weather and stood waiting. The girl
looked at his simple coat, common face and said, "Sit down, if you like, the light is too bad for
reading. Let's talk."
"Do you know," he said, "that you are very beautiful. I see you here sometimes." "Oh, let's change
the subject. Don't forget that I'm a lady. You'd better tell me about the people passing by. Where are
they going? Are they happy? I come here to sit because only here I am near the masses of people. I
speak to you because I want to talk to a man not spoiled by money. Oh! You don't know how tired I
am of money, money, money! And of the men who surround me! I'm tired of pleasure, of jewels, of
travels!"
The young man looked at her with interest. "I've always thought that money is a good thing! I like to
read about the life of rich people."
"Sometimes I think," the girl continued, "that I could love only a simple man. What is your
profession?"
"I'm a cashier in the restaurant that you see on the opposite side of the street."
The girl looked at her watch and rose. "Why aren't you at work?" she asked. "I'm on the night shift.
When shall I see you again?"
"I don't know. Now I must be going. Oh, there is a dinner and a concert tonight. Did you notice the
white automobile at the comer of the park? The driver is waiting for me. Good night."
"But the park is full of rude men. May I accompany you to the car?"
"Oh, no. Stay on this bench for ten minutes after I have left."
And she went away. The young man looked at her elegant figure while she was going to the gate of

the park. Then he stood up and followed her. When the girl reached the park gate she turned her head
to look at the white car, then passed it, crossed the street and entered the restaurant. A red-haired girl
left the cashier 's desk and the girl in grey took her place.
The young man walked slowly down the street, then stepped into the white automobile and said to
the driver, "Club, Henry!"
- Ask and answer questions on the text. Retell the text both in direct and in indirect speech.
304

305
This is an extract from "The Gadfly" by Voinich.
"Gemma, there is a man downstairs who wants to see you," Martini said.
"A man, Martini? What does he want?"
"I don't know, dear. He did not tell me. He said he wanted to speak to you alone."
"Very well. I must go to him, I think, but probably it's only a spy."
"In any case, I shall be in the next room," Martini said. "When he goes away, you must lie down and
have a rest. You have been working too much today."
"Oh, no. I will go on with my work."
She went slowly down the stairs, and Martini followed her in silence. In the little study she found one
of the guards, dressed as a mountaineer.
"Can you speak German?" he asked.
"A little. I hear you want to see me."
"Are you Signora Bolla? I have brought you a letter."
"A letter?" She was beginning to tremble.
"I'm one of the guards of the fortress. It is from the man who was shot last week. I promised him to
give it into your own hands myself."
She bent her head down. So he had written after all. He took a letter out of the breast of his blouse
and gave it to her.
"You won't say anything," he began again looking at her. "I've risked my life to come here."
"Of course I will not say anything," said Gemma. She stood still for a minute with the paper in her
hand, then sat down by the open window to read.
A. Retell the text both in direct and in indirect speech. Situations
A. Give a one-minute impromptu speech. Your classmates will take notes, and then in a short
paragraph, or orally, they will report what you said. Choose any topic that comes to mind (relatives,
sports, books, etc.)
B. Work in pairs. Each pair should create a short dialogue (five to ten sentences) based on one of the
given situations. Each
306
pair will then present their dialogue to the class. After the dialogue, ' the class will report what was
said.
Sample situation: Have a conversation about going somewhere in this city.
Sample dialogue:
Ann: Would you like to go to the zoo tomorrow?
Bob: I can't. I have to study.
Ann: That's too bad. Are you sure you can't go? It will take
only a few hours. Bob: Well, maybe I can study in the morning and then go to
the zoo in the afternoon. Ann: Great! What time do you want to go? Bob: Let's go around two
o'clock.
Sample report:
Ann asked Bob if he wanted to go to the zoo tomorrow. Bob said that he could not go because he had
to study. Ann finally persuaded him to go. She said it would take only a few hours. Bob decided that
he could study in the morning and go to the zoo in the afternoon. Ann asked Bob what time he
wanted to go. He suggested going around two o'clock.
1. Have a conversation in which one of you invites the other one to a party.
2. One of you is a teenager and the other one is a parent. The teenager is having problems at school
and is seeking advice and encouragement.
3. Have a conversation in which one of you persuades the other one to begin a health program by

taking up a new kind of exercise (jogging, walking, tennis, etc.)


4. The two of you are a married couple. One of you is reminding the other one about the things he
should or has to do today.
B. Money is the most important thing in life. Do you agree with the given statement? Have a
discussion. At the end of your discussion, make a formal written report of the main points made by
each speaker in your group. (Do not attempt to report every
307

word that was spoken, give an accurate idea of the speaker's words, you don't necessarily have to use
the speaker's exact words.)
hi your report, use the words such as think, believe, say, remark, and state to introduce object clauses.
When you use think or believe, you will probably use present tenses (eg John thinks that money is the
most important thing in life.) When you use say, remark, or state, you will probably use past tenses
(eg Ann said that many other things were more important than money.)

Self check
I. Translate from Russian into English.
A. ,
, , . , ,
, .
. .
, , , . ,
. , "
". , , .
, . ,
. ,
, , , .
,
. ,
. , 12.30,
.
B. , , .
, ,
,
. , .
, . .
. , ,
. ,
. .
308

UNIT 14 TOPIC: MEDICAL MATTERS


Listen, read and practise.
At the Doctor's Surgery
There were several patients waiting at the surgery, one of them was Joseph. There was nothing wrong
with him, but the National Health Service was free, so he was always inventing pains and being
given enormous supplies of pills, ointments and medicines that were worth a small fortune.
This meant that he was getting regular check-ups, because he was constantly having to register with a
new doctor. But what harm was there in that?
His name was called over the loudspeaker and he rose promptly. He didn't want his overcoat, which
he wore winter and summer alike, but as he was taking it off, a woman said, "You've dropped
something."
He looked down. It was a receipt. He picked it up, and continued to struggle out of his coat. His
name was repeated over the intercom. Hurriedly he stuffed the crumpled receipt into a pocket and left
the waiting room.
"Third door on the right," the receptionist told him.
Joseph knocked and entered.
"Morning, doctor."

"Good morning."
The doctor got up behind his desk and they shook hands.
"Well, what's the trouble?"
The doctor flicked through the cards in the index cabinet and pulled one out.
"I've got a pain." Sometimes he would complain of backache, sometimes of headaches, at other times
of pains in the chest. Today he chose a pain in the stomach, just above the navel.
"Right, take your shirt off and let's have a look at you."
Joseph stripped and lay stretched out on the couch.
"How's your appetite?"
"I never refuse a good meal."
"Any discomfort afterwards? Nausea, indigestion, dizziness?"
310
"No."
"Are you ever troubled by constipation?"
"I'm as regular as clockwork."
"I see," the doctor said.
"Perhaps I'd better give you a general check-up."
He got out his stethoscope and sounded Joseph's chest.
"Do you sleep well?"
"Like a dog."
The doctor pressed his hands over Joseph's fat stomach.
"Are you a worrier?"
"What's the use of worrying, doctor? It may never happen."
They were silent for a minute while Joseph had his pulse taken.
"How many cigarettes do you smoke a day?" the doctor asked, as he prepared to take his blood
pressure.
"A packet of twenty."
"Are you a heavy drinker?"
"Wish I could afford to be. Do you know the price of a bottle of whisky these days?"
The doctor nodded.
"Do you ever get pains in the chest after exercise?"
"Never take exercise."
"You should, you're overweight. You ought to go on a diet, keep off fried food and cut out sugar
altogether."
"Which reminds me, doctor. I reckon I need a good tonic."
Next Joseph was tapped below the knee to test his reflexes.
"The best tonic for you is to go for a walk after supper and do some exercises when you get up in the
morning. A prescription isn't needed for that. Let's have a look at your throat. Say "Ah." He nodded.
"There is nothing wrong with you. All the same, I'll take a blood sample and I'd better have a
specimen of your urine."
The thought that he was giving things rather than receiving them upset Joseph. He hastily began
inventing other symptoms of illness.
"But, doctor, I get this tired feeling..."
"No wonder." The doctor patted Joseph's belly. "You're carrying about with you the equivalent of a
sack of potatoes."
"Well, that's enough exercise, isn't it?"
"The wrong sort. Now you take my advice, and you'll be in excellent condition in no time."
"Thank you, doctor."
311
The waiting-room was empty. His overcoat pocket was empty too. Joseph peered suspiciously round.
On the chair opposite was the green coat belonging to that sharp-eyed female who'd first spotted the
receipt on the floor. Had it been picked by her? He felt in the pockets. The green coat revealed
nothing, but the handbag had been hidden under it. He opened it and swiftly searched among its
contents. The owner of the handbag appeared quite suddenly and screamed.

"Help. Thief. Murder!"


Joseph, in panic, dropped the bag and fled.
Some time later he found the missing receipt in his jacket pocket. Even later he was visited by two
policemen in plain clothes.
A. Questions
1. What was Joseph doing at the surgery? 2. What did he complain of on this occasion? 3. What did
the doctor tell Joseph to do? 4. What was the result of the doctor's examination? 5. What was the last
piece of advice he gave Joseph? 6. Why, according to the doctor, did Joseph feel tired? 7. What
happened after Joseph had left the surgery?
B. Study and practise the text.
C. Special Difficulties
I. Make up short dialogues. Use the present or the past continuous with always.
(a) A: Mike doesn't interrupt much, does he?
B: Oh yes, he does. He's always interrupting! b) A: He didn't interrupt much, did he?
B: Oh yes, he did. He was always interrupting!
(a) He doesn 't... does he? (b) He didn 't... did he?
1. smoke much
2. ask for help often
3. talk about her
4. argue much
5. often forget your telephone number (Use my in the answer.)
6. use the phone often
312
7. change his job often
8. have accidents often
9. get into trouble often
10. boast often
11. break things often
12. let you down (Use me in the answer.)
13. grumble much
14. tell lies often
15. get into debt often
16. catch cold often
17. write to the newspapers
II. Which of these sentences can be completed with either used to or would? Which of them can only
be completed with used to?
1. When Andrew was a small baby he ... cry a lot. 2. When I was little, I... be afraid of the dark. 3.
When we were children, we ... visit my grandmother every Sunday afternoon. 4. When Mrs Woods
was younger, she ... play tennis every weekend. 5. Years ago I... have a motorbike. 6. There ... be
quite a lot of cinemas in the town, but now there aren't any. 7. We... live in a village in the North of
England. 8. When Robert was younger, he ... go running every morning. 9. Whenever Arthur was
angry, he ... walk out of the room.
III. From each pair of sentences make one sentence -with as (time).
eg She opened the letter. I watched her. I watched her as she opened the letter.
1. We posed for the photograph. We smiled. We smiled... 2. He explained what I had to do. I listened
carefully. I... 3. The two teams ran onto the pitch. The crowd cheered. The crowd... 4. She passed me
in the street. She didn't look at me. 5. The man slipped. He was getting off the train. 6. She was
taking the cakes out of the oven. She burnt herself. 7. The thief was seen. He was climbing over the
wall.
IV. Supply the correct forms of the verbs in brackets.
1. What are you doing? I... the car. (clean) I'm cleaning the car.
313
2. Where's your car? It... at the moment. I'll collect it in an hour, (clean) 3.1 never find time to
clean the car myself, so I... (clean) 4. Did you decorate the room yourselves? No, we... (decorate).
5. We can't use the living room. It.... at the moment, (decorate) 6. You... They look quite worn,

(must/repair your shoes) 7. My shoes ... It was an expensive job! (just repair) 8. The heel came off
my shoe andl... it myself, (repair) 9. "I'd like this film...," I said. "Certainly," the assistant said,
(develop and print) 10. "Can I use the photocopier... this document?" I asked, (photocopy) 11. Who...
the children's clothes in this house? Who do you think? I do! (mend) 12. What's happened to my
report? It... at the moment, (photocopy)
V. Make up statements according to the models.
a)
I can't type the article now. There is something wrong with my typewriter.
b) I'm tired.
No wonder. You've been working hard.
VI. Vocabulary of injury
The following words are often contused.
Verb
Noun
Adjective
to hurt
to ache

____

an ache

to injure to
a pain an injury
wound
a wound
painful injured wounded
People are wounded in wars or in a fight, and injured in an accident. Both are more serious than
hurt.
Ache as a noun is mainly found in the following compounds. backache, earache, headache,
stomachache, toothache. For other parts of the body, we say a pain in my elbow, etc.
An ache is dull and continuous; a pain can be more extreme and more sudden.
When ache and hurt are used as verbs, it is more common to
314
find them m the Present Simple than the Present Continuous to describe pain now: My leg hurts
Fill each gap with one of the words from the chart in the correct form.
1. The England football captain has... his ankle, and won't be playing in next week's international
against Belgium. 2. The soldier had a bullet ...-in his thigh. 3.1 have a terrible ... in my chest. 4.
When I cough, it really ... 5. Two people died and ten were ... in a train crash yesterday. 6.1 played
tennis for the first time this year yesterday. Today my whole body... 7. Two football fans were
seriously ...ma knife attack by rival fans earlier today. Three men are helping police with their
enquiries. 8. Please don't touch my ankle. It's too ... to move. 9. Doctor: I want to feel your bones. If
it..., tell me and I'll stop.

Health Service in Great Britain


There is a state medical service in Britain called the National Health Service (NHS). Anyone can go
and see a GP and this costs nothing. (The service is free for foreigners too in an emergency.) If the
doctor thinks you need some medicine, he writes you a prescription, which you take to the chemist's.
Most people have to pay a small charge for a prescription. Although medical treatment, including
hospital treatment, costs NHS patients almost nothing, there are some problems: you often have to sit
in crowded waiting rooms with a lot of ill people; doctors and nurses are overworked; people may
have to wait for months for a minor operation because there aren't enough hospital beds. People who
have serious illnesses, however, get immediate medical treatment.
Some people go to private doctors to get private treatment, though this is expensive.
Health service isn't paid for in the United States. There is no government health service. People buy
insurance, but it doesn't Pay for everything. Hospital rooms can cost as much as two hundred dollars
a day, and very often the patients have to buy their own necessities. Sometimes they pay for their
treatment for the rest of their lives.
315
A. Speak about health service in Great Britain.
B. 1. Do you pay to see a doctor in your country? 2. Would you like to be a doctor? Why? Why not?
3. Talk about interesting personal experiences with doctors and hospitals.
'Dentists
In Britain, young people (under 21) and people on Social Security don't have to pay for dental

treatment. Other people have to pay. But there is a maximum charge for treatment (in 1980 it was
8.00). This means if the dentist gives you one, two or three fillings, an injection, an X-ray and pulls
out a tooth, you pay a little for each piece of treatment, but you don't have to pay more than the
maximum charge. The government pays most of the cost of your treatment. There are also private
dentists. People go to them if they want special treatment, like gold fillings or better quality false
teeth. It is almost impossible for foreigners in Britain to find a dentist who is willing to do work on
their teeth on the National Health.
A. Speak about dental service in Great Britain.
B. 1. Why do people hate going to the dentist? 2. Do you pay lot for dental treatment in your
country?
C. Discussion'. Advantages and disadvantages of government an private health services.
What Should I do?
Ten years ago I used to be very fit. I cycled to work and I got a lot of exercise at the weekends. I used
to play tennis a lot and go for long walks. In those days I didn't earn very much. I had a job m an
office. It wasn't a very good job but I had a lot of time to do the things I enjoyed doing.
Then, about eight years ago, I got a much better job. The pay was better. But the hours were a lot
longer, too. I bought a car ar> J drove to work every day. I began to take people out to lunch.
"Expensive account" lunches. And I began to put on weight, too. I stopped playing tennis and going
for long walks at the weekenc' because I just didn't have any time for things like that any more
There's a lot of stress in a job like mine. Perhaps that's why I
316
started drinking more than I used to. For example, I used to have only a half a glass of whisky when I
got home, then I started filling the glass to the top. Then I had another glass, and then another. I
started smoking a lot, too. I never used to smoke at all. Two months ago I had a heart attack. At first I
just couldn't believe it. "I'm too young," I said. Luckily it wasn't very serious. I was in hospital a few
days and they did a lot of tests. The doctor advised me to stop smoking and to eat less. He told me to
do a lot of other things, too. But I don't see how I can do some of them and keep my job. For
example, he advised me to work less, and get more exercise. But I just haven't any time! My job
takes everything out of me! Sometimes I wonder if I should get another job. Perhaps I could do
something like I used to do. But if I do that, I won't earn as much. I have a family to support. I have
to think of them, too. I just don't know what I should do. What do you think?
A. Questions
1. What are some of the things this man used to do but which he doesn't do any more? 2. What are
some of the things he probably enjoyed doing at the weekend? 3. Do you think he enjoys life as
much as he used to? Give reasons for your answer. 4. What are the things he does now but which he
didn't use to do? 5. What has his job to do with these things? 6. Do you think he should stop doing
some things and start doing others? What? Why?
Laura's Story
Here's one person who really believes in keeping fit. Her name is Mrs Laura Taylor. She is 45 but
looks at least 10 years younger. Let's listen to her story.
It all started about two years ago. In those days things were very different. I was overweight. I used
to smoke a lot about 30 cigarettes a day. I never got any exercise. I used to stay at home all day. I
never went out into the fresh air, except to do the shopping. And even then I used to take the car. One
day I looked at myself in the mirror. "My God!" I thought. "I look terrible!" I tried to touch my toes. I
couldn't do it. I found an old dress. I couldn't put it on. It was too small. Or rather I was too fat!
The next day I tried to jog a little. At first it was terrible. I mean I just couldn't run. Not even a short
distance. And at first
317
people used to laugh at me. "Why are you running? Are you in a hurry?" they shouted. But now I've
completely changed the way I live. I've stopped eating meat and I've started eating far more fresh
vegetables. My husband and daughter have started that, too. At first they didn't like the new food. But
they've changed. About six months ago I sold my car and bought a bike. Recently I've started doing yoga
exercises.
My husband often goes cycling with me now and my daughter jogs with me in the evening. They've both

lost weight and are much healthier than they used to be, too.
A. 1. Describe the way Laura Taylor used to live.
2. Describe what happened one day about two years ago.
3. Describe the things she and her family have started doing in the last two years.
B. Keeping fit
Write down as many ways of getting and keeping fit as you can think of in five minutes, then tell them to
the class. Say when, where or how often you can do these things. Your ideas can be serious or funny, as
long as they keep you fit.
eg You can go to a keep-fit class once or twice a week. You can climb the Eiffel Tower once a year.
Bad Habits
Heart disease kills more than a million people in the world every year. In Britain alone 170,000 die from
the disease annually. There are three main reasons for this: smoking, a bad diet, and not taking enough
exercise. Many people travel to work by car, bus or train and then sit down at work all day! The food they
eat is unhealthy and they eat too much. In a typical British dish of sausages, chips and beans there is too
much salt and too much sugar an important ingredient in tinned food and there are not enough
vegetables. And there is not enough fibre in most meals. There are too many deaths from heart disease.
We can reduce that number, but we have to change our habits.
A. Are these statements true or false?
1. 100,000 people in the world die annually from heart disease.
318
2. There is only one reason for heart disease.
3. Many people do not take enough exercise.
4. There isn't any sugar in tinned food.
5. Smoking can cause heart disease.
B. Speak about bad habits that make our life shorter.
C. Fitness or fun?
Work in two teams. Have a class discussion. Team A argues that "Fitness and good health are the
most important things in life." Team argues that "Fun and enjoyment are the most important things
in life."
D. Sum up the specific vocabulary on the topic "Medical Matters. " Name a) the nouns b) the verbs c) the
expressions.
"How to live to be 100 or more" by George Burns
People keep asking me, "George, you're 88, how do you do it? You make films, you do television,
you give concerts, you record albums, smoke cigars, drink Martinis, go out with pretty girls how
do you do it? It's simple. Today you don't have to worry about getting old; you have to worry about
rusting. So I do exercises and walk a lot. Every morning I walk a mile and a half. My advice is to
walk whenever you can. It's free; you feel better and look trim. If you want to live to be 100 or older,
you can't just sit around waiting for it to happen. You have to get up and go after it. Here are my
secrets for long life:
Think positive. Avoid worry, stress, and tension. Worry, stress, and tension are not only unpleasant
but can shorten your life. My attitude is, if something is beyond your control, there's no point
worrying about it. And if you can do something about it, then there's still nothing to worry about. I
feel that way when the plane I'm on is bouncing around in turbulence. It's not my problem. The pilot
gets a lot of money to fly that plane; let him worry about it.
Stay active. I know that for some people retirement works out fine. They enjoy it. I also know that for
a great many others it Presents lots of problems.
To me the biggest danger of retirement is what it can do to your attitude. When you have all that time
on your hands, you
319
think old, you act old. It's a mistake. I see people, who, the minute they get to be 65, start rehearsing
to be old. They practise grunting when they get up, and by the time they get to be 70 they've made it
they're a hit they are now old!
Not me. When you're around my age you've got to keep occupied. You've got to do something that
will get you out of bed. I never made any money in bed. Yes, find something that will make you get
out of bed like an interest, a hobby, a business, a pretty girl there we are, back in bed again. At my

age at least let me talk about it.


Challenge yourself. When my wife Gracie retired in 1958,1 could have retired too. Even today I don't
have to do what I'm doing. I don't have to travel round giving concerts, making movies, doing
television specials, recording country-music albums, being a sex symbol. I firmly believe that you
should keep working as long as you can. And if you can't, try to find something that will interest you.
Don't wait for it to happen; make it happen. Remember, you can't help getting older, but you don't
have to get old.
There's an old saying, "Life begins at 40." That's silly life begins every morning when you wake
up. Open your mind to it; don't just sit there do things. Swim the English Channel; find a cure for
the common cold; be the first to go over the Niagara Falls in a rocking chair. You see, the
possibilities are endless. The point is, with a good positive attitude and a little bit of luck, there's no
reason you can't live to be 100. Once you've done that you've really got it made, because very few
people die over 100."
A. Study and practise the text.
B. Do you take care of your health? What is your daily routine? Do you want to live to be a hundred?
What do you think one ought to do to live to be a hundred?
C. Work with a partner. Write a questionnaire with the title "Have you got a healthy lifestyle? "
Write at least ten questions which include some of the following phrases.
for breakfast/lunch to/at school in the park by bicycle/bus
how many... a day/week? in the morning/afternoon to/in bed at the weekend
320
watch television in summer/winter
on foot take exercise
What Should I Do?
Doctor Lennox is a radio doctor. She answers listeners' questions about their medical problems. Read
their questions to her.
a) Hello, Doctor Lennox. Well, three days ago I fell over and cut my arm. There was a little blood,
but it quickly stopped bleeding and I forgot about it. Now the wound is painful and red. It hurts when
I touch it. I also think I may have a fever. I feel a little hot and quite weak. Do you think I should see
my doctor?
b) Doctor Lennox, I am a 63-year-old woman. A few months ago, I was walking upstairs when I
suddenly felt very faint and almost fell over. Now, whenever I do just a little exercise I get out of
breath very quickly. Even when I'm sleeping, I have breathing problems. I wake up in the middle of
the night and can't get back to sleep. I'm really worried, because I have never had insomnia in my life
before. I don't have a pain in my chest, so I don't think I have heart problems. I'm very worried. What
do you think?
c) For the last two days, Doctor Lennox, I have been feeling absolutely terrible. My whole body
aches. I have a backache and all my muscles ache. I have a terrible headache too. But the worst thing
is the vomiting. Food just won't stay in my stomach for more than a few minutes. And the diarrhea
I'm in the bathroom every half an hour. I called my doctor and asked for a prescription for some
medicine, but she said there wasn't much she could do for me. She said I should stay in bed and drink
a lot of liquids. Is that right?
d) I hope you can understand me all right, doctor, but I can't talk very well because of my sore throat.
I've had it a few months now. And a cough, too, even though I don't smoke. And I seem to be tired all
the time, but I'm never so sick that I can't go to work. I've been to the doctor and had some tests, but
they can't find anything wrong with me. What do you think I should do now?
A. Here are Doctor Lennox's answers. Match her answers to the questions.
1. You should see a doctor as soon as possible. Your doctor will arrange for you to have a complete
series of tests.
321

It's best to take care of these things right away.


2. You've probably got a minor infection. Sometimes they
take a long time to go away. The important thing is to get plenty of rest. And maybe you should get
an opinion from another doctor.
3. It sounds as if you have an infection. You'll have to see

your doctor, who will probably write you a prescription for an antibiotic and some medicine to put on
your skin as well.
4. You probably have the flu. It's very important that you
drink a lot of liquids. You should feel better soon, but if it continues much longer you should see your
doctor.
B. What are the most common symptoms (signs) of flue? When were you ill last? What was wrong
with you? What did you do?
C. Situation: You are a radio doctor. At the moment you're answering listeners' questions about their
medical problems.

Conversation practice Listen, read and practise.


Making an Appointment
Nurse: Doctor Kowalski's office.
Sheila: Hi. My name's Sheila Berger. I'd like an appointment
with the doctor as soon as possible. Nurse: Have you been in before? Sheila: No, I haven't. Nurse:
Okay, you're a new patient then. Sheila: Well, yes, but I don't live here. I'm passing through the
town.
Nurse: I see. And what's the matter? Sheila: I'm dizzy and I have pretty bad diarrhea. Nurse: Hmmm.
Can you come in this afternoon at 3:00? Sheila: Oh huh, that'd be fine. Nurse: And since you're
not a resident of Evanston, I'll have
to ask you to pay the $ 55 for the office call today. Sheila: That's fine. See you at three.
A. Questions
1. When does Sheila want to see the doctor? 2. Is she a new patient? Why do you think so? 3. What is
the matter with her? 4. When does the nurse want her to come in? 5. How much will the office call
cost? 6. Is Sheila a resident of the town that Dr Kowalski's office is in? 7. What's the name of the
town? 8. When will Sheila pay the bill? Why?
B. Roleplay the conversation.
Can I help you? Mrs Cheevers is phoning her doctor.
Clinic:
Hello. Parkway Health Clinic. Can I help you?
Mrs Cheevers: Yes, this is Mrs Cheevers. I'd like to make an appointment to see Dr Fox.
Clinic:
Certainly. When would you like to come?
Mrs Cheevers: Well, I'm free on Monday...
Clinic:
I'm afraid Dr Fox won't be here next week.
He's on holiday.
Mrs Cheevers: Oh, well. I'll be in London tomorrow. Can he see me then?
Clinic:
Yes, he's here tomorrow. And he's free at 12 p.m.
Mrs Cheevers: Oh, dear. I'm meeting a friend for lunch at 12.30. Isn't he free in the afternoon?
Clinic:
I'm afraid not. Dr Fox is very busy at the moment. He won't be able to see you unless you come at 12.
Mrs Cheevers: Well, all right. I'll change my lunch appointment. Twelve o'clock tomorrow.
Clinic:
That's right, Mrs Cheevers.
Mrs Cheevers: Oh, just a minute. Did you receive my last payment? I didn't get a receipt.
Clinic:
Oh, hold on a minute, Mrs Cheevers. I'll just
look in our files.
A. Questions
1. When does Mrs Cheevers want to see Dr Fox? 2. Will she be able to see Dr Fox on Monday? Why
not? 3. Why doesn't 12 o'clock suit Mrs Cheevers0 4. When can Dr Fox see Mrs Cheevers9 5. Whai
will Mrs Cheevers have to do?
322
323
B. Report the conversation.
C. Roleplay the conversation.
D. Situation: You seem to have caught flu. You are phoning the clinic and making an appointment
with the doctor.
What a relief
Dr Fox is examining Mrs Cheevers.

Dr Fox:
Hello, Mrs Cheevers. How can I help you?
Mrs Cheevers: Oh, Dr Fox. I think it's my heart. I've got pains
in my chest. Dr Fox:
I see. Let me have a look then. Now, where
does it hurt exactly?
Mrs Cheevers: Just here. And it hurts in my back, too. Dr Fox:
Mm. Is it hurting now?
Mrs Cheevers: Not now. No.
Dr Fox :
What about when you are doing some exercise 7
Mrs Cheevers: Oh, well. I don't really do much exercise. Not
now. Dr Fox:
Well, I don't think it's your heart. You're still
working for that shoe company, aren't you? Sales manager?
Mrs Cheevers: Yes, that's right. So you don't think it's my heart? Dr Fox:
No, no... do you
still smoke as much?
Mrs Cheevers: Oh, you know... Dr Fox:
How many?
Mrs Cheevers: A few. Forty a day. In fact I've still got a sore
throat from... Dr Fox:
Well, I'll take an X-ray of your lungs, but I don't
think there's anything wrong. You must cut
down on your smoking. Alcohol? Mrs Cheevers: I beg your pardon? Dr Fox:
How much do
you drink?
Mrs Cheevers: Well, a bit. If I go out I'll have a few drinks. Sometimes a bottle of wine with dinner, a sherr>
or two in the evening. Dr Fox:
Well, I think the ache is actually in your stomach, Mrs Cheevers. It's probably just indigestion.
324
Mrs Cheevers: Oh, what a relief!
Dr Fox:
But you must relax, don't work too hard. And
do watch your drinking and smoking. Now, make an appointment with the hospital for an X-ray. I'll
give you a card.
. Questions
1. What does Mrs Cheevers complain of? 2. What questions does the doctor ask her? 3. What does
Mrs Cheevers answer? 4. What does the doctor advise her to do?
B. Report the conversation.
C. Roleplay the conversation.
D. Roleplay
Role A: You have a very difficult job. You smoke and drink a lot. You don't get any exercise. You are
worried about your health. You go to a doctor for advice.
Role B: You are a doctor. Find out how much A smokes and drinks and how much exercise he/she
gets. Then give some advice.
E. When were you at the doctor's? What was wrong with you? Did the doctor give you any useful
advice?
At the Doctor's
Doctor: I see you last came to see me two years ago.
Mr Smith: Yes, doctor. You gave me a general check-up then.
Doctor: And what's wrong with you at the moment?
Mr Smith: Well, my throat hurts and I've had a terrible headache since last night.
Doctor: Have you got a temperature?
Mr Smith: I took my temperature this morning. It was 38.2.
Doctor: That's not very much.
Mr Smith: So much the better. If it was 39 I'd be in bed now.
Doctor: Are you coughing much?
Mr Smith: A little bit.
Doctor: All right. I'll examine you now. (The doctor examines the patient)
Doctor: Now take a deep breath please. Let it out. And now
325

cough. And now cough again, please. Well, don' worry, it's only a throat infection. There's nothing
wrong with your lungs. I'll prescribe some pill which you should take in the morning and evening I'll
also prescribe some syrup, 2 spoonfuls a day will be sufficient.
Mr Smith: Is that all doctor?
Doctor:
Oh yes, I won't give you any antibiotics, as you ha ven't got bronchitis. You'll see that
with the pres- -cription I've given you, you'll feel better in a few days. Don't forget your prescription.
Mr Smith: Thank you, doctor.
Doctor: Goodbye. You'll feel better soon.
Mr Smith: Goodbye, doctor.
A. Questions
1. When did Mr Smith last visit his doctor? 2. Did Mr Smith have an operation the last time he
visited the doctor? 3. What's wrong with Mr Smith? 4. How long has he had a headache? 5. Has he
got a high temperature? 6. Has he been coughing a lot? 7. Has Mr Smith got bronchitis? 8. What
medicine does the doctor prescribe? 9. When should he take the pills? 10. Did Mr Smith almost
forget anything?
B. Study the reported version of the conversation:
Mr Smith has an appointment with his doctor. The doctor tells him it has been two years since he
came for a general check-up Today, he explains to the doctor that he has a sore throat and a headache
and that he is coughing a bit. The doctor asks him if he has taken his temperature. Mr Smith tells him
he has, and that it was 38.2 this morning. After the examination the doctor reassures him and tells
him there is nothing wrong with his lungs, and he prescribes some njedicine which Mr Smith should
take. He says he will not give him any antibiotics as he has not got bronchitis, and with the pills and
the syrup he should be better in a few days. As Mr Smith leaves, the doctor tells him not to forget his
prescription and says he hopes Mr Smith will feel better soon.
C. Report the conversation in the past.
D. Roleplay the conversation. Make a similar conversation.
326

At the Doctor's Suegeey


Mr Pale hasn't been feeling very well lately. He has just waited forty-five minutes to see the doctor
and now he is with the doctor in his surgery.
Doctor: Good evening. Sit down. Yes? What's wrong?
Mr Pale: Doctor, I haven't been feeling well for the last few weeks.
Doctor: And what exactly is the matter?
Mr Pale: Well, I've got a slight headache.
Doctor: Anything else?
Mr Pale: In the mornings I sometimes have a pain in my chest.
Doctor: Uh-huh. Any other problems?
Mr Pale: Sometimes my back hurts.
Doctor: I see. OK. Well, I'm just going to examine you... open your mouth... say "ah".
Mr Pale: Ah!
Doctor: Right. Have you been worrying much recently?
Mr Pale: Perhaps a little bit, yes.
Doctor: Mmm. Have you been sleeping all right?
Mr Pale: No, actually doctor, I haven't.
Doctor: What about your appetite? Have you been eating properly?
Mr Pale: Yes, I think so.
Doctor: So you haven't lost any weight recently?
Mr Pale: No, I don't think so.
Doctor: What do you do?
Mr Pale: I'm a teacher.
Doctor: And are you happy in your work?
Mr Pale: Well, not really, doctor.
Doctor: Look. Here's a prescription.
Mr Pale: Thank you.
Doctor: Take one of these before you go to bed each night. Try to stop worrying and come and see

me in two weeks.
Mr Pale: Thank you, doctor. Goodbye.
Doctor: Goodbye.
A- Ask and answer questions on the text.
327

B. Report the conversation.


C. Roleplay the conversation.
D. Imagine you have a medical problem, answer the doctor s questions.
What's the Trouble?
Mr Williams: Good morning, doctor.
Doctor:
Hello, Mr Williams. Take a seat. What seems
to be the trouble? Mr Williams: I'm not sure, doctor. But I haven't been feeling
too well. I think I must have a touch of flu. Doctor:
Mm. There's a lot of it going round at the
moment. What are the symptoms?
Mr Williams: I'm feeling very tired, and I'm aching all over. I've been sneezing a lot, and feeling
pretty feverish, hot and cold all the time. Oh, and I've got a sore throat.
Doctor:
Any vomiting?
Mr Williams: No, but I don't feel very hungry. I've got no appetite at all.
Doctor: Well, let's have a look at you. Open your mouth. "Aah". Yes, your throat's a bit inflamed; and
the glands in your neck are swollen. Can you just unbutton your shirt? I want to listen to your chest.
Breathe deeply. Right. I'll just take your temperature. Don't say anything for a minute, just keep the
thermometer under your tongue. I'll write out a prescription for you, but you know the best thing is
just to go home, go to bed, and take plenty of fluids.
A. Ask and answer questions on the text.
B. Report the conversation.
C. Roleplay the conversation.
D. Situation: You haven't been feeling well lately. At the moment you are being examined by the
doctor.
328
What's the Problem?
Doctor: Come in. Do sit down. Now, what's the problem? Woman: I just can't sleep at night any
more. I don't know what
to do. I feel so tired all the time. Doctor: Do you take any exercise during the day? Woman: No, not
really. Doctor: Well, the first thing you should try to do is to take some
sort of exercise during the day. Maybe walk for twenty minutes or so. Woman: Mmm. I see. Doctor:
Then you should try to relax before you go to bed.
Make a hot drink, watch television, have a bath and
then go to bed. Woman: I usually have a cup of tea before I go to bed. Is that all
right? Doctor: No, you really oughtn't to drink tea or coffee late at
night. They both contain caffeine and it keeps you
awake.
Woman: I see. What about sleeping pills? Doctor: Well, I really don't think you need to try sleeping
pills yet...
A. Study and practise the conversation.
B. Situation: You're at the doctor's. The doctor is giving you some pieces of advice.
C. Ask students to work in pairs and give a suitable piece of advice for someone who:
1. wants to make a perfect omelette
2. is planning to drive his/her car in snowy conditions
3. is going for a job interview
4. wants to come to your country to work
5. wants to take care of his/her teeth
6. wants to start a garden
329

Listening
The Doctor's Advice
One day an old man went to see a doctor. The doctor examined him and said, "Medicine won't help
you. You must have a rest. Go to a quiet country place for a month, go to bed early, drink milk, walk
a lot and smoke only one cigar a day." "Thank you very much," said the old man. "I'll do everything
you say."
A month later the man came to the doctor again. "How do you do?" said the doctor. "I'm very glad to
see you. You look much younger." "Oh, doctor," said the man, "I'm quite well now. I had a good rest.
I went to bed early. I drank a lot of milk, I walked a lot. Your advice certainly helped me. But you
told me to smoke one cigar a day and that one cigar a day almost killed me at first. It's no joke to start
smoking at my age."
A. Questions
I. Where did the old man go one day? 2. What did the doctor advise him to do? 3. Did the old man
follow his advice? 4. Did he have a good rest? 5. But there was one thing that troubled him. What
was it?
A. Skiing holiday
Robert was skiing down a mountain with a tall, beautiful American girl. Her name was Isabel and he
had met her only the day before. Isabel was a very good skier. The ski run twisted and turned but she
went round all the curves very fast. Robert tried to do the same.
Suddenly, he fell. He felt a sharp pain in his ankle while he was lying in the snow. Isabel came back.
Another skier, a handsome young man, stopped as well. The two of them helped Robert to get back
to the hotel. There was a doctor there.
The doctor was a Scotsman. He was married to a Swiss girl. That was why he was working in
Switzerland.
"Hmm," he said when he saw Robert's ankle, and shook his head.
"I haven't broken it, have I?" Robert asked hopefully.
"No, but you've twisted it badly."
"You mean I've sprained it?"
330
"Yes, I'm afraid so. And it's badly bruised and swollen," the doctor answered, pointing to the dark
blue marks on Robert's ankle, which was now getting bigger.
Robert lay back with a groan. No more skiing for him! Just then he heard Isabel laughing on the
terrace. He could see her. She was smiling at the young man.
A. Questions
1. What was Robert doing when he fell? 2. What happened then? 3. Who was Isabel? 4. How did
Robert get back to the hotel? 5. Was Robert seriously injured? 6. What else disappointed him?
At the Dentist's
The tooth had been bothering David for some time. He knew he should have gone to the dentist's
earlier. But in spite of the pain he had put it off. He always put off going to the dentist as long as
possible.
The dentist smiled pleasantly at first. David told him that the tooth had kept him awake the night
before. Then the dentist looked into his mouth, but he did not look only at the one tooth. Instead he
looked them all over.
"Hmm," he said. "I'm afraid several of your teeth need seeing to." He smiled again. But this time it
was a rather grim smile. He began to describe exactly what needed doing. David listened to him with
a kind of sick feeling in his stomach.
"I should say that at least four teeth have cavities and then some of your old fillings are loose. We'll
have to see to them immediately!" David asked about the tooth that had been aching. "I may be able
to save it," the dentist said, and smiled grimly again. He got his electric drill ready. "Now," he said
with another grim smile, "this shouldn't hurt too much."
A. Questions
1. Why had David gone to the dentist's? 2. What had he pui off? 3. What was the first thing the
dentist did? 4. What did he tell David? 5. What exactly was the work that needed doing? 6. What
happened then?

331
Dr'Jones and his Patient
The telephone rang and Dr Jones took up the receiver. His patient's servant asked him to come to
their place. "I can do nothing with the old man," he said and the doctor agreed to come at once.
He had thought much about his patient since his last visit and knew what the matter was. His patient,
a rich old man, liked to buy things at high prices. In a short period of time he had spent very much
money. His friends were afraid that he would soon be penniless, that's why they wanted the doctor to
do something to stop him.
The doctor was thinking about it when he entered his patient's house that day. ''Good morning," he
greeted the old man. "How are you today? I want to tell you something." The old man who was
sitting in an armchair turned to him. "What is it? More medicine or some other idea?" he asked.
"Would you like to stuJ> art?" asked the doctor. "It will do your health much good." "Why should I, I
don't understand it," the old man answered. "It doesn't matter. You must study it. I can get a student
from an art school who will come here once a week and give you lessons," the doctor said. His
patient agreed.
A few days later the doctor found an art student who was glad to accept his offer. Five dollars a
lesson was not bad at all. The next morning the lessons began. The old man studied hard and often
visited art exhibitions. He even stopped buying things at high prices. He decided to exhibit one of his
own pictures. It was a very bad picture and the doctor could not understand why the exhibition
accepted it.
Some days passed. One morning the old man received a letter. "Read it to me," he asked the doctor,
"I'm tired." "Your picture has received the first prize," the doctor said. "Now I believe, you like art
more than anything else." "Oh, no! Art is nothing!" said the old man. "I've bought the exhibition."
A. Questions
1. What was the matter with Dr Jones's patient? 2. What did the doctor suggest his patient should do?
3. Did the old man agree to study art? 4. Did he stop buying things at high prices? 5. What were the
old man's results in studying art? 6. Why did the old man's picture receive the first prize?
332
American Business
This story is about an American general who was a very important person in the American Army
during the First World War. Everybody in the United States knew him and many people wanted to
have his photo or any other of his things in then- homes. When the war was over the general returned
home. He lived in Washington and worked in the office in which he had worked before the war. His
health was poor. Very often he had a terrible toothache.
One day he went to a dentist. The dentist pulled out his six bad teeth. A week later the general heard
that some shops were selling his extracted teeth. One tooth cost 5 dollars. On each of the teeth there
was a label with the name of the general.
The general became very angry. He did not know what to do. Then an idea came to his mind. He told
his six officers to go around the city and buy all his extracted teeth.
The officers left the office in the morning and visited a lot of shops in the capital. They were running
from shop to shop all day long. In the evening they returned to the office and put all the teeth on the
table in front of the general. They had bought 175 teeth.
A. Questions
1. Why was the general so popular? 2. What did he do after the war? 3. What happened to him one
day? 4. What did the dentist do? 5. What made the general very angry? 6. What did he do? 7. How
many teeth did the officers buy?
The Doctor's help
There was a bookseller who did not like paying for anything. One day he let a big box of books fall
on his foot.
"Go to the doctor," said his wife, "and show that foot to him."
"No," he said. "I'll wait until the doctor comes into the shop next time. Then I'll ask him about my
foot. If I go to see him, I shall have to pay him."
On the next day the doctor came into the shop and bought some books. When the bookseller was
getting them ready, he told the doctor about his bad foot. The doctor looked at it.
"Yes," said the doctor. "You must put that foot in hot water every night. Then you must put

something on it."
333
He took out a piece of paper and wrote on it. "Buy this and put it on the foot before you go to bed
every night," he said.
"Thank you," said the bookseller. "And now, sir, here are your books."
"How much?" said the doctor.
"Two pounds."
"Good," said the doctor. "I shall not have to pay you anything."
"Why?" asked the bookseller.
"I told you about your foot. I want two pounds for that. If people come to my house, I ask them to
pay one pound for a small thing like that. But when I go to their houses, I want two pounds. And I
came here, didn't I? Good morning."
A. Questions
1. What happened to the bookseller one day? 2. Why didn't he want to go to the doctor? 3.When did
the doctor come to the shop? 4. What advice did he give the bookseller? 5. Why did the doctor refuse
to pay for the books?

Reading
Food and health
Scientists say their studies show that some foods may help prevent, possibly even treat, some
diseases such as cancer and disorders of the heart and blood system. And their advice is similar for
both. We would be much healthier if we sharply cut the amount of fatty, salty and sweet foods that
we eat. We also should limit the amount of alcohol we drink. And we should eat more fresh fruit and
vegetables, and foods that are high in fiber and m vitamins A and C.
Cancer and heart experts all agree. Eat less fat. This includes fatty red meats and poultry, whole eggs,
whole milk and other dairy products, and cooking oils. Studies seem to show that people who eat
large amounts of fat face an increased danger of suffering breast or colon cancers. Breast cancer is
rare in Japan, where little fat is eaten. But in the United States, where much fat is eaten, breast cancer
is a major killer. One study in England and Wales found a reduced rate of breast and colon cancer
during World War Two when people did not eat foods rich in sugar,
334

meat and fat. But the cancer rate rose after the war when such foods were available again.
Doctors also say eating less fat will reduce the amount of dangerous cholesterol in the blood. This
cholesterol can stick to the wall of blood passages blocking the flow of blood. In the arteries that
carry blood to the heart muscle, such blockages cause a heart attack. Instead, eat more foods low in
fat. This includes low-fat milk and dairy products, lean meats, poultry without the skin, and fish and
shellfish. Experts also say cooking foods in olive oil, canola oil and fish oil will help lower
cholesterol. And they say it is best to steam, bake, roast or broil foods, not to fry. They also say eating
dried peas and beans helps lower the amount of fat in the blood.
Health experts also say we should eat more fruit and vegetables, and foods high in fibers such as
whole grain breads and cereals and brown rice. Some fibers help lower levels of dangerous
cholesterol. This would help reduce the danger of heart disease. Most experts agree that fiber can
protect against cancer. They are not sure how fiber does this. Some believe it helps the body to
quickly remove fat that may cause cancer to develop.
Medical experts also say some vegetables seem to contain agents that block cancer. These include
asparagus, Brussels sprouts, cabbage, cauliflower, kale and mustard greens.
Other studies show that persons who eat large amounts of foods that contain the substance betacarotene are less likely than others to develop cancers in the skin, lung, bladder, breast and colon.
Vegetables with beta-carotene include beet greens, bell peppers, carrots, kale, lettuce, spinach, sweet
potatoes and tomatoes. Fruits that contain the substance include apricots, cantaloupes, cherries,
papaya and watermelon.
The body changes beta-carotene to vitamin A. Some health experts say eating more foods with
vitamin A may also help protect against cancer. These include liver, eggs and dairy products.
The experts also agree. Cut the amount of salt in your food. Salt helps raise blood pressure. High
blood pressure is linked to heart disease. We also should eat much less smoked and salt-cured foods.
This includes ham, smoked fish, sausages, bacon and bologna.

Health experts say we should drink only moderate amounts of alcohol. Researchers say large
amounts of alcohol seem to
335
increase the danger of cancer. This seems especially true if the person smokes cigarettes.
Margaret's Job
Margaret Oliver works in a hospital. Here she talks about her job. 1
I'm a physiotherapist. My job is to help people who have been injured. Many of my patients have had
road accidents. I show them how to walk again, or move their arms, or bend their backs. It's a
difficult job and not very well paid, but it's very interesting. I really love it. The only thing I don't like
is the long hours. Sometimes I come home from work so tired that I just fall asleep in front of the
television. I'm too tired to go out even with my boyfriend, Joe. He doesn't like it when I work late.
He says I work too hard, but he doesn't understand that a physiotherapist has to work hard If she
doesn't, her patients won't get better.
Q What is the only disadvantage about Margaret's job? 2
Of course, working in the hospital isn't always enjoyable. Some days nothing goes right and then it's
very frustrating. I get annoyed when nurses don't do what I tell them to do. Some of the young ones
don't seem to listen to what I say. That makes me angry. I feel quite depressed sometimes. But then
one of my patients comes back to see me. That happened yesterday. It was a young girl who had
smashed her arm in a bad accident. We sat in my room and had a cup of coffee. She told me she was
back at work and she showed me how well she could move her arm now. That really cheered me up.
It always does.
Q What makes Margaret depressed? 3
The hospital I work in is about forty miles from London. It's quite old, but it's got all the latest
equipment. I like most of the people I work with they're super. My patients are super too. And
some are very interesting. Last week, for instance, I had a
336
young footballer called Don. He had broken his leg in three places, jfe was afraid he would never
play football again. I had to tell him that he would soon get better. I told him to be patient and not to
worry. A physiotherapist has to do that quite often reassure her patients, I mean.
Q What did Margaret tell Don? 4
Working with older people is much more difficult. They take much longer to get better. A lot of the
older patients don't want to leave hospital at all. They feel safe there and they have lots of friends.
When they go home they feel very lonely. They miss their friends. I go and visit them at home when
I can, but it's hard to get the time. Some of them will never really get well again. I feel sorry for
them, but you can't show them how you feel. You've just got to be cheerful and do what you can. I
always try to do my best for all my patients. You can't do more than that, can you?
Q Why do sonic of the older patients want to stay in hospital?
Margaret Oliver describes a day in her life. 1
I normally getup at seven o'clock, but today Ididn't have to start work until half-past eight, so I stayed
in bed for another half-hour. That was lovely. I switched on the radio and just listened to it with my
eyes closed. Then I got up, washed, and had breakfast. Usually, I just have some cereal, but today I
made myself a proper breakfast: orange juice, a boiled egg, tea, and toast.
I left home at a quarter past eight. My flat isn't far from the hospital. In the summer, I sometimes
walk to work. But if the weather's bad, I often drive to work. This morning it was cold and wet, so I
drove to work.
Q What does Margaret mean by "a proper breakfast"? Why was she able to have "a proper breakfast"
today?
2
My first job this morning was to see a patient who had hurt his back. He'd lifted a bag of potatoes
and hurt himself because he hadn't
337

picked it up correctly. I gave him some heat treatment and told him to get as much rest as possible.
Then it was time for what I call my "knee class". These are people who have all injured their knees in
some way. I show them exercises that will strengthen their knees They're a great group and we
always have lots of fun together.

Q Describe Margaret's "knee class". 3


At twelve-thirty I had lunch in the canteen. I didn't eat much because I've put on some weight
recently and I want to take it off before the summer. I just had a cup of coffee and an apple.
After lunch, I went to see my favourite patient, Edie. She's eighty-five now and she's got a bad chest.
I'm sure she'll never leave hospital now. I can't really do much for her, but she always likes to see me.
She doesn't say very much, but she loves to hear what I've been doing. I was just telling her about my
"knee class" when Nurse Walker came in. She said that Mrs Callan, the head physiotherapist, wanted
to see me. I tried to find out what she wanted, but Nurse Walker said she didn't know. So I said
goodbye to Edie and went to see Mrs Callan, wondering why she wanted to see me.
Q Who is Margaret's favourite patient?

Self check
I. The following passage is about Uncle Tom, who is a hypochondriac (a person who always thinks he is
ill). Change the word or words in brackets into the correct form, where necessary. Sometimes, you must
add other words, usually a preposition.
When Auntie Ivy is ill, she tries to smile about it. She tries not to let the illness (make) her (feel)
unhappy. She fights against it and usually recovers quickly. My uncle Tom, though, is different He
seems (enjoy) grumbling (be) ill, and from the way he speaks you would think that he looks forward
(be) ill. His doctor isn ' very pleased (Uncle Tom visit) him so often. He once said t him, "If every
patient of mine came to visit me as often as you do, I (need) to work 48 hours a day." Of course,
there's nothini
wrong with Uncle Tom. He's in good health, but he can't help (feel) ill; he's that type. Whenever I
visit him, he's busy reading a medical dictionary. The next day he (usually go) to see his doctor, and
describes an illness he has read about. His doctor is used (Uncle Tom describe) all types of illness,
and knows that as long as he (give) him some tablets, Uncle Tom won't come and see him for three or
four days. Uncle Tom is accustomed (take) at least three different tablets a day. We once threw his
new white tablets away and put some sweets, which looked the same, in the bottle instead. Uncle
Tom never noticed the difference, and went on (take) them. A few days later he told us the tablets had
done him a lot of good!
II. Fill in the blanks with articles if necessary.
Henry is (1) clerk in (2) office in (3) town. He's also (4) health freak. He wants to live to be (5)
hundred so (6) health is very important to him. He gets up at five o'clock in the morning and lifts (7)
weights for thirty minutes. For (8) breakfast he eats (9) spinach and (10) raw egg with (11) garlic and
(12) chilli pepper. It tastes disgusting, but he thinks it's good for him. Then he runs for (13) hour in
(14) park, even if (15) weather is bad. He leaves for (16) work at seven o'clock. He never goes by
(17) bus or (18) train and he thinks that (19) cars are extremely dangerous. So he walks everywhere
with (20) mask over his nose and mouth. He also wears (21) uniform which he designed to protect
himself from (22) dust and (23) dirt. At (24) office he washes his hands ten times (25) day and he
wears (26) gloves to pick up (27) telephone in case it's dirty. He takes his lunch to (28) work with
him. He eats fifteen sunflower seeds and one onion. He is sure that (29) lunch which the firm
provides isn't good for him. After (30) work he rushes home to water (31) plants. He has hundreds of
(32) plants because they provide (33) oxygen. In the evening he sometimes listens to (34) radio, but
he never watches (35) television because it might damage his eyesight. On Monday he goes to (36)
deep breathing class and on Thursday he goes to (37) vegetarian cookery class. He rarely goes to (38)
cinema or to (39) theatre there are far too many germs. He goes to (40) bed early. In summer he
sleeps in (41) tent in (42) garden. At (43) weekend he goes camping in (44) country, but he never sits
in (45) sun.
338

339
On (46) first day of every month he goes to (47) doctor's, just to make sure that he isn't ill. After all,
he doesn't want to find himself in (48) hospital.
III. Translate from Russian into English.
1. . , . 2. . .
, . 3. .
, . 4. . , .
? . , . 5.

. , . 6.
. 7. , . 8.
( , ). 9.
? . . . 10.
. . .
. 11. . .
,
. 12. ,
. 13. . ? 14.
() . 15.
. . 16. . ?
? . , .
. 17. .
, . , .
. 39. .
, , ,
. , , .

340

, . ,
. . 18.
. , , . . 19.
. , .


Unit? Exercise I, p. 40
1 do 2 to swim 3 to go, rain 4 repeat 5 leave 6 to smoke 7 (to) move 8 to arrive 9 know 10 wait 11 to
go, make, go 12 to knov,, to live 13 not to inform, (to) disobey 14 to disappoint, let, have 15 to be 16
wish, to make 17 want, to know 18 remember, look 19 to learn, to know 20 to be 21 not to feed 22 to
use, show 23 to sign 24 open/opening, move/moving 25 to make, believe 26 to have missed, go 27
shake/shaking 28 go, promise, not to tell 29 like, to come, walk 30 to ask, to tell, to get 31 to put, (to)
keep 32 to give, see, not to forget 33 open/opening, throw/ throwing 34 to carry, help 35 to obey 36
to cross/crossing, (to) turn/turning 37 to marry 38 to know

Exercise II, p. 41
IB 2C 3D 4D 5C 6D 7B 8B 9A 10A 1 IB 12 13 14A 15D 16 Exercise III, p. 43
I to ride, to do, coming, to come 2 spending, earning 3 being, to apologize 4 to eat 5 working,
spending 6 looking, being 7 posting 8 to lock, go, do 9 to learn, saying 10 trying, to interrupt, to wait,
talking 11 doing, to move/moving 12 leaving/to leave, to go 13 being, to wait 14 trying, to make,
adding 15 going, stay 16 getting up, walking 17 listening, listening 18 to make/making, to see 19
doing 20 to put, to prevent, climbing 21 taking, to eat 22 ringing, asking, to do 23 waiting, to clear, to
set 24 repeat, to make, to do 25 leaving, sending, to tow 26 borrowing, asking, to do 27 to offend,
annoying28 getting, to walk 29 to ask, to leave 30 setting, having been 31 to go, (to)try, to save,
cutting 32 earn, scrubbing, make, blackmailing 33 to turn 34 carrying 35 not listening 36 cleaning 37
looking, to answer 38 postponing 39 to go camping 40 to take, to pay 41 to stand 42 not to wait 43
waiting, doing 44 talking 45 to play, not to make 46 to look after 47 paying 48 not
342

to smoke 49 not to know/not knowing 50 whistling, to concentrate 5] to turn off 52 to renew 53 not
to wait 54 not to play 55 to call 56 dropping, hitchhiking, trying, to find 57 to ask, to tell, to
remember, to bring 58 to do 59 worrying 60 taking 61 to buy 62 being 63 promising, to visit 64 being
laughed 65 not telling 66 to be fooled 67 to tell, to be told 68 being told 69 being photographed 70 to
have had 71 sending/to be sent 72 to have recovered, to be 73 having had 74 having 75 not having
been told, to be informed 76 washing/to be washed 77 to be asked 78 telling 79 beating 80 not being
81 to be awarded 82 to accept 83 to travel, (to) leave 84 to be liked, (to) be trusted 85 wondering 86
driving/having driven 87 to have been chosen 88 living 89 to take 90 to let 91 hearing 92 driving, to
drive/to be driving 93 to get 94 not being 95 ring/ ringing 96 coming/come 97 knock/knocking 98

walk, open, get in 99 to lend 100 write 101 to be, not to hear 102 to be 103 looking 104 to have 105
to get 106 to wear 107 paying 108 to watch 109 not to turn 110 not to go 111 taking

Exercise IV, p. 46
Infinitive as subject, complement of subject
1. It is useful to do morning exercises every day. 2. It's difficult to study a foreign language. 3. It's
pleasant to swim and lie in the sun on such a fine day. 4. It's interesting to meet new people. 5. Not to
warn him of this would be dishonest. 6. It's necessary for us to see him today. 7. It's difficult for me
to understand him. 8. It's difficult for a child to sit still for a long time. 9. It's not polite to interrupt
the speaker. 10. It was difficult for us to receive this information. 11. It's dangerous to swim here. 12.
It was necessary for him to return at once. 13. It's important to have good friends. 14. It'll take you
twenty minutes to get to the station. 15. Which is more difficult to read English or to write English?
16. It's interesting to play tennis. 17. It's important for students to do their homework. 18. It's
interesting to learn something about a new culture. 19. Is it easy to learn driving? 20. It'a dangerous
to walk alone at night in this part of the city. 21. It's difficult for us to do this work in such a short
period of time. 22. It's difficult for her to climb these stairs. 23. How long will it take you to complete
the experiment? 24. Our plan was to save the children. 25. My
343

aim is to become a good teacher. 26. Our duty is to help our old parents. 27. My advice to you is not to
spend so much time on sports. 28. The first thing to do is to consult a doctor. 29. It is too late to send the
letter. The only thing left for us to do is to send a telegram. 30. My wish is to win the match. 31. His plan
is to learn swimming. 32. The only chance to see him is to go to the library. He comes there almost every
day. 33. The best thing for you to do is to apologize to her. 34. The first thing I want to do is to have a
good rest. 35. The only thing I want now is to be left in peace and quiet, (not to be bothered) 36. My
advice to you is not to invite him to the party. 37. My dream now is to be fishing somewhere in a little
village.
Verb + infinitive
1.1 tried to fall asleep but I couldn't. 2. He agreed to wait another two days. 3. My brother promised to
visit me tomorrow. 4. I'm going (intend) to return on Saturday. 5.1 forgot to close the safe. 6. He hopes to
pass his exam. 7.1 learned to play the piano when I was ten years old. 8. We arranged to meet outside the
theatre at 7 o'clock. 9.1 can't afford to buy such an expensive thing. 10.1 want to stay at home and have a
rest today. 11. He decided not to go to the south this year. 12.1 managed to complete the work in time. 13.
Don't forget to send the telegram. 14. I didn't want (mean) to hurt you. 15. He refused to take part in the
competition. 16.1 am planning to have a party . Ann offered to help me and I'm very grateful to her. 17.
He threatened to tell my parents. 18.1 want to complete the experiment on Friday. 19. I need to have your
opinion. 20. She didn't manage to find him at home. 21.1 didn't want to go to the meeting, but I had to.
seem/happen/appear/prove/pretend + infinitive
1. He pretended to be sleeping. 2. They seem to be waiting for you downstairs. 3. The plan proved to be a
success. 4. My friend seems to be having a good time at the seaside. 5. He appeared (proved) to be a good
engineer. 6. He happened to look in that direction and saw a man run out of the house. 7. The question
appears to be of great importance to them. 6. He seems to know all about this matter. 9. He seemed to be
willing to do it himself'
344

10. The results of the test seemed to have disappointed them. 11. He didn't appear to be surprised at the
news. 12. She seems to have been waiting for a long time. 13. She happens to know him. 14.1 happened
to leave the office early that day. 15. This plant seems to have been producing such equipment since 1986.
16. There seem to be no obj ections to their proposal. 17. There proved to be another solution of the
problem. 18. There happened to be a surgeon among them. 19. He appears to know this subject very well.
20. He seems to have read a lot on this problem. 21. This book seems to be very interesting. 22. He seems
to be angry with me. 23. Yesterday we happened to meet Mr Green. 24. He seems to be ill. 25. They seem
to have been using this reference book. 26. He happened to be at home at that time. 27. He appeared
(proved) to be a very experienced worker. 28. He pretended to be working hard. 29. All the students seem
to have read this article. 30. He seems to have been ill all this time. 31. He seems to be satisfied with the
results of his work. 32. He seems to have left for the south. 33. The box seems to be empty. 34. He proved
(appeared) to be a good sportsman. 35.1 happened to meet him in Sochi. 36. This task proved to be very
difficult. 37.1 happened to hear him ask her about it. 38. There seem to be a lot of interesting articles in
this magazine. 39. There seem to be a lot of foreign books in this library. 40. He doesn't seem to be very
clever. 41. He doesn't seem to know French. 42. They didn't seem to be interested in that problem. 43.

They didn't appear to be experienced teachers.


Verb + object + infinitive
1. She asked me to read the letter carefully and write a reply to it.
2. Will you help me (to) carry this bag? 3. My son asked me to let him go to the cinema. 4. The man told
me not to walk on the grass. 5. Let me help you with your work. 6. You must make him practise an hour
every day. 7. He was made to come. 8. She was made to obey. 9. The captain ordered the sailors to wash
the deck. 10. He got (persuaded) me to join them. 11. The customers asked the sellers to reduce the price.
12. The representative of the firm asked the manager to send the letters by air-mail. 13. My brother taught
me to cycle. 14. My friend advised me to take up tennis. 15. My mother didn't let me swim. 16. He
warned me to be careful. 17. The teacher told us not to write in the margins. 18.1 couldn't
345

persuade her to accept my suggestion. 19. My father forbade me to use his car. 20.1 got him to help her.
21.1 asked the typist to type some letters. 22. He allowed the children to have a swim. 23. We invited
them to join us. 24.1 reminded my sister to bring my dictionary. 25. He persuaded me to take up sports.
26. We were not allowed to use a dictionary. 27. They made him tell the truth. 28. She begged the doctors
to save her child. 29. I was allowed to use the library. 30. He was made to help her.
I want you to come.
1. I'd like you to wait for me here. 2. He wants his son to become a teacher. 3. We didn't expect him to
come so early. 4. Everybody expected them to get married. 5. Do you want me to help you? 6.1 want his
article to be published. 7. The doctor doesn't want me to go to the south. 8. The captain wanted the goods
to be loaded at once. 9. Where do you want me to wait for you? 10.1 expected him to help me. 11. She
doesn't like her children to do their homework at night 12.1 want you to take this article and translate it.
13. Nobody expected the weather to change so suddenly. 14.1 want you to be happ\ 15. Did you expect
him to write to you? 16.1 would like him to take part in our expedition. 17. He likes the students to ask
him questions. 18. He didn't expect them to come so early.
I know him to be an honest man.
1. I know him to be a very experienced teacher. 2. I consider myself to be right. 3.1 think this question to
be very important. 4.1 think him to be very clever. 5. Do you think him to be an experienced doctor? 6. I
believe this information to be very important. 7.1 find him to be too self-assured. 8.1 believe him to know
the truth. 9. I believe him to be an honest and a reliable friend 10.1 think this article to be of great interest.
He is said/supposed/thought, etc. to be clever.
1. He's supposed to be in London. 2. The winter is expected to be cold this year. 3. This house is supposed
to have been built about two hundred years ago. 4. The fire is thought to have started at night. 5. He was
supposed to have left already. 6. He is known to
346

have a different opinion on this problem. 7. The expedition is reported to have left on the 15th of May. 8.
The treaty is expected to be signed this week. 9. He is considered to be one of the best surgeons in our
country. 10. The delegation was reported to arrive at night. 11. lie is supposed to know this problem very
well. 12. He is said (supposed) to have been married before. 13. They are expected to reach their
destination on time. 14. The conference was reported to take place in Paris. 15. He is known to be a good
specialist in the field of electronics. 16. He is expected to be invited to the conference.
The infinitive of purpose
1. All was done to save him. 2. He called for his car to take us to the station. 3.1 got up at six o'clock so as
not to miss the morning train. 4.1 wrote a letter to him to remind him of his promise. 5. The child ran out
to meet his mother. 6. He was walking slowly in order not to fall dow 7. She did all to please him. 8. I'll
write down your telephone number in order not to forget it. 9.1 came to talk to you about a very important
matter. 10. Put on your warm coat so as not to catch cold. 11. He went to the library to take the journals
and books he needs for his history exam. 12. He lay down on the sofa to have a short rest. 13. He put his
key into his brief-case so as not to lose it. 14. She always has a walk in the evening to sleep better at
night. 15. He read the rule several times to understand it better. 16. He was writing the dictation very
carefully so as not to make mistakes. 17.1 have come to say goodbye to you.
The infinitive after adjectives
1. He was afraid to forget about his promise. 2. I'm glad to have followed your advice. 3. I'm sorry not to
have seen this play. 4. He Was delighted to see her at the party. 5. We were surprised to see him at your
house. 6. He was disappointed not to have got a ticket for the concert. 7. It's very kind of you to help me.
8. It was stupid of him to behave like that. 9. The child is too small to understand your joke. 10. He's
clever enough to do this work. 11. It was too late to change anything. 12. This suitcase is too heavy for

me to lift. 13. It was not warm enough to swim. 14. I'm too
347

tired to go to the cinema today. 15. It was light enough to read. 16. He was the last to leave the
laboratory. 17. He was the second to answer. 18.1 was the first to come. 19. He is hard to please. 20.
She's hard to deal with. 21. She's pleasant to look at. 22. He has changed a lot. He is difficult to
recognize. 23. He is good at dancing. He is pleasant to dance with.
The infinitive after nouns
1. Have we got anything tasty to serve for dessert? 2. There are still many things to pack (to be
packed). 3.1 have no time to visit her today. 4. He is not the man to worry about trifles. 5. Have you
got any friends to help you? 6. She has a sick child to look after 7.1 shall be busy this week; I have a
lot of things to do. 8. She will always find something to laugh at. 9. There was nothing to worry
about. The sick man felt better. 10. This is just the man to speak to on this problem. 11.1 have no
desire to go to the south. 12. His offer to help surprised us. 13.1 was surprised at his refusal to come
with us.
The infinitive after question words
1.1 have no idea how to help her. 2.1 didn't know where to spend my holiday. 3. Could you tell me
how to get to Independence Square? 4.1 couldn't decide whether to go home or to spend the night in
the country house. 5. She explained to me how to make the salad. 6. I can't decide what to wear at the
party. 7. I don't know when to begin planting potatoes. 8.1 don't know where to buy this book. 9. I
have no idea how to drive a car. 10. I don't know what to give him for his birthday.
See someone do and see someone doing
1. I have never heard him speak French. 2. He didn't hear me knock at (on) the door. 3.1 hear that he
has already returned to Minsk. 4. I've never seen him swim, but I've heard he swims very well. 5.1
saw that she didn't understand the rule and I decided to explain it to her once again. 6. She saw him
enter the house and she went downstairs to meet him. 7.1 heard somebody singing in the next room.
8.1 saw the taxi stop at the door. 9. For a while
348
I watched the children playing in the garden. 10.1 saw her enter the room, switch on the light and sit
down at the table. 11. Nobody noticed her leave the room. 12. He saw that she was very pale.
13. I'd like to see her dancing/dance. 14. I saw the sun set and dark clouds cover the sky. 15.1 saw
him come up to them and say something. 16.1 heard the door open and saw someone enter the room.
17.1 saw her walking in the garden.
likely/imlikely/certain/sure + infinitive
1. The weather is likely to change tomorrow. 2. This question is very likely to be discussed at today's
meeting. 3. He is not likely to come here. 4. The negotiations are very likely to end at the beginning
of May. 5. He is likely to be at home at 6 o'clock. 6. They are not likely to return soon. 7. It is very
likely to rain tomorrow. 8. He is sure to marry her. 9. She is sure to come. 10. Their suggestion is not
likely to be accepted. 11. His article is certain to be published in the newspaper. 12. They are not
likely to come before the 1st of September. 13. He is certain to like his new job.
14. The tourists are not likely to reach the top of the mountain.
15. The delegation is likely to stay in Moscow for some more days. 16. They are not likely to
complete their work by the end of May. 17. She is certain to take part in the competition. 18. The
goods are sure to be delivered at the end of the week.
Would rather/had better + infinitive
1. I'm very tired. I'd rather stay at home tonight. 2. The film is starting in ten minutes. I'd better hurry
up. 3. It is a fine day today. Shall we go to the beach or would you rather go to the country? 4. Would
you like to watch TV? I'd rather listen to some music. 5. You look pale and tired. You'd better
consult a doctor. 6.1 would rather take a taxi than go to the station by bus. 7. She is hurt. You'd better
apologize to her. 8. When are you going to have a holiday this year? I'd rather have it in August.
I'd better go to the seaside this year. 9. I'd rather wait for a bus than go on foot. 10. Let's go to the
south in summer. I'd rather go on a tourist trip to England. 11. You'd better book the tickets in
advance. Yes, certainly. 12. Why don't we stay at our relatives'? I don't want to. I'd rather stay
at a hotel. 13. You'd
349
better translate this text tomorrow morning, it's too late now. I want to finish it today. 14. Would you

like to go to the circus? No, thank you. I'd rather go to the cinema. 15. You'd better phone him first.
All right. I'll do that. 16. You'd better leave your luggage in the left luggage office. I'll certainly do
that, thank you.

Unit 8 Exercise I, p. 139


do you by any chance know; should/would like, have just heard, would exactly suit, doesn't apply, won't
get; saw, was just leaving/ had just left; said, was going, promised, (had) found; have heard, don't even
know, went; know, should/would be, would phone (a formal request); have tried, doesn't seem

Exercise II, p. 139


to starting; of the new typist's taking; on her not eating; to travel; in spoiling; not to pay; in being; (in)
reading; of having; about catching; on reading; at doing; of going; (in) worrying; to buy; to his daughter's
getting; to travelling; in being; to go; to give up; to get on

Exercise III, p. 140


I wouldn't have wanted to try something different 2 there would have been family problems 3 I hadn't
been careful 4 there would have been accidents 5 hadn't had 6 would have got bored 7 hadn't been 8 we
would have complained about it 9 we hadn't been comfortable 10 wouldn't have worked so well 11 we
had worked longer than three weeks 12 hadn't left the factory 13 wouldn't have felt

Unit 9 Exercise I, p. 145


I has been eaten 2 was being cleaned 3 hadn' t been invited/weren4 invited 4 is produced 5 has been stolen
6 had all been sold 7 ate
350
spoken 8 was built 9 are being washed 18 was broken into 11 was being repaired 12 was television
invented 13 is used 14 has been repainted 15 was played 16 are exported 17 is played 18 was frightened
19 was damaged 20 has been broken 21 haven't been typed 22 is surrounded 23 was invented 24 will be
built 25 was divided 26 is worn 27 had been caused 28 is expected 29 will be completed 30 are televised
31 is visited 32 were being tested 33 was offered 34 was killed, was reported 35 was made 36 are taught
37 was performed 38 was written, was written 39 was invented 40 was the room cleaned 41 was the
window broken 42 has anybody been injured 43 was bitten 44 are these rooms cleaned 45 are shown 46
was made 47 was born, were you born 48 will have been typed 49 was seen 50 will be sent 51 is being
shown 52 has been offered, has been awarded 53 is grown 54 was told 55 have you been sent 56 will be
served 57 is being given 58 will be sent 59 has been paid 60 have just been watered 61 will be announced
62 was being pulled 63 was written 64 will be invited 65 was suggested 66 had been returned 67 will
have been made 68 is that course taught, is not taught 69 is being painted 70 was interviewed 71 was
discovered

Exercise , p. 151
I was stolen, entered 2 created 3 was discussed 4 won, was assassinated 5 arrived, was interviewed 6 will
be given, was announced 7 were taken 8 will probably be won 9 saw, was interviewed 16 are controlled,
are determined 11 blew, didn't want, had cost 12 is being treated 13 was caught, was being chased,
jumped, kept 14 appeared, are named and described, are discovered 15 is read 16 was interrupted 17
belongs 18 is delivered 19 is not pronounced 20 happened 21 arrived, was met 22 heard, was surprised,
was shocked 23 will be built 24 was discovered 25 was your bike stolen 26 have you paid, will be shut off
27 has happened 28 is, is visited, was designed, was erected, has been, is recognized 29 is being repaired
30 was being repaired 31 has already been hired 32 are manufactured 33 will be told 34 will exhibit 35
was being/was assisted 36 did you buy, didn't buy, was given, do you like 37 applied, was hired 38 had
already been rented 39 will be interviewed, has collected 40 have complained, has been done 41 is being
redecorated 42 hadn't been wound 43 was being/ was broadcast, heard, happened 44 were served 45 has
been training
351
46 graduated, had been offered 47 finish/have finished 48 are returned, will be given 49 began, were
allowed 50 have already been typed 51 is being done 52 are still considering 53 happened 54 agree 55 is
accomplished 56 will be finished

Exercise IV, p. 153


1 is closed 2 was closed 3 is made 4 is shut 5 is finished 6 are turned on 7 is not crowded 8 is stuck 9 was
stuck 10 is made, is swept, are washed 11 is set, are done, are lit 12 is gone 13 is torn 14 is hidden 15 am
lost 16 am exhausted 17 are excited 18 is dressed 19 are turned off 20 are divorced 21 am confused 22 am
married 23 is gone 24 is spoiled 25 is located 26 is it plugged in 27 am accustomed 28 am satisfied 29 am
not acquainted 30 is known 31 is equipped

Exercise V, p. 154
1. This film is much spoken about. I think it is worth seeing. 2. He is very angry. He has never been
spoken to like that before. 3. You won't have to wait. When you come the documents will have been
checked and the letters will have been typed. 4. The novel is (was) written by a young talented writer. 5.
Don't say such things. You'll be laughed at. 6. When the director came everything was ready: the
documents had been checked and the letters had been typed. 7. Why is it so cold in the reading room?
It is just being aired. The reading room is aired several times a day. 8. He is a qualified doctor. He is
highly spoken of. 9. May I have a look at the documents? They are still being typed. 10. The children
will be taken to the theatre on Sunday. 11. The Palace of Sports was still being built when I came to
Minsk. 13. This picture was painted by an unknown artist. 13. By the evening the work had been finished.
14. Hurry up. You are being waited for. 15. Where will the new library be built? 16. What is produced at
this factory9 17. The letter can't be sent today because it hasn't been signed by the director. 18. The foreign
students were shown the classrooms, the laboratories and the dormitory of Moscow University. 19. He
was interrupted by the noise in the corridor 20. Glass is broken very easily. 21. (At) what time is the
reading room closed? It is closed at 10 p.m. 22. This question won't
352

be discussed today. 23.1 don't want to show you my article until it is finished. 24. As soon as the journals
are received we'll show them to you. 25. What question was being discussed at the meeting when you
came? 26. Unfortunately nothing was done to help him (to) finish the work. 27. Have the documents been
signed yet? Not yet. 28. When was this monument erected? 29. An interesting problem is being
discussed in the club now. 30. She is happy- She has been offered an interesting job. 31. This house is not
lived in. 32. The school will have been built by the beginning of the new school year. 33. Newspapers and
letters are delivered early in the morning. 34. He said that the work would be done in time if all the
necessary information was received. 35.1 was given all the necessary instructions. 36.1 was asked to
come a bit later because my application was still being considered.

Unit 10 Exercise I, p. 192


1. A lot of skyscraper blocks have been built here recently. 2. The town has been made to look ugly. 3. An
area of terraced nouses is going to be demolished. 4. A shopping area is going to be built. 5. When I
walked past the area the first house was being demolished. 6. The town is being destroyed by these
council planners. 7. Hundreds of protests have been sent in. 8. Their decision has been taken. 9. The
quality of life in the town is being destroyed.

Exercise II, p. 193


A. 1 the; 2 - ;3 the ;4 - ; 5 a; 6 -; 7 -; 8 -; 9 the; 10 -; 11 an; 12 the; 13 - ; 14 the; 15 the; 16 the; 17 the; 18
the; 19 the; 20 -; 21 the; 22 the; 23 an; 24 -; 25 -; 26 -; 27 -; 28 the; 29 -; 30 the; 31 the; 32 the; 33 a; 34 a;
35 an;36 an; 37 -; 38 the; 39 -.
B. I the; 2 the; 3 the; 4 the; 5 the; 6 a; 7 a; 8 the; 9 a; 10 the; 11 the; 12 a; 13 an.
353

Unit 11 Exercise I, p. 212


1 looking 2 make 3 watching, swimming 4 studying 5 feel 6 draw 7 convincing 8 open 9 trickling 10
repaired 11 to help, (to) prepare 12 polishing 13 painted 14 being elected 15 telling 16 lying 17 playing,
joining 18 drink 19 to be, (to) listen 20 play 21 going 22 to discover 23 being/having been, to expect 24
sipping, eating 25 taken 26 to be told 27 to have, to know, to handle 28 being, being 29 understanding 30
have, join 31 to begin 32 failing 33 to let, run 34 make 35 talking 36 built 37 built 38 remembering 39 to
be admitted 40 to get, cut, trimmed 41 entering, leading 42 explaining 43 being allowed 44 being taken 45
having seen 46 knowing 47 having known, speak 48 being surprised, planning 49 asking, forgetting 50 to
sleep, thinking 51 burning, coming 52 to have a garage built, to do 53 being accepted, concentrating 54
hearing, play/playing, forgetting, making, to relax, (to) enjoy 55 wasting, to fail, doing 56 asked/being
asked 57 arriving/having arrived 58 cleaning/to be cleaned, sweeping/to be swept, washing/to be washed,
dusting/to be dusted, reading, doing 59 to complain, losing 60 house-hunting, to ask, looking 61 go,
swimming, going 62 spending, arguing, not to go 63 giving, going, to live 64 to leave, to call 65 to have
kept you waiting, apologizing 66 having been promised 67 earning, to show 68 to start, filling 69 to buy,
to ask 70 cheating, buying, to deal 71 waiting 72 dining, have, to go, having 73 cutting, have 74 to
convince, managing, helping 75 to come, go/going, to climb, making 76 going, burning 77 having lived
78 to leave, to put 79 writing, to receive, go 80 to turn, working 81 keeping, to fill, asking, to keep,
making 82 go fishing, coming, to cut, wasting, sitting, watching, fishing 83 spending, living, to think,
selling, returning 84 grown, grown 85 locked, refusing 86 having worked 87 asking

Exercise II, p. 215

Participles as adjectives and adjectival phrases


1. The windows facing the bridge were open. 2. The secretary posted the letters signed by the director. 3.
I'm very grateful to the doctors who have saved my child's life. 4. His unexpected
354

answer surprised us. 5. The road being repaired now will be much wider after the repairs. 6. There are
some broken chairs in this room. 7. He brought me some illustrated magazines. 8. We carefully read the
article sent by Prof. Ivanov. 9. The stories, published in this magazine, are very interesting. 10. The
workers unloading the ship will be free in an hour. 11. The dictionaries taken by the students from the
library must be returned not later than 6 o'clock. 12. The man sitting by the open window was looking at
the children playing in the garden. 13.1 hope you won't make the mistakes made in the last dictation. 14.
He showed me a list of goods exported by this firm. 15. There are a lot of figures hi his article illustrating
the development of our industry. 16.1 haven't looked through all the journals sent to us from London. 17.1
have already checked the compositions written by the students of my group. 18. Here is a list of students
studying English. 19. All the students taking part in this work must come to the institute at 6 p.m. 20.1
read the article translated by my sister from English into Russian. 21. He put the sleeping child on the
sofa. 22. We came up to the man standing on the comer and asked him the way to the station. 23. The
people waiting for the doctor have been sitting here for a long time. 24. The people who have been
waiting for you have just left. 25. The conference being held at the university is devoted to the problems
of nuclear physics. 26. The scientist who has written this article will make a report at our university. 27.1
asked the young man reading a newspaper what time it was. 28. The picture hanging in the hall attracted
my attention. 29. The picture which hung here last year is at the art museum now. 30. The books lying on
the table belong to my brother. 31. This telegram came with the mail delivered in the morning. 32. The
students who have finished translating the article may leave the room. 33.1 have never heard about the
actress who starred in this film. 34. The car following us was grey. 35. The agreement concluded between
these two countries is of great importance to them. 36. The trees growing in front of our house Were
planted by my father. 37. The problems discussed at the last meeting are very interesting.
Participles introducing adverbial phrases
I.You must be careful (while) playing chess. 2. They were quickly walking talking about omething with
great interest. 3. The
355
captain was standing on deck giving instructions to the sailors.
4. Having left our things in the cloakroom we went sightseeing
5. Left alone/being left alone he began to unpack his things. 6. Having lived in London many years he
knew the city well. 7. He didn't agree to come to the concert with us saying he was busy. 8. She stood
thinking what to answer. 9.1 didn't phone him thinking that he was busy. 10. Travelling around the
country we saw a lot of places of interest. 11. Understanding that she wouldn't be able to do the work
alone she asked me for help. 12. Knowing that I had enough time to reach the cinema on time I wasn't in a
hurry. 13. Hearing that her sister couldn't come to see her Ann got upset. 14. He was looking at her
smiling. 15. She spent the morning doing the flat. 16. Arriving in the city we went to the hotel. 17.
Having worked in the hospital more than ten years he became an experienced doctor. 18. Looking through
the old magazines I found an interesting article about Great Britain. 19. Waiting for my tram I saw an old
man staring at me. 20. Having read the letter he put it into the drawer. 21. Being very tired I decided to
stay at home. 22. Not knowing grammar he made very many mistakes. 23. He took the dictionary without
asking permission. 24. Not receiving letters from her he sent her a telegram.
25. Not knowing how to get to the station I asked a policeman.
26. She left without looking at us. 27. Be careful while crossing the street. 28. Being very absent-minded
he made several mistakes copying the text. 29. Having worked at the report all day long he felt very tired.
30. He realized his mistake and stopped arguing. 31. Having received the telegram I immediately left for
my hometown 32. We had a good time swimming and sunbathing.
Participle after verbs of perception
1.1 saw her working in the garden. 2.1 watched the mechanic repairing my car. 3.1 heard her singing in
the next room. 4.1 feel something burning in the kitchen. 5. We watched the children playing football. 6.1
saw him walking in the park. 7.1 heard her playing the piano and didn't want to interrupt her. 8. I watched
my son doing his homework. 9.1 heard them talking in the next room. 10. Seeing the taxi drive up to the
house he took his things and went downstairs. 11.1 noticed somebody standing at the gate.
356

Have something done

1. How often do you have your hair cut? 2.1 must immediately have my watch repaired. 3. We had had
our house repaired before w-e left for the south. 4. I want to have this document typed as soon as possible.
5.1 have just had my tooth pulled out. 6. When did you have your room papered? A week ago. How
much did it cost you? 100 dollars. 7.1 didn't have my watch repaired yesterday because all the repairshops were closed. 8. Have you had your ceiling whitewashed? 9. Where did you have this dress made?
10. When will you have your piano tuned at last? 11. When did you have your garage built? 12. Yesterday
he had his wallet stolen. 13.1 want to have my suit ironed. 14. You must have your hair cut.

Unit 12 Exercise I, p. 251


1 the; 2 the; 3 the; 4 the; 5 the; 6 the; 7 a; 8 the; 9 the; 10 a; 11 the; 12 a; 13 -; 14 -; 15 -; 16 the; 17 a; 18
a; 19 -; 20 -; 21 -; 22 -; 23 -; 24 -; 25 -.

Exercise 2, p. 251
1. When I was a student, I went in for sports. I was good at running and jumping. But when I became
older, I gave up sports and I'm very sorry about it. This winter I'm going to go skiing and skating, and
when summer comes, I'll go swimming and rowing. 2. I'm very fond of figure skating and I always watch
on TV the international figure skating competitions. 3. I study at the Linguistic University. We have an
excellent sports hall and all facilities for good physical training. 4. My brother dreams to achieve (to set) a
record in swimming. He trains a lot. 5.1 prefer track and field athletics to boxing and wrestling. 6.
Mountaineering is a dangerous sport. 7. My daughter is keen on sports. She is good at figure skating, she
can swim and run well. 8. Are you going to take part in the boating race? No, I'm off form now. 9.1
seem to know this man. He was an excellent runner once and now he trams young sportsmen. 10. By
whom was the last world record
357
in high jump set? I don't know. I'm not keen on track and field athletics. I prefer football. 11. Last
Saturday my friend and I went to the stadium. Moscow Spartak and Minsk Dynamo were playing My
friend is a Muscovite and he supports Spartak, and I'm a supporter of Minsk Dynamo. The game
(match) was exciting Both the teams were in good shape. A Minsk forward was the first to score a
goal. Some minutes later a Spartak halfback evened the score. The first half ended in a draw. In the
second half the Dynamo players were stronger than their opponents and they scored another goal.
They won by two goals to one. I was happy, but my friend was disappointed.

Unit 13 Exercise I, p. 308


A. Peter reminded Nick that they had no homework for the next day and suggested going to the
cinema saying that he hadn't seen a film for a long time. It turned out that Nick had no money, but
Peter said he had enough money for both of them. Nick thanked him and promised to pay back the
money on Monday. At that moment their friend John appeared. He asked where they were going, and
Peter answered they were going to the cinema. John wanted to know what film they were going to
see. Peter said that they were going to see "War and Peace". John remarked that his parents had
already seen that film, and they had enjoyed it very much. Nick asked why John hadn't seen the film
together with his parents. John explained that he had been very busy that day. When Nick asked John
whether he wanted to come with them, John answered that he did, but he had promised his father to
repair his car. Nick invited John to go to the pictures together with them and promised that after the
film they would all come to his place to help them with the car. John thanked his friends and asked
them when the film began. Peter answered that it began at 12.30, and the boys hurried to the cinema.
B. Talking about the weather one day, Peter remarked joyfully that the day was lovely. Jane agreed
saying that it was the first really warm day that spring because the weather hadn't been too good
lately. Peter protested saying that there had been some sunshine every day. Jane remarked ironically
that there had been
358

rain every day too. Peter called her a pessimist. Then he suggested having a picnic. With an
exclamation of regret Jane said that she couldn't because she had to prepare for her exams. Peter
begged her to go to the country at the weekend but she refused. Her friend was disappointed.

Unit 14 Exercise I, p. 338


make; feel; to enjoy; about being; to being; about Uncle Tom('s) visiting; would need; feeling;
usually goes; to Uncle Tom('s) describing; gives; to taking; taking

Exercise 2, p. 339
1 a; 2 an ;3 -; 4 a; 5 a; 6 -; 7 -; 8 -; 9 -; 10 a, 11 -; 12 -;13 an; 14 the; 15 the; 16 -; 17 -; 18 -; 19 -; 20

a; 21 a; 22 -; 23 -; 24 the; 25 a; 26 -; 27 the; 28 -; 29 the; 30-; 31 the; 32 -; 33 -; 34 the; 35 -; 36 a; 37


a; 38 the; 39 the; 40 -; 41 a; 42 the; 43 the; 44 the; 45 the; 46 the; 47 the; 48 -.

Exercise III, p. 340


1.1 have a sore throat. It must be quinzy. 2. She is seriously ill. She has been taken to hospital. She
may (might) be operated on. 3. You look ill. I advise you to consult a doctor the sooner the better.
4. I'm suffering from insomnia. I don't know what to do. Why don't you take up sports? It might
help you. I'm too old to go in for sports. 5.1 have a bad pain in my chest. I'm afraid it's
pneumonia. 6. Helen is ill with scarlet fever. She's in hospital now. 7. He was treated for flu but it
turned out to be pneumonia. 8. This is a good medicine for a headache (an earache, a toothache). 9.
Have you been X-rayed? Not yet. But I've just had my blood pressure taken. It's normal. 10. He
has a weak heart. Yesterday he had a bad heart attack. He's in bed. The doctor told him to stay in bed
for three days. 11. You have two bad teeth. You must go to the dentist's. Three months ago the
dentist filled two of my teeth, I wish I didn't have to have my teeth filled every three months. 12. The
doctor prescribed me some medicine
359

and said that I could have the prescription made up at any chemist's. 13. Your eyes are swollen.
What's wrong with you? 14. He has got over (recovered from) his bronchitis and now he is quite
well. 15. You must take your temperature. Here's the thermometer. 16. You don't look well. What's
the matter with you? Have you had a sleepless night? I don't feel well. I think there's nothing
serious. If I were you I should consult a doctor.
17. Some days ago I woke up with a splitting headache. I had a running nose and a bad cough.
Besides I had a sore throat. I took my temperature. It was 39.1 phoned my doctor. The doctor came
and examined me thoroughly, felt my pulse, sounded my heart and lungs, took my blood pressure,
looked at my tongue and throat. The doctor said that it was flue and that I should stay in bed for a
few days. He wrote out a prescription for some tablets and a mixture and told me to take a spoonful
of it three times a day. My wife went to the chemist's where she had the prescription made up. I
followed the doctor's instructions and recovered in a week.
18. I'm a little sick. I have a slight fever, my body aches all over, I'm dizzy. I'm ill. 19. I have a pain
in my back. I don't know what's wrong.

Vous aimerez peut-être aussi